<PAGE>
As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 6, 1998
Registration No. 333-43143
================================================================================
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
PRE-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT NO. 3 TO
FORM S-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
POCAHONTAS BANCORP, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware 6712 (To be applied for)
(State or other jurisdiction (Primary standard (I.R.S. Employer
of incorporation industrial classification) identification number)
or organization)
203 West Broadway Street
Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455
(870) 892-4595
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)
Skip Martin
President and Chief Executive Officer
203 West Broadway Street
Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455
(870) 892-4595
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number,
including area code, of agent for service)
Copies to:
Robert B. Pomerenk, Esq.
Richard A. Gashler, Esq.
Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick
5335 Wisconsin Avenue, N.W.
Suite 400
Washington, D.C. 20015
Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as
practicable after this registration statement becomes effective.
If any of the securities being registered on this form are to be offered on a
delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 of the Securities Act of 1933,
check the following box: |X|
If this form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant
to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the
Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective
registration statement for the same offering. |_|
If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under
the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. |_|
If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under
the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. |_|
If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434, check
the following box. |_|
The registrant hereby amends this registration statement on such date or dates
as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall file
a further amendment which specifically states that this registration shall
thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities
Act of 1933 or until the registration statement shall become effective on such
date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section
8(a), may determine.
<PAGE>
Prospectus Supplement
POCAHONTAS BANCORP, INC.
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS
AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND
LOAN ASSOCIATION 401(K) SAVINGS AND
EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN
(Participation Interests)
This Prospectus Supplement relates to the offer and sale to participants
(the "Participants") in the Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
401(k) Savings and Employee Stock Ownership Plan (the "Plan") of
participation interests and shares of common stock, par value $.01 per share
(the "Common Stock"), of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (the "Company"), in
connection with the proposed conversion ("Conversion") of the Pocahontas
Federal Mutual Holding Company (the "Mutual Holding Company") from a
federally chartered holding company to a Delaware stock corporation, pursuant
to the Mutual Holding Company's Plan of Conversion and Reorganization (the
"Plan of Conversion") and the related Subscription Offering and Community
Offering (collectively, the "Offering").
The Plan permits the investment of Plan assets in Common Stock of the
Company. The Trustee has determined to give Participants the limited
opportunity to invest in Common Stock of the Company in the Offering.
Participants will not have an ongoing opportunity to invest in Common Stock
of the Company. The Plan permits Participants to direct the trustee of the
401(k) Trust under the Plan (the "Trustee") to invest in Common Stock with
amounts in the Elective Deferral, Discretionary Contribution, Matching
Contribution, Rollover, Qualified Non-Elective Contribution and Qualified
Matching Contribution Accounts (the "Accounts") in the Plan attributable to
such Participants. Such investments in Common Stock would be by means of the
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. Stock Fund ("Employer Stock Fund"). This Prospectus
Supplement relates to the one-time election of Participants to direct that
all or a portion of their Accounts be invested in the Employer Stock Fund in
connection with the Conversion and Offering. A Participant will be able to
provide alternative investment instructions to the Trustee in the event that
the Offering is oversubscribed and the total amount allocated by a
Participant cannot be used by the Trustee to purchase Common Stock.
The Prospectus of the Company dated February ___, 1998 (the
"Prospectus") which is attached to this Prospectus Supplement includes
detailed information with respect to the Conversion, the Common Stock and the
financial condition, results of operations and business of the Bank. This
Prospectus Supplement, which provides detailed information with respect to
the Plan, should be read only in conjunction with the Prospectus.
THESE PARTICIPATION INTERESTS HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION, THE OFFICE OF THRIFT SUPERVISION OR BY
ANY OTHER FEDERAL AGENCY, OR BY ANY STATE SECURITIES BUREAU OR OTHER STATE
AGENCY, NOR HAS ANY SUCH OFFICE, CORPORATION, COMMISSION, BUREAU OR OTHER
AGENCY PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT.
ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representations other than those contained in the Prospectus or this
Prospectus Supplement, and, if given or made, such information or
representations must not be relied upon as having been authorized by the Bank
or the Plan. This Prospectus Supplement does not constitute an offer to sell
or solicitation of an offer to buy any securities in any jurisdiction to any
person to whom it is unlawful to make such offer or solicitation in such
jurisdiction. Neither the delivery of this Prospectus Supplement and the
Prospectus nor any sale made hereunder shall under any circumstances create
any implication that there has been no change in the affairs of the Bank or
the Plan since the date hereof, or that the information herein contained or
incorporated by reference is correct as of any time subsequent to the date
hereof. This Prospectus Supplement should be read only in conjunction with
the Prospectus that is attached hereto and should be retained for future
reference.
The date of this Prospectus Supplement is February ___, 1998.
<PAGE>
TABLE OF CONTENTS
THE OFFERING............................................................. 1
Securities Offered.................................................. 1
Election to Purchase Common Stock in the Offering; Priorities....... 1
Value of Participation Interests.................................... 2
Method of Director Transfer......................................... 2
Time for Directing Transfer......................................... 2
Irrevocability of Transfer Direction................................ 2
Direction to Purchase Common Stock After the Offering............... 2
Purchase Price of Common Stock...................................... 3
Nature of a Participants Interest in Common Stock................... 3
Voting Rights of Common Stock....................................... 3
DESCRIPTION OF THE PLAN.................................................. 3
Introduction........................................................ 3
Eligibility and Participation....................................... 4
Contributions Under the Plan........................................ 4
Limitations on Contributions........................................ 5
Investment of Contributions and Account Balances.................... 7
Benefits Under the Plan............................................. 10
Withdrawals and Distributions From the Plan......................... 10
Trustee............................................................. 11
Plan Administrator.................................................. 11
Reports to Plan Participants........................................ 11
Amendment and Termination........................................... 11
Merger, Consolidation or Transfer................................... 12
Federal Income Tax Consequences..................................... 12
ERISA and Other Qualifications...................................... 15
SEC Reporting and Short-Swing Profit Liability...................... 15
Financial Information Regarding Plan Assets......................... 16
LEGAL OPINION............................................................ 16
<PAGE>
THE OFFERING
Securities Offered
The securities offered hereby are participation interests in the Plan.
Up to 140,000 shares (assuming a purchase price of $10.00 per share) of
Common Stock may be acquired by the Plan in connection with the Offering to
be held in the Employer Stock Fund. The Company is the issuer of the Common
Stock. Only employees of the Bank may become Participants in the Plan. The
Common Stock to be issued hereby is conditioned on the consummation of the
Conversion. A Participant's investment in the Employer Stock Fund in the
Conversion is subject to the priority set forth in the Plan of Conversion.
Information with regard to the Plan is contained in this Prospectus
Supplement and information with regard to the Conversion and the financial
condition, results of operation and business of the Bank is contained in the
attached Prospectus. The address of the principal executive office of the
Bank is 203 West Broadway, Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455. The Bank's telephone
number is (870) 892-4595.
Election to Purchase Common Stock in the Offering; Priorities
The Plan permits each Participant to direct that all or part of the
Accounts which represent his or her beneficial interest in the assets of the
401(k) part of Plan may be transferred to the Employer Stock Fund, an
investment fund in the Plan, and used to purchase Common Stock issued in
connection with the Offering. The Trustee of the 401(k) Trust under the Plan
will purchase Common Stock offered for sale in connection with the Offering
in accordance with each Participant's directions. Participants will be
provided the opportunity to elect alternative investments from among the six
other funds offered. In the event the Offering is oversubscribed and the
Trustee is unable to use the full amount allocated by a Participant to
purchase Common Stock in the Offering, Participants may either (i) elect
alternative investments from among the six other funds offered, or (ii)
direct the Trustee to hold the funds transferred to the Employer Stock Fund
and purchase Common Stock in the open market after the Offering. If a
Participant fails to direct the investment of his or her Account balance, the
Participant's Account balance will remain in the other investment funds of
the Plan as previously directed by the Participant.
The shares of Common Stock to be sold in the Offering are being offered
in accordance with the following priorities: (i) holders of deposit accounts
of the Bank totaling $50 or more as of September 30, 1996 ("Eligible Account
Holders"); (ii) the 401(k) Savings and Employee Stock Ownership Plan
("KSOP"); (iii) holders of deposit accounts of the Bank totaling $50 or more
as of December 31, 1997 ("Supplemental Eligible Account Holders"); (iv)
members of the Mutual Holding Company as of January 21, 1998 ("Other
Members"); (v) Minority Stockholders. To the extent that Participants fall
into one of these categories, they are being permitted to use funds in their
Plan Accounts to subscribe or pay for the Common Stock being acquired.
Common Stock so purchased will be placed in the Participant's Employer Stock
Fund within his Plan account.
1
<PAGE>
Value of Participation Interests
The assets of the 401(k) Plan (as described below) were valued at
approximately $1,339,423.00 as of September 30, 1997. Each Participant was
informed of the value of his or her beneficial interest in the Plan as of
September 30, 1997. The $1,339,423.00 value represents the aggregate market
value as of September 30, 1997, of all Participants' accounts in the 401(k)
Plan and earnings thereon, less previous withdrawals.
Method of Directing Transfer
Each Participant shall receive a form which provides for a Participant
to direct that all or a portion of his or her beneficial interest in the
Accounts in the Plan be transferred to the Employer Stock Fund (the
"Investment Selection Form") or to the other investment options established
under the Plan. The Participant's investment in the other investment options
set forth in the Plan may be in any whole percentage from 0% to 100%. If a
Participant wishes to invest all or part of his or her beneficial interest in
the Plan to the purchase of Common Stock issued in connection with the
Offering, he or she should indicate that decision on the Investment Selection
Form.
Time for Directing Transfer
Directions to transfer amounts to the Employer Stock Fund in order to
purchase Common Stock issued in connection with the Offering must be returned
to the Stock Center at the Bank at _______________________________________ no
later than __:00 p.m. on March ___, 1998.
Irrevocability of Transfer Direction
A Participant's direction to transfer amounts credited to such
Participant's Accounts in the Plan to the Employer Stock Fund in order to
purchase shares of Common Stock in connection with the Offering is
irrevocable. Participants, however, will be able to direct the investment of
their Accounts under the Plan as explained below.
Direction to Purchase Common Stock After the Offering
The Trustee has determined to give Participants the limited opportunity
to invest in Common Stock in connection with the Offering. After the
Offering, a Participant will not be able to direct further investments to the
Employer Stock Fund. The allocation of a Participant's interest in a Plan
Fund may be changed on a quarterly basis but a Participant will not be
entitled to purchase additional shares of Common Stock. Special restrictions
may apply to transfers from the Employer Stock Fund by those Participants who
are officers, directors and principal shareholders of the Company who are
subject to the provisions of Section 16(b) of the Securities and Exchange Act
of 1934 (the "Exchange Act"), as amended.
2
<PAGE>
Purchase Price of Common Stock
The funds transferred to the Employer Stock Fund for the purchase of
Common Stock in connection with the Offering will be used by the Trustee to
purchase shares of Common Stock, except in the event of an oversubscription,
as discussed above. The price paid for such shares of Common Stock will be
the same price as is paid by all other persons who purchase shares of Common
Stock in the Offering. Subsequent to the Offering, Common Stock purchased by
the Trustee will be acquired in open market transactions until the initial
amounts directed to purchase Common Stock in the Offering are satisfied. The
price paid by the Trustee for shares of Common Stock will not exceed
"adequate consideration" as defined in Section 3(18) of the Employee
Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA").
Nature of a Participant's Interest in the Common Stock
The Common Stock will be held in the name of the Trustee for the Plan,
as Trustee. Shares of Common Stock acquired at the direction of a Participant
will be allocated to the Participant's account under the Plan. Therefore,
earnings with respect to a Participant's account should not be affected by
the investment designations (including investments in Common Stock) of other
Participants. The Trustee as record holder will vote such allocated shares,
if any, as directed by Participants.
Voting Rights of Common Stock
The Trustee generally will exercise voting rights attributable to all
Common Stock held by the Employer Stock Fund as directed by Participants with
interests in the Employer Stock Fund. With respect to each matter as to which
holders of Common Stock have a right to vote, each Participant will be
allocated voting instruction rights reflecting such Participant's
proportionate interest in the Employer Stock Fund. The number of shares of
Common Stock held in the Employer Stock Fund that are voted in the
affirmative and negative on each matter shall be proportionate to the number
of voting instruction rights exercised by Participants in the affirmative and
negative respectively.
DESCRIPTION OF THE PLAN
Introduction
The Bank adopted the Plan effective October 1, 1997, which Plan is a
consolidation of the Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association 401(k)
Savings and Profit Sharing Plan (the "401(k) Plan") and the Pocahontas
Federal Savings and Loan Association Employee Stock Ownership Plan (the
"ESOP"). The Plan is an ESOP with a cash or deferred compensation feature
3
<PAGE>
established in accordance with the requirements under Section 401(a), Section
401(k) and Section 4975(e) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
(the "Code"). The Plan is qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code, and its
related trust is qualified under Section 501(a) of the Code.
The Bank intends that the Plan, in operation, will comply with the
requirements under Section 401(a), Section 401(k) and Section 4975(e) of the
Code. The Bank will adopt any amendments to the Plan that may be necessary to
ensure the qualified status of the Plan under the Code and applicable
Treasury Regulations.
Employee Retirement Income Security Act. The Plan is an "individual
account plan" other than a "money purchase pension plan" within the meaning
of ERISA. As such, the Plan is subject to all of the provisions of Title I
(Protection of Employee Benefit Rights) and Title II (Amendments to the
Internal Revenue Code Relating to Retirement Plans) of ERISA, except the
funding requirements contained in Part 3 of Title I of ERISA which by their
terms do not apply to an individual account plan (other than a money purchase
plan). The Plan is not subject to Title IV (Plan Termination Insurance) of
ERISA. The funding requirements contained in Title IV of ERISA are not
applicable to Participants (as defined below) or beneficiaries under the Plan.
Reference to full Text of Plan. The following statements are summaries
of certain provisions of the Plan. They are not complete and are qualified in
their entirety by the full text of the Plan. Words capitalized but not
defined in the following discussion have the same meaning as set forth in the
Plan. Copies of the Plan are available to all employees by filing a request
with the Plan Administrator, c/o Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan
Association, 203 West Broadway, Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455. Each employee is
urged to read carefully the full text of the Plan.
Eligibility and Participation
Any employee of the Employer is eligible to participate in any ESOP,
matching or discretionary contributions under the Plan on the first Entry
Date (October 1 and April 1) following completion of one (1 ) year of Entry
Service, as defined, with the Bank, provided he or she has reached age 21 at
such time. A year of Entry Service is defined as the 12 month period during
which an employee completes at least 1000 hours of service with the Bank.
Any employee with one hour of service may participate in making any elective
deferrals. The plan year is October 1 to September 30 (the "Plan Year").
As of October 31, 1997, there were approximately 60 employees eligible
to participate in the ESOP, matching or discretionary contributions under the
Plan, and 65 employees eligible to participate in any elective deferral
contributions.
Contributions Under the Plan
401(k) Plan Contributions. Each Participant of the Plan is permitted to
elect to defer such Participant's Cash Compensation (as defined below) on a
pre-tax basis up to the lesser of 15% of
4
<PAGE>
such Participant's Cash Compensation (expressed in terms of whole
percentages) or the applicable limit under the Code (for 1998, the applicable
limit is $10,000) and subject to certain other restrictions imposed by the
Code, and to have that amount contributed to the Plan on such Participant's
behalf. For purposes of the Plan, "Cash Compensation" means, generally, a
Participant's wages received from the Bank as reported on IRS Form W-2 for
purposes of income-tax withholding ("415 Compensation") plus amounts
contributed under an elective deferral agreement pursuant to Code Section
401(k) or a salary reduction agreement pursuant to Section 125 of the Code.
In 1998, the annual 415 Compensation of each Participant taken into account
under the Plan was and is limited to $160,000. (Limits established by the IRS
are subject to increase pursuant to an annual cost of living adjustment, as
permitted by the Code). A Participant may elect to modify the amount
contributed to the Plan by filing a new elective deferral agreement with the
Plan Administrator.
Matching Contributions. The Bank may, in its sole discretion, make
matching contributions to the Plan. Matching Contributions are allocated
ratably to certain Participants who have made elective deferral contributions.
Discretionary Contributions. The Bank may, in its sole discretion, make
contributions to the Plan. Discretionary Contributions are allocated to the
accounts of certain Participants in proportion to Cash Compensation.
ESOP Contributions. The Bank may, in its sole discretion, make
contributions to the ESOP Accounts of certain Participants in proportion to
Cash Compensation. If the Plan incurs a stock obligation for the purchase of
Common Stock, the Bank may contribute an amount sufficient to cover all
payments of principal and interest as they come due. Shares purchased with
the ESOP loan are held in a suspense account for allocation among
Participants as the loan is repaid. In any Plan Year in which ESOP
Contributions are used as payments under a stock obligation, shares of stock
are released from the suspense account in an amount proportional to the
repayment of the loan. The released shares are allocated among the ESOP
Accounts of certain Participants, on the basis of compensation in the year of
allocation.
Limitations on Contributions
Limitation on Employee Salary Deferrals. The annual amount of deferred
Cash Compensation of a Participant (when aggregated with any elective
deferrals of the Participant under a simplified employee pension plan or a
tax-deferred annuity) may not exceed the limitation contained in Section
402(g) of the Code, adjusted for increases in the cost of living as permitted
by the Code (the limitation for 1998 is $10,000). Contributions in excess of
this limitation ("excess deferrals") will be included in the Participant's
gross income for federal income tax purposes in the year they are made. In
addition, any such excess deferral will again be subject to federal income
tax when distributed by the Plan to the Participant, unless the excess
deferral (together with any income allocable thereto) is distributed to the
Participant not later than the first April 15th following the close of the
taxable year in which the excess deferral is made. Any income on the excess
deferral that
5
<PAGE>
is distributed not later than such date shall be treated, for federal income
tax purposes, as earned and received by the Participant in the taxable year
in which the distribution is made.
Limitations on Annual Additions and Benefits. Pursuant to the
requirements of the Code, the Plan provides that the amount of contributions
and forfeitures allocated to each Participant's account during any Plan Year
may not exceed the lesser of $30,000 or 25% of the Participant's Compensation
(as defined) for the Plan Year. In addition, annual additions are limited to
the extent necessary to prevent contributions on behalf of any employee from
exceeding the employee's combined plan limit, i.e., a limit that takes into
account the contributions and benefits made on behalf of an employee to all
plans of the Bank. To the extent that these limitations have been exceeded
with respect to a Participant, the Plan Administrator shall:
(i) return any elective deferral contributions to the extent that the
return would reduce the excess amount in the Participant's accounts;
(ii) if the Participant is covered by the Plan at the end of the Plan
Year, any excess amount remaining will be used to reduce Employer
Contributions for such Participant in the next Plan Year, and each succeeding
Plan Year if necessary;
(iii) if an excess amount still exists, and the Participant is not
covered by the Plan at the end of a Plan Year, the Excess Amount will be
held unallocated in a suspense account. The suspense account will be applied
to reduce future Employer Contributions for all remaining Participants in the
next Plan Year, and each succeeding Plan Year if necessary;
(iv) if a suspense account is in existence at any time during a Plan
Year, it will participate in the allocation of the trust's investment gains
or losses. If a suspense account is in existence at any time during a
particular Plan Year, all amounts in the suspense accounts must be allocated
and reallocated to Participant's Accounts before any employer or any
Participant contributions may be made to the Plan for that Plan Year. Excess
amounts may not be distributed to Participants or former Participants.
If, in addition to this Plan, the Participant is covered under other
defined contribution plans and welfare benefit funds maintained by the Bank
and annual additions exceed the maximum permissible amount, the amount
contributed or allocated under this Plan will be reduced so that the annual
additions under all such plans and funds equal the maximum permissible amount.
Limitation on Plan Contributions for Highly Compensated Employees.
Sections 401(k) and 401(m) of the Code limits the amount of elective deferral
contributions and matching contributions that may be made to the Plan in any
Plan Year on behalf of Highly Compensated Employees (defined below) in
relation to the amount of elective deferral contributions made by or on
behalf of all other employees eligible to participate in the Plan.
Specifically, the "actual deferral percentage" ("ADP") (i.e., the average of
the actual deferral ratios, expressed as a percentage, of each eligible
employee's elective deferral contribution if any, for the Plan Year over the
employee's
6
<PAGE>
compensation), of the Highly Compensated Employees must meet either of the
following tests: (i) the ADP of the eligible Highly Compensated Employees is
not more than 125% of the ADP of all other eligible employees, or (ii) the
ADP of the eligible Highly Compensated Employees is not more than 200% of the
ADP of all other eligible employees, and the excess of the ADP for the
eligible Highly Compensated Employees over the ADP of all other eligible
employees is not more than two percentage points. Similarly, the actual
contribution percentage ("ACP") (i.e., the average of the actual contribution
ratios, expressed as a percentage, of each eligible employee's matching
contributions, if any, for the Plan Year over the employee's compensation) of
the Highly Compensated Employees must meet either of the following tests: (i)
the ACP of the eligible Highly Compensated Employees is not more than 125% of
the ACP of all other eligible employees, or (ii) the ACP of the eligible
Highly Compensated Employees is not more than 200% of the ACP of all other
eligible employees, and the excess of the ACP for the eligible Highly
Compensated Employees over the ACP of all other employees is not more than
two percentage points.
In general, for Plan Years beginning in 1998, a Highly Compensated
Employee includes any employee, who, (1) during the Plan Year or the
preceding Plan Year, was at any time a 5% owner (i.e., owns directly or
indirectly more than 5% of the stock of an employer, or stock possessing more
than 5% of the total combined voting power of all stock of an employer), or
(2) for the preceding Plan Year, received 415 Compensation from an employer
in excess of $80,000 (in 1998), and (if the employer elects for a Plan Year)
was in the group consisting of the top 20% of employees when ranked on the
basis of compensation paid during the Plan Year. The dollar amounts set
forth above are adjusted annually to reflect increases in the cost of living.
In order to prevent the disqualification of the Plan, the Bank may, in
its sole discretion, make special Qualified Nonelective Contributions for
certain Participants who are not Highly Compensated Employees.
Alternatively, the Bank may elect to return any amount contributed by Highly
Compensated Employees that exceed the ADP limitation in any Plan Year
("excess deferrals"), together with any income allocable thereto, first to
Highly Compensated Employees with the greatest dollar amount of deferrals,
and so on, until the Plan satisfies the ADP test, before the close of the
following Plan Year. Moreover, the Bank will be subject to a 10% excise tax
on any excess deferrals unless such excess deferrals, together with any
income allocable thereto, either are re-characterized or are distributed
before the close of the first 2-1/2 months following the Plan Year to which
such excess deferrals relate. In addition, in order to avoid disqualification
of the Plan, the Bank may, in its sole discretion, make special Qualified
Matching Contributions for certain Participants who are not Highly
Compensated Employees. Alternatively, any contributions by Highly
Compensated Employees that exceed the average contribution limitation in any
Plan Year ("excess aggregate contributions") together with any income
allocable thereto, may be distributed to such Highly Compensated Employees
before the close of the following Plan Year. However, the 10% excise tax will
be imposed on the Bank with respect to any excess aggregate contributions,
unless such amounts, plus any income allocable thereto, are distributed
within 2-1/2 months following the close of the Plan Year in which they arose.
Investment of Contributions and Account Balances
All amounts credited to Participants' Accounts under the Plan are held
in the 401(k) Trust (the "Trust") which is administered by the Trustee
appointed by the Bank's Board of Directors.
7
<PAGE>
Prior to the effective date of the Offering, Participants have been
provided the opportunity to direct the investment of their Accounts into one
of the following funds (the "Funds"):
A. Oppenheimer Main Street Income & Growth Fund
B. Merrill Lynch Growth Fund
C. Merrill Lynch Basic Value Fund
D. Merrill Lynch Capital Fund
E. Merrill Lynch CMA Money Market Fund
F. Retirement Preservation Trust
The Plan now provides that in addition to the Funds specified above, a
Participant will have the limited opportunity to direct the Trustee to
invest all or a portion of his Account in the Employer Stock Fund in
connection with the Offering.
A Participant may elect to have past contributions (and earnings)
invested either in the Employer Stock Fund or among the Funds listed above.
Transfers of past contributions (and the earnings thereon) do not affect the
investment mix of future contributions. This election will be effective as of
___________________________________. Any amounts credited to a Participant's
Accounts for which investment directions are not given will remain in the
other investment funds of the Plan as previously directed by the Participant.
A. Previous Funds.
Prior to the effective date of the Offering, contributions to the
Accounts under the Plan have been invested in the six Funds specified above.
The following table provides performance data with respect to the investment
funds available under the Plan, based on information provided to the Company
by Merrill Lynch:
Through
10/31/1997 1996 1995 1994
---------- ---- ---- -----
A. Oppenheimer Main Street 19.56% 14.84% 29.65% N/A
Income & Growth Fund
B. Merrill Lynch Growth Fund 26.87 28.38 35.45 0.72
Class B
C. Merrill Lynch Basic Value 23.22 16.58 31.60 0.88
Fund Class B
D. Merrill Lynch Capital Fund 16.56 11.50 31.52 -0.10
Class B
E. Merrill Lynch CMA Money Returns through November 30, 1997:
Market Fund
YTD 4.71%
1 Year Average Annual 5.16%
3 Year Average Annual 5.28%
5 Year Average Annual 4.46%
8
<PAGE>
F. Retirement Preservation Trust:
30-day annual yield as of 7/16/97 = 5.49%
The following is a description of each of the Plan's six investment Funds:
Oppenheimer Main Street Income & Growth Fund. This fund seeks high
total return. The fund primarily invests in income-producing common stocks,
preferred stocks, convertible securities, bonds, debentures, and notes. The
fund will shift its assets among these various investments depending on its
view of the investment climate.
Merrill Lynch Growth Fund. Merrill Lynch Growth Fund is an open-end
fund which seeks to provide growth of capital and, secondarily, income. The
fund seeks to meet its objective by investing in a diversified portfolio of
primarily equity securities placing principal emphasis on those securities
which management of the fund believes to be undervalued.
Merrill Lynch Basic Value Fund. Merrill Lynch Basic Value Fund is an
open-end fund which aims to achieve capital appreciation. The fund invests
primarily in equities that provide an above average dividend return and sell
at a below-average price-earnings ratio. Emphasis is placed on securities
that are out of favor and sell at a discount to book value and price earnings
ratio.
Merrill Lynch Capital Fund. Merrill Lynch Capital Fund is an open-end
common stock fund. The fund seeks to achieve high total investment return
consistent with prudent risk. The fund invests in equity, debt, and
convertible securities with an emphasis on capital stability and income.
Merrill Lynch CMA Money Market.
Retirement Preservation Trust. This is a money market fund.
B. The Employer Stock Fund.
The Employer Stock Fund will consist of investments in Common Stock made
on (and after in the event of an oversubscription) the effective date of the
Offering. Pending investment in Common Stock, assets held in the Employer
Stock Fund will be placed in money market accounts.
When Common Stock is sold, the costs are charged to the Accounts of
Participants affected by the sale. The Participant will pay any brokerage
commissions, transfer fees and other expenses incurred in the sale of
securities attributable to him or her in all the investment alternatives,
including the Common Stock for the Employer Stock Fund. At the Bank's
election, however, the Bank may pay such brokerage commissions transfer fees,
and other expenses. A Participant's account will be adjusted to reflect
changes in the value of shares of Common Stock resulting from stock
dividends, stock splits and similar changes.
INVESTMENT IN THE EMPLOYER STOCK FUND MAY INVOLVE CERTAIN RISKS IN
INVESTMENT IN COMMON STOCK OF THE COMPANY. FOR A DISCUSSION OF THESE RISK
FACTORS, SEE THE PROSPECTUS.
9
<PAGE>
Benefits Under the Plan
Vesting. A Participant, at all times, has a fully vested,
nonforfeitable interest in his or her Elective Deferral Account, Qualified
Non-Elective Contribution Account, Qualified Matching Contribution Account
and Rollover Account under the Plan. A Participant's vested interest in his
ESOP, Discretionary Contribution and Matching Contributions Accounts shall be
as follows:
Percentage of
Vesting Years Interest Vested
------------- ---------------
Fewer than 5 0%
5 or more 100%
Withdrawals and Distributions From the Plan
APPLICABLE FEDERAL LAW REQUIRES THE PLAN TO IMPOSE SUBSTANTIAL
RESTRICTIONS ON THE RIGHT OF A PLAN PARTICIPANT TO WITHDRAW AMOUNTS HELD FOR
HIS OR HER BENEFIT UNDER THE PLAN PRIOR TO THE PARTICIPANT'S TERMINATION OF
EMPLOYMENT WITH THE BANK. A SUBSTANTIAL FEDERAL TAX PENALTY MAY ALSO BE
IMPOSED ON WITHDRAWALS MADE PRIOR TO THE PARTICIPANT'S ATTAINMENT OF AGE
59-1/2, REGARDLESS OF WHETHER SUCH A WITHDRAWAL OCCURS DURING HIS OR HER
EMPLOYMENT WITH THE BANK OR AFTER TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT.
Withdrawals Prior to Termination of Employment. A Participant may make
a withdrawal of all or any portion of the vested amount from his or her
Discretionary Contribution Account, Elective Deferral Account, Qualified
Non-Elective Contribution Account or Rollover Account prior to termination of
employment in the event of financial hardship, subject to the hardship
distribution rules under the Plan. These requirements insure that
Participants have a true financial need before a withdrawal may be made.
Distribution Upon Retirement or Disability. The form of benefit payable
to a Participant who retires, incurs a disability, or otherwise terminates
employment shall be, at the election of the Participant, a lump sum payment
or by payment in a series of equal installments over a period of up to five
(5) years. Benefit payments ordinarily shall commence as soon as practicable
following termination of service but no later than one year after the close
of the Plan Year in which the Participant terminates service upon (i)
attainment of normal retirement age; (ii) disability; or (iii) death of the
Participant. With respect of a 5% owner, benefit payments must commence in
no event later than April 1 following the calendar year in which the
Participant attains age 70-1/2.
Distribution Upon Death. A Participant who dies prior to the benefit
commencement date for retirement, disability or termination of employment
shall have his or her benefits paid to the surviving spouse or beneficiary
under one or more of the forms available under the Plan.
10
<PAGE>
Distribution Upon Termination for Any Other Reason. Distribution of
benefits to a Participant who terminates employment for any other reason
ordinarily shall commence as soon as practicable following termination of
service, but no later than one year after the close of the Plan Year which is
the fifth Plan Year following the year in which the participant's service
terminates.
Nonalienation of Benefits. Except with respect to federal income tax
withholding and as provided with respect to a qualified domestic relations
order (as defined in the Code), benefits payable under the Plan shall not be
subject in any manner to anticipation, alienation, sale, transfer,
assignment, pledge, encumbrance, charge, garnishment, execution, or levy of
any kind, either voluntary or involuntary, and any attempt to anticipate,
alienate, sell, transfer, assign, pledge, encumber, charge or otherwise
dispose of any rights to benefits payable under the Plan shall be void.
Trustee
The Trustee is appointed by the Board of Directors of the Bank to serve
at its pleasure. Despite the consolidation of the 401(k) Plan and the ESOP,
the Bank determined to maintain the separate trust. Skip Martin, James A.
Edington and Dwayne Powell serve as trustees of the 401(k) Trust. N. Ray
Campbell, Marcus Van Camp, Ralph B. Baltz and Charles Ervin serve as trustee
of the ESOP Trust.
The Trustee receives, holds and invests the contributions to the Plan in
trust and distributes them to Participants and beneficiaries in accordance
with the terms of the Plan and the directions of the Plan Administrator. The
Trustee is responsible for investment of the assets of the Trust.
Plan Administrator
Pursuant to the terms of the Plan, the Plan is administered by the plan
administrator (the "Plan Administrator"). CMC Pension Services, Inc. is the
Plan Administrator. The address and telephone number of the Plan
Administrator is c/o 3690 Orange Place, Suite 575, Beachwood, Ohio 44122,
telephone number (216) 595-2300. The Plan Administrator is responsible for
the administration of the Plan, interpretation of the provisions of the Plan,
prescribing procedures for filing applications for benefits, preparation and
distribution of information explaining the Plan, maintenance of plan records,
books of account and all other data necessary for the proper administration
of the Plan, and preparation and filing of all returns and reports relating
to the Plan which are required to be filed with the U.S. Department of Labor
and the IRS, and for all disclosures required to be made to Participants,
beneficiaries, and others under Sections 104 and 105 of ERISA.
Reports to Plan Participants
The Plan Administrator will furnish to each Participant a statement at
least annually showing (i) the balance in the Participant's account as of the
end of that period, (ii) the amount of contributions allocated to such
Participant's account for that period, and (iii) the adjustments to such
Participant's account to reflect earnings or losses (if any).
Amendment and Termination
It is the intention of the Bank to continue the Plan indefinitely.
Nevertheless, the Bank may terminate the Plan at any time. If the Plan is
terminated in whole or in part, then regardless of other provisions in the
Plan, each employee affected by such termination shall have a fully vested
interest in his or her accounts. The Bank reserves the right to make, from
time to time, any amendment or
11
<PAGE>
amendments to the Plan which do not cause any part of the Trust to be used
for, or diverted to, any purpose other than the exclusive benefit of
Participants or their beneficiaries; provided, however, that the Bank may
make any amendment it determines necessary or desirable, with or without
retroactive effect, to comply with ERISA.
Merger, Consolidation or Transfer
In the event of the merger or consolidation of the Plan with another
plan, or the transfer of the Trust assets to another plan, the Plan requires
that each Participant would (if either the Plan or the other plan then
terminated) receive a benefit immediately after the merger, consolidation or
transfer which is equal to or greater than the benefit he or she would have
been entitled to receive immediately before the merger, consolidation or
transfer (if the Plan had then terminated).
Federal Income Tax Consequences
The following is only a brief summary of certain federal income tax
aspects of the Plan which are of general application under the Code and is
not intended to be a complete or definitive description of the federal income
tax consequences of participating in or receiving distributions from the
Plan. The summary is necessarily general in nature and does not purport to be
complete. Moreover, statutory provisions are subject to change, as are their
interpretations, and their application may vary in individual circumstances.
Finally, the consequences under applicable state and local income tax laws
may not be the same as under the federal income tax laws. Participants are
urged to consult their tax advisors with respect to any distribution from the
Plan and transactions involving the Plan.
The Plan is qualified under Sections 401(a), 401(k) and 4975(e) of the
Code and the related Trust is exempt from tax under Section 501(a) of the
Code. A plan that is qualified under these sections of the Code is afforded
special tax treatment which include the following: (1) the Bank is allowed an
immediate tax deduction for the amount contributed to the Plan each year
including contributions made and dividends used to repay principal and
interest on a stock obligation; (2) Participants pay no current income tax on
amounts contributed by the Bank on their behalf; and (3) Earnings of the Plan
are tax-exempt thereby permitting the tax-free accumulation of income and
gains on investments. The Plan will be administered to comply in operation
with the requirements of the Code as of the applicable effective date of any
change in the law. The Bank expects to timely adopt any amendments to the
Plan that may be necessary to maintain the qualified status of the Plan under
the Code.
Assuming that the Plan is administered in accordance with the
requirements of the Code, participation in the Plan under existing federal
income tax laws will have the following effects:
(a) Amounts contributed to a Participant's account and the investment
earnings on the account are not includable in a Participant's federal taxable
income until such contributions or earnings are actually distributed or
withdrawn from the Plan. Special tax treatment may apply to the taxable
portion of any distribution that includes Common Stock or qualifies as a Lump
Sum Distribution (as described below).
12
<PAGE>
(b) Income earned on assets held by the Trust will not be taxable to the
Trust.
Lump Sum Distribution. A distribution from the Plan to a Participant or
the beneficiary of a Participant will qualify as a lump sum distribution
("Lump Sum Distribution") if it is made: (i) within one taxable year of the
Participant or beneficiary; (ii) on account of the Participant's death,
disability or separation from service, or after the Participant attains age
59-1/2; and (ii) consists of the balance to the credit of the Participant
under this Plan and all other profit sharing plans, if any, maintained by the
Bank. The portion of any Lump Sum Distribution that is required to be
included in the Participant's or beneficiary's taxable income for federal
income tax purposes (the"total taxable amount") consists of the entire amount
of such Lump Sum Distribution less the amount of after-tax contributions, if
any, made by the Participant to any other profit sharing plan maintained by
the Bank which is included in such distribution.
Averaging Rules. The portion of the total taxable amount of a Lump Sum
Distribution that is attributable to participation after 1973 in the Plan or
in any other profit-sharing plan maintained by the Bank (the "ordinary income
portion") will be taxable generally as ordinary income for federal income tax
purposes. However, a Participant who has completed at least five years of
participation in the Plan before the taxable year in which the distribution
is made, or a beneficiary who receives a Lump Sum Distribution on account of
the Participant's death (regardless of the period of the Participant's
participation in the Plan or any other profit-sharing plan maintained by the
Bank), may elect to have the ordinary income portion of such Lump Sum
Distribution taxed according to a special averaging rule ("five-year
averaging"). The election of the special averaging rules may apply only to
one Lump Sum Distribution received by the Participant or beneficiary,
provided such amount is received on or after the Participant turns 59-1/2 and
the recipient elects to have any other Lump Sum Distribution from a qualified
plan received in the same taxable year taxed under the special averaging
rule. Under a special grandfather rule, individuals who turned 50 by 1985 may
elect to have their Lump Sum Distribution taxed under either the five-year
averaging rule or under the prior law ten-year averaging rule. Such
individuals also may elect to have that portion of the Lump Sum Distribution
attributable to the Participant's pre-1974 participation in the Plan taxed at
a flat 20% rate as gain from the sale of a capital asset.
Common Stock Included in Lump Sum Distribution. If a Lump Sum
Distribution includes Common Stock, the distribution generally will be taxed
in the manner described above, except that the total taxable amount will be
reduced by the amount of any net unrealized appreciation with respect to such
Common Stock, i.e., the excess of the value of such Common Stock at the time
of the distribution over the cost or other basis to the Trust. The tax basis
of such Common Stock to the Participant or beneficiary for purposes of
computing gain or loss on its subsequent sale will be the value of the Common
Stock at the time of distribution less the amount of net unrealized
appreciation. Any gain on a subsequent sale or other taxable disposition of
such Common Stock, to the extent of the amount of net unrealized appreciation
at the time of distribution, will be considered long-term capital gain
regardless of the holding period of such Common Stock. Any gain on a
subsequent sale or other taxable disposition of the Common Stock in excess of
the amount of net unrealized appreciation at the time of distribution will be
considered short-term, mid-term or long-term capital gain depending upon the
length of the holding period of the Common Stock. The recipient of a
distribution may elect to include the amount of any net unrealized
appreciation in the total taxable amount of such distribution to the extent
allowed by the regulations to be issued by the IRS.
13
<PAGE>
Contribution to Another Qualified Plan or to an IRA. A Participant may
defer federal income taxation of all or any portion of the total taxable
amount of a Lump Sum Distribution (including the proceeds from the sale of
any Common Stock included in the Lump Sum Distribution) to the extent that
such amount, or a portion thereof, is contributed, within 60 days after the
date of its receipt by the Participant, to another qualified plan or to an
individual retirement account ("IRA"). If less than the total taxable amount
of a Lump Sum Distribution is contributed to another qualified plan or to an
IRA within the applicable 60-day period, the amount not so contributed must
be included in the Participant's income for federal income tax purposes and
will not be eligible for the special averaging rules or for capital gains
treatment. Additionally, a Participant may defer the federal income taxation
of any portion of an amount distributed from the Plan on account of the
Participant's disability or separation from service, generally, if the amount
is distributed within one taxable year of the Participant, and such amount is
contributed, within 60 days after the date of its receipt by the Participant,
to an IRA. Prior to 1993, following the partial distribution of a
Participant's account, any remaining balance under the Plan (and the balance
to the credit of the Participant under any other profit sharing plan
sponsored by the Bank) would not be eligible for the special averaging rules
or for capital gains treatment. For these purposes, a "partial distribution"
is a distribution within one taxable year of the Participant equal to at
least 50% of the balance of a Participant's account ("Partial Distribution").
Pursuant to a change in the law, effective January 1, 1993, virtually
all distributions from the Plan may be rolled over to another qualified Plan
or to an IRA without regard to whether the distribution is a Lump Sum
Distribution or a Partial Distribution. Effective January 1, 1993,
Participants have the right to elect to have the Trustee transfer all or any
portion of an "eligible rollover distribution" directly to another plan
qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code or to an IRA. If the Participant
does not elect to have an "eligible rollover distribution" transferred
directly to another qualified plan or to an IRA, the distribution will be
subject to a mandatory federal withholding tax equal to 20% of the taxable
distribution. An "eligible rollover distribution" means any amount
distributed from the Plan except: (1) a distribution that is (a) one of a
series of substantially equal periodic payments made (not less frequently
than annually ) over the Participant's life or the joint life of the
Participant and the Participant's designated beneficiary, or (b) for a
specified period of ten years or more; (2) any amount that is required to be
distributed under the minimum distribution rules; and (3) any other
distributions excepted under applicable federal law.
The beneficiary of a Participant who is the Participant's surviving
spouse also may defer federal income taxation of all or any portion of a
distribution from the Plan to the extent that such amount, or a portion
thereof, is contributed within 60 days after the date of its receipt by the
surviving spouse, to an IRA. If all or any portion of the total taxable
amount of a Lump Sum Distribution is contributed by the surviving spouse of a
Participant to an IRA within the applicable 60-day period, any subsequent
distribution from the IRA will not be eligible for the special averaging
rules or for capital gains treatment. Any amount received by the
Participant's surviving spouse that is not contributed to another qualified
plan or to an IRA within the applicable 60-day period, and any amount
received by a nonspouse beneficiary will be included in such beneficiary's
income for federal tax purposes in the year in which it is received.
Additional Tax on Early Distributions. A Participant who receives a
distribution from the Plan prior to attaining age 59 1/2 will be subject to
an additional income tax equal to 10% of the taxable amount of the
distribution. The 10% additional income tax will not apply, however, to the
14
<PAGE>
extent the distribution is rolled over into an IRA or another qualified plan
or the distribution is (i) made to a beneficiary (or to the estate or a
Participant) on or after the death of the Participant, (ii) attributable to
the Participant's being disabled within the meaning of Section 72(m)(7) of
the Code, (iii) part of a series of substantially equal periodic payments
(not less frequently than annually) made for the life (or life expectancy) of
the Participant or the joint lives (or joint life expectancies) of the
Participant and his beneficiary, (iv) made to the Participant after
separation from service on account of early retirement under the Plan after
attainment of age 55, (v) made to pay medical expenses to the extent
deductible for federal income tax purposes, (vi) payments made to an
alternate payee pursuant to a qualified domestic relations order, or (vii)
made to effect the distribution of excess contributions or excess deferrals.
ERISA and Other Qualifications
As noted above, the Plan is subject to certain provisions of the ERISA
and has applied for a favorable determination that it is qualified under
Section 401(a) of the Code.
The foregoing is only a brief summary of certain federal income tax
aspects of the Plan which are of general application under the Code and is
not intended to be a complete or definitive description of the federal income
tax consequences of participating in or receiving distributions from the
Plan. Accordingly, each Participant is urged to consult a tax advisor
concerning the federal, state and local tax consequences of participating in
and receiving distributions from the Plan.
SEC Reporting and Short-Swing Profit Liability
Section 16 of the Exchange Act imposes reporting and liability
requirements on officers, directors, and persons beneficially owning more
than 10% of public companies such as the Company. Section 16(a) of the
Exchange Act requires the filing of reports of beneficial ownership. Within
10 days of becoming a person subject to the reporting requirements of Section
16(a), a Form 3 reporting initial beneficial ownership must be filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") . Certain changes in beneficial
ownership, such as purchases, sales and gifts must be reported periodically,
either on a Form 4 within 10 days after the end of the month in which a
change occurs, or annually on a Form 5 within 45 days after the close of the
Company's fiscal year. Certain discretionary transactions in and beneficial
ownership of the Common Stock through the Employer Stock Fund of the Plan by
officers, directors and persons beneficially owning more than 10% of the
Common Stock of the Company must be reported to the SEC by such individuals.
In addition to the reporting requirements described above, Section 16(b)
of the Exchange Act as provides for the recovery by the Company of profits
realized by an officer, director or any person beneficially owning more than
10% of the Company's Common Stock ("Section 16(b) Persons") resulting from
non-exempt purchases and sales of the Company's Common Stock within any
six-month period.
The SEC has adopted rules that provide exemption from the profit
recovery provisions of Section 16(b) for all transactions in employer
securities within an employee benefit plan, such as the Plan, provided
certain requirements are met. These requirements generally involve
restrictions upon the timing of elections to acquire or dispose of employer
securities for the accounts of Section
15
<PAGE>
16(b) Persons.
Except for distributions of Common Stock due to death, disability,
retirement, termination of employment or under a qualified domestic relations
order, Section 16(b) Persons are required to hold shares of Common Stock
distributed from the Plan for six months following such distribution and are
prohibited from directing additional purchases of units within the Employer
Stock Fund for six months after receiving such a distribution.
Financial Information Regarding Plan Assets
Financial statements for the 401(k) Plan and the ESOP for the year
ending September 30, 1997 are attached to the Prospectus. The financial
statements were prepared by CMC Pension Services, Inc.
LEGAL OPINION
The validity of the issuance of the Common Stock will be passed upon by
Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, A Professional Corporation, Washington,
D.C., which firm acted as special counsel to the Bank in connection with the
Company's Conversion from a mutual savings bank to a stock based organization
and the concurrent formation of the Company.
16
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS & LOAN
401(k) PROFIT SHARING PLAN
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR PLAN BENEFITS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
September 30
1997 1996
------------------------- --------------------------
Carrying Market Carrying Market
Value Value Value Value
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
ASSETS
Cash and equivalents $ 86,752 $ 86,752 $ 60,364 $ 60,364
Participant loans 79,693 79,693 68,624 68,624
RECEIVABLE
Employer contribution 109,695 109,695 65,067 65,067
Loan payments 2,191 2,191 2,228 2,228
Employee salary deferral 3,805 3,805 3,825 3,825
CORPORATE EQUITY SECURITIES
Pocahontas Federal Savings &
Loan Assoc. Stock - 4700 shares 59,925 155,100 59,925 66,975
MUTUAL FUNDS
6582.046/5511.611 shs ML Basic Value 189,297 246,366 152,174 160,498
8829.654/7239.695 shs ML Capital Fund 273,330 306,654 222,767 216,394
7219.716/5880.771 shs ML Growth Fund 161,076 226,049 125,200 136,669
OPPENHEIMER "B"
3524.8991/3283.3382 shares 80,554 123,618 73,492 95,480
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
TOTAL ASSETS $1,046,318 $1,339,923 $ 833,666 $ 876,124
LIABILITIES
Loan fees payable 500 500 0 0
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES 500 500 0 0
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE
FOR PLAN BENEFITS $1,045,818 $1,339,423 $ 833,666 $ 876,124
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
</TABLE>
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS & LOAN
401(k) PROFIT SHARING PLAN
CHANGES IN NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR PLAN BENEFITS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
For Plan Years Ended September 30
1997 1996
------------------------- --------------------------
Carrying Market Carrying Market
Value Value Value Value
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
ADDITIONS
Employer contribution $ 109,695 $ 109,695 $ 43,756 $ 43,756
Employer contribution 45,212 45,212 65,067 65,067
Investment income 66,709 66,709 60,216 60,216
Unrealized appreciation of plan assets 0 252,108 0 25,937
Realized gain on sale of assets 5,888 4,927 2,470 1,894
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
TOTAL ADDITIONS $ 227,504 $ 478,651 $ 171,509 $ 196,870
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
REDUCTIONS
Distributions to plan participants 15,202 15,202 32,481 32,481
Administrative expense 150 150 0 0
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
TOTAL REDUCTIONS $ 15,352 $ 15,352 $ 32,481 $ 32,481
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Net Increase (Decrease) $ 212,152 $ 463,299 $ 139,028 $ 164,389
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE
FOR PLAN BENEFITS
Beginning of Year 833,666 876,124 694,638 711,735
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
End of Year $1,045,818 $1,339,423 $ 833,666 $ 765,124
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
</TABLE>
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS & LOAN
EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR PLAN BENEFITS
September 30
1997 1996
------------------------- ------------------------
Carrying Market Carrying Market
Value Value Value Value
----------- ----------- ---------- ----------
ASSETS
Cash and equivalents $ 50,625 $ 50,625 $ 19,711 $ 19,711
EMPLOYER SECURITIES 522,240 1,723,392 523,250 745,631
-------- ---------- -------- --------
TOTAL ASSETS $572,865 $1,774,017 $542,961 $765,342
LIABILITIES
Acquisition Indebtedness 104,650 104,650 209,300 209,300
Collateral Stock 0 240,695 0 88,953
-------- ---------- -------- --------
TOTAL LIABILITIES $104,650 $ 345,345 $209,300 $298,253
-------- ---------- -------- --------
-------- ---------- -------- --------
NET ASSETS AVAILABLE
FOR PLAN BENEFITS $468,215 $1,428,672 $333,661 $467,089
-------- ---------- -------- --------
-------- ---------- -------- --------
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS & LOAN
EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN
CHANGES IN NET ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR PLAN BENEFITS
For Plan Years Ended September 30
1997 1996
------------------------- ------------------------
Carrying Market Carrying Market
Value Value Value Value
----------- ----------- ---------- ----------
ADDITIONS
Employer contribution $104,650 $ 104,650 $104,882 $104,882
Investment income 46,391 46,391 29,593 29,593
Unrealized appreciation
of plan assets 0 828,039 0 52,324
-------- ---------- -------- --------
TOTAL ADDITIONS $151,041 $ 979,080 $134,475 $186,799
-------- ---------- -------- --------
REDUCTIONS
Interest expense $ 13,471 $ 13,471 $ 16,340 $ 16,340
Distributions to plan
participants 3,016 4,026 0 0
-------- ---------- -------- --------
TOTAL REDUCTIONS $ 16,487 $ 17,497 $ 16,340 $ 16,340
-------- ---------- -------- --------
Net Increase (Decrease) $134,554 $ 961,583 $118,135 $170,459
NET ASSETS AVAIALBLE
FOR PLAN BENEFITS
Beginning of Year 333,661 467,089 215,526 296,630
-------- ---------- -------- --------
End of Year $468,215 $1,428,672 $333,661 $467,089
-------- ---------- -------- --------
-------- ---------- -------- --------
<PAGE>
PROSPECTUS
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
(Proposed Holding Company for Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association)
Up to 2,875,000 Shares of Common Stock
(Anticipated Maximum)
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), is
offering up to 2,875,000 shares (subject to adjustment to up to 3,306,250
shares as described herein) of its common stock, par value $.01 per share
(the "Common Stock"), in connection with the conversion of Pocahontas Federal
Mutual Holding Company (the "Mutual Holding Company"), from a federally
chartered mutual holding company to a Delaware stock corporation pursuant to
a Plan of Conversion and Reorganization (the "Plan of Conversion"). As of
October 31, 1997, the Mutual Holding Company held no material assets except
for $461,000 in cash or cash equivalents and 862,500 shares, or 52.8%, of the
common stock ("Bank Common Stock") of Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan
Association (the "Bank"), a federal stock savings association. The remaining
769,924 shares, or 47.2% (the "Minority Ownership Percentage"), of the Bank
Common Stock (the "Minority Shares") were publicly owned by stockholders
including the Bank's employees, directors, and stock benefit plans (together,
the "Minority Stockholders"). After the Conversion (as defined herein), the
Company will be the sole stockholder of the Bank.
FOR INFORMATION ON HOW TO SUBSCRIBE,
CALL THE STOCK CENTER AT ( )
---------------------------
FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN FACTORS THAT SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY EACH
PROSPECTIVE INVESTOR, SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE .
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION, THE OFFICE OF THRIFT SUPERVISION, OR ANY
OTHER FEDERAL AGENCY OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION, NOR
HAS SUCH COMMISSION, OFFICE OR OTHER AGENCY OR ANY STATE
SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR
ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION
TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
ESTIMATED UNDERWRITING ESTIMATED
COMMISSIONS AND OTHER NET CASH
SUBSCRIPTION PRICE (1) FEES AND EXPENSES(2) PROCEEDS (3)
-------------------- --------------------------- --------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
Minimum Per Share......................... $ 10.00 $ .29 $ 9.71
Midpoint Per Share........................ 10.00 .26 9.74
Maximum Per Share......................... 10.00 .24 9.76
Maximum Per Share (as adjusted)........... 10.00 .22 9.78
Minimum Total............................. $ 21,250,000 $ 618,000 $ 20,632,000
Midpoint Total............................ 25,000,000 652,500 24,347,500
Maximum Total............................. 28,750,000 687,000 28,063,000
Maximum Total, as adjusted (4)............ 33,062,500 726,675 32,335,825
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Based on (i) the independent appraisal prepared by RP Financial, Inc. ("RP
Financial") dated December 12, 1997, which states that the estimated pro
forma market value of the Common Stock ranged from $40,219,142 to
$54,414,133 (subject to adjustment to $62,576,253), and (ii) the Minority
Ownership Percentage pursuant to which 52.8% of the to-be outstanding
shares of Common Stock will be offered as Subscription Shares in the
Offering. See "The Conversion--Share Exchange Ratio," and "--Stock Pricing
and Number of Shares to be Issued."
(2) Consists of the estimated costs of the Conversion, including estimated
fixed expenses of $422,500 and marketing fees to be paid to Friedman,
Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc. Actual expenses may vary from these
estimates. See "Pro Forma Data" for the assumptions used in arriving at
these estimates.
(3) Includes proceeds from the sale of shares of Common Stock in the Offering
to the Bank's 401(k) savings and employee stock ownership plan and trust
(the "KSOP"). The ESOP portion of the KSOP intends to purchase 8% of the
shares sold in the Offering. Funds to purchase such shares will be loaned
to the ESOP portion of the KSOP by the Company, which may fund such loan
with offering proceeds. The Bank intends to repay the loan with funds
from future operations. See "The Conversion--Plan of Distribution and
Selling Commissions" and "Management of the Bank--Benefit Plans."
(4) As adjusted to give effect to the sale of up to an additional 15% of the
shares that may be offered without a resolicitation of subscribers or any
right of cancellation. See "The Conversion--Stock Pricing and Number of
Shares to be Issued."
FRIEDMAN, BILLINGS, RAMSEY & CO., INC.
The date of this Prospectus is February , 1998
<PAGE>
Of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby, (i) up to 2,875,000 shares
(subject to adjustment to up to 3,306,250 shares) of Common Stock (the
"Subscription Shares") are being offered for a subscription price of
$10.00 per share (the "Subscription Price") in a subscription and
community offering as described below, and (ii) up to 2,566,413 shares
(subject to adjustment to up to 2,951,375 shares) of Common Stock (the
"Exchange Shares") will be issued to Minority Stockholders pursuant to an
Agreement of Merger, whereby Minority Shares shall automatically, without
further action by the holder thereof, be converted into and become a
right to receive shares of Common Stock (the "Share Exchange"). See "The
Conversion--Share Exchange Ratio." The simultaneous conversion of the
Mutual Holding Company to stock form pursuant to the Plan of Conversion,
the exchange of all of the Minority Shares for Common Stock, and the
offer and sale of Subscription Shares pursuant to the Plan of Conversion
are herein referred to collectively as the "Conversion."
Non-transferable rights to subscribe for Common Stock in a subscription
offering (the "Subscription Offering") have been granted, in order of
priority, to the following: (i) depositors of the Bank with account
balances of $50 or more as of September 30, 1996 (the "Eligibility Record
Date," and such account holders "Eligible Account Holders"); (ii) the
Bank's 401(k) savings and employee stock ownership plan and related trust
(the "KSOP") in an amount up to 8% of the shares sold in the Offering;
(iii) depositors with aggregate account balances of $50 or more as of
December 31, 1997 (the "Supplemental Eligibility Record Date") who are
not Eligible Account Holders ("Supplemental Eligible Account Holders");
(iv) members of the Mutual Holding Company as of January 21, 1998 (the
"Voting Record Date") who are not Eligible Account Holders or
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders ("Other Members"); and (v) to the
extent shares of Common Stock remain available after satisfying the
subscription rights of Eligible Account Holders, the KSOP, Supplemental
Eligible Account Holders and Other Members, to Minority Stockholders.
Subscription rights are nontransferable; persons found to be transferring
subscription rights will be subject to the forfeiture of such rights and
possible further sanctions and penalties imposed by the OTS. Subject to
the prior rights of holders of subscription rights, the Company is
offering the shares of Common Stock not subscribed for in the
Subscription Offering for sale in a concurrent community offering (the
"Community Offering") to certain members of the general public with
preference given to natural persons residing in counties in which the
Bank has its home office or a branch office (the "Community"). The
Company retains the right, in its discretion, to accept or reject any
order in the Community Offering. The Subscription Offering and Community
Offering are referred to collectively as the "Offering." Unless otherwise
specifically provided, the term "Offering" does not include the shares of
Common Stock that will be issued in the Share Exchange.
The minimum number of shares that may be purchased is 25 shares. Except
for the KSOP, no Eligible Account Holder, Supplemental Eligible Account
Holder, Other Member or Minority Stockholder may in their capacities as such
purchase in the Subscription Offering more than 30,000 Subscription Shares;
no person, together with associates of and persons acting in concert with
such person, may purchase in the Offering more than 30,000 Subscription
Shares; and no person together with associates of and persons acting in
concert with such person may purchase in the aggregate more than the number
of Subscription Shares that when combined with Exchange Shares received by
such person together with associates of and persons acting in concert with
such person exceeds 100,000 shares, provided, however, that the maximum
purchase limitation may be increased or decreased at the sole discretion of
the Company and the Bank. See "The Conversion--Subscription Offering and
Subscription Rights," "--Community Offering" and "--Limitations on Common
Stock Purchases."
The Subscription Offering and Community Offering will terminate at noon,
Central time, on March 18, 1998 (the "Expiration Date") unless
extended by the Bank and the Company, with the approval of the OTS, if
necessary. The Bank and the Company may determine to extend the Subscription
Offering and/or the Community Offering for any reason, whether or not
subscriptions have been received for shares at the minimum, midpoint, or
maximum of the Offering Range, and are not required to give subscribers
notice of any such extension. The Community Offering must be completed within
45 days after the expiration of the Subscription Offering unless extended by
the Bank and the Company with the approval of the OTS, if necessary. Orders
submitted are irrevocable until the completion of the Conversion; provided
that all subscribers will have their funds returned promptly, with interest,
and all withdrawal authorizations will be canceled if the Conversion is not
completed within 45 days after the expiration of the Subscription Offering,
unless such period has been extended with the consent of the OTS, if
necessary. See "The Conversion--Subscription Offering and Subscription
Rights" and "--Procedure for Purchasing Shares in Subscription and Community
Offerings."
The Bank Common Stock is currently traded on the Nasdaq "SmallCap"
Market. The Company applied to have its Common Stock listed on the Nasdaq
National Market under the Bank's previous symbol "PFSL." Friedman, Billings,
Ramsey & Co., Inc. ("FBR") has advised the Company that upon completion of
the Conversion, it intends to act as a market maker in the Common Stock,
depending upon the volume of trading and subject to compliance with
applicable laws and regulatory requirements. FBR will assist the Company in
obtaining additional
2
<PAGE>
market makers, but there can be no assurance that additional market makers
will be identified or that the Company's application for listing on the
Nasdaq National Market will be approved. See "Market for Common Stock."
3
<PAGE>
[INSERT MAP]
THE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK OFFERED HEREBY ARE NOT SAVINGS ACCOUNTS OR
DEPOSITS AND ARE NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION
("FDIC"), THE BANK INSURANCE FUND ("BIF"), THE SAVINGS ASSOCIATION INSURANCE
FUND ("SAIF") OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENT AGENCY.
4
<PAGE>
SUMMARY
The following summary does not purport to be complete, and is qualified
in its entirety by the more detailed information including the "Recent
Developments" section and Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto
of the Bank appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus.
THE COMPANY
The Company was organized in December 1997 by the Bank for the purpose of
owning all of the capital stock of the Bank upon completion of the
Conversion. Immediately following the Conversion, the only significant assets
of the Company will be the capital stock of the Bank and that percentage of
the Offering proceeds retained by the Company. See "The Company" and
"Regulation--Holding Company Regulation."
THE MUTUAL HOLDING COMPANY
The Mutual Holding Company is a federal mutual holding company that was
organized on December 31, 1991 in connection with the mutual holding company
reorganization of the Bank's mutual savings association predecessor. The
Mutual Holding Company has no material assets other than $461,000 in cash or
cash equivalents, and the Bank Common Stock. Accordingly, all financial and
other information contained in this Prospectus relates to the business,
financial condition, and results of operations of the Bank. Upon consummation
of the Conversion, the Mutual Holding Company will convert from mutual to
stock form and simultaneously merge with and into the Bank. See "The
Conversion."
THE BANK
The Bank is a community-oriented savings institution headquartered in
Pocahontas, Arkansas that operates nine full-service offices in its market
area consisting of the Arkansas counties of Randolph, Lawrence, Craighead,
Sharp and Clay. The Bank is primarily engaged in the business of originating
single-family residential mortgage loans funded with deposits, FHLB advances
and securities sold under agreements to repurchase. The Bank's $383.4 million
of total assets at September 30, 1997 included $159.7 million of loans
receivable, net, or 41.7% of total assets, and $200.6 million of investment
securities, or 52.3% of total assets. The Bank's net loan portfolio consists
primarily of first mortgage loans collateralized by single-family residential
real estate and, to a lesser extent, multifamily residential real estate,
commercial real estate and agricultural real estate loans. At September 30,
1997, the Bank's net loan portfolio totaled $159.7 million, of which $138.5
million, or 86.8% were single-family residential real estate mortgage loans,
$1.6 million, or 1.0%, were multifamily residential real estate loans, $9.6
million, or 6.0%, were commercial real estate loans (including land loans),
and $4.7 million, or 2.9%, were agricultural real estate loans. The remainder
of the Bank's loans at September 30, 1997 included commercial business loans
(i.e., crop production, equipment and livestock loans) which totaled $6.5
million, or 4.1%, of the Bank's total net loan portfolio as of September 30,
1997. Other loans, including automobile loans and loans collateralized by
deposit accounts, totaled $3.8 million, or 2.3%, of the Bank's net loan
portfolio as of September 30, 1997. The Bank also maintains a significant
portion of its assets in mortgage-backed securities. At September 30, 1997,
mortgage-backed securities aggregated $168.8 million, or 44.0%, of the Bank's
total assets. The Bank's investment portfolio also includes obligations of
the United States Government and agencies, municipal bonds and interest
earning deposits in other institutions. The carrying value of this portion of
the Bank's investment portfolio totaled $31.7 million at September 30, 1997.
In January 1998, the Bank purchased three full-service branch offices,
which increased the number of the Bank's branch offices to nine. The purchase
included an aggregate of $ in deposits, as well as the buildings and
land at each branch location. The newly acquired branches are located in
Walnut Ridge, Hardy and Lake City in Arkansas and supplement the Bank's
existing branches in Lawrence, Sharp and Craighead Counties.
5
<PAGE>
Financial highlights of the Bank include the following:
- Profitability. The Bank had net income of $2.4 million, $2.0 million
and $1.9 million for the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996
and 1995, respectively. The Bank's return on average equity ratios for
the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995 were 10.07%,
8.98% and 9.58%, respectively. The earnings of the Bank depend
primarily on its level of net interest income, which is a function of
the Bank's interest rate spread as well as a function of the average
balance of interest-earning assets as compared to the average balance
of interest-bearing liabilities. For the fiscal year ended September
30, 1997, the Bank's ratio of average interest-earning assets to
average interest-bearing liabilities was 104.09%.
- Net Interest Margin. The Bank's net income is affected by its net
interest margin (net interest income as a percent of average
interest-earning assets) which was 2.04%, 1.89% and 1.85% for the
fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively.
- Asset Quality. The Bank's ratio of nonperforming loans to net loans was
0.28%, 0.74% and 0.43% at September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995,
respectively.
- Retail Deposit Base. The Bank draws retail deposits from nine
full-service branch offices in its market area. The Bank does not
solicit or accept brokered deposits. As a result of the purchase by the
Bank in January 1998 of three full-service branch offices, the Bank's
deposits increased by $28.0 million, of which $15.8 million consisted
of certificates of deposit.
- Interest Rate Risk Management. The Bank has sought to manage its
interest rate risk exposure by emphasizing the origination of ARM loans
and by generally selling into the secondary mortgage market fixed rate
mortgage loans with maturities greater than 15 years. At September 30,
1997, ARM loans constituted 73.8% of the Bank's total net loan
portfolio. In addition, the Bank invests in floating rate
mortgage-backed securities, which comprised 89.9% of the Bank's total
portfolio of mortgage-backed securities as of September 30, 1997.
Finally, the Bank purchases interest rate caps in an effort to mitigate
the effects of interest rate fluctuations.
The Bank's executive offices are located at 203 West Broadway, Pocahontas,
Arkansas, and its telephone number at that location is (870) 892-4595.
THE CONVERSION
GENERAL. On October 14, 1997, the Board of Directors of the Mutual
Holding Company unanimously adopted the Plan of Conversion and
Reorganization, which plan was subsequently amended on February , 1998
(the "Plan of Conversion"), pursuant to which the Mutual Holding Company is
converting from a federally chartered mutual holding company to a
Delaware-chartered stock corporation. As part of the Conversion each of the
issued and outstanding Minority Shares shall automatically, without further
action by the holder thereof, be converted into and become a right to receive
a number of shares of Common Stock determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio.
See "The Conversion--Share Exchange Ratio."
REASONS FOR THE CONVERSION. The Board of Directors unanimously
determined to conduct the Conversion because it believed that the market for
equity securities in financial services companies was at an unprecedented
level and that the Bank (together with the Company, the "Converted
Institution") could raise substantial funds from such a transaction. The
Board of Directors believed that maximizing such proceeds is in the best
interests of the Converted Institution because such proceeds can be used to
increase the net income of the Converted Institution though investment and
eventual deployment of the proceeds, and support the possible expansion of
the Bank's existing franchise through internal growth or the acquisition of
branch offices or other financial institutions. Management believed that
acquisition opportunities would increase as a result of the Conversion
because the Converted Institution would have
6
<PAGE>
substantially more capital following the Conversion. The Bank acquired three
branch offices in January 1998, and intends to actively explore additional
acquisitions, although neither the Company nor the Bank has any specific
plans, arrangements or understandings regarding any additional expansions or
acquisitions at this time, nor have criteria been established to identify
potential candidates for acquisition. In addition, the Board considered that
there was no assurance that the pricing for financial services stocks would
continue at such favorable levels, and that if the market were to become less
favorable, the amount of capital that could be raised in the Conversion might
be substantially reduced. See "Risk Factors-- Potential Low Return on Equity"
and " Uncertainty as to Future Growth Opportunities." See "The
Conversion--Purposes of Conversion."
APPROVALS REQUIRED. The affirmative vote of a majority of the total
eligible votes of the members of the Mutual Holding Company at the Special
Meeting of Members to be held on March 20, 1998 (the "Special Meeting of
Members") is required to approve the Plan of Conversion and the transactions
incident to the Conversion. The affirmative vote of the holders of at least
(i) two-thirds of the outstanding common stock of the Bank, and (ii) a
majority of the Minority Shares at a special meeting of stockholders of the
Bank to be held on March 20, 1998 (the "Special Meeting of Stockholders")
is required to approve the Plan of Conversion. Consummation of the Conversion
is also subject to the approval of the OTS.
EFFECTIVE DATE. The date upon which the Conversion is consummated.
Share Exchange Ratio. OTS regulations and policy provide that in a
conversion of a mutual holding company to stock form, stockholders other than
the mutual holding company will be entitled to exchange their shares of
subsidiary savings bank common stock for common stock of the converted
holding company, provided that the bank and the mutual holding company
demonstrate to the satisfaction of the OTS that the basis for the exchange is
fair and reasonable. The Boards of Directors of the Bank and the Company have
determined that each Minority Share will on the Effective Date be
automatically converted into and become the right to receive a number of
Exchange Shares determined pursuant an exchange ratio (the "Exchange Ratio")
which was established as the ratio that ensures that after the Conversion,
subject to a slight adjustment to reflect the receipt of cash in lieu of
fractional shares, the percentage of the to-be outstanding shares of Common
Stock issued to Minority Stockholders in exchange for their Minority Shares
will be equal to the percentage of the Bank Common Stock held by Minority
Stockholders immediately prior to the Conversion. The total number of shares
held by Minority Stockholders after the Conversion would also be affected by
any purchases by such persons in the Offering.
The following table sets forth, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum, and
adjusted maximum of the Offering Range, the following: (i) the total number
of Subscription Shares and Exchange Shares to be issued in the Conversion,
(ii) the percentage of Common Stock outstanding after the Conversion that
will be sold in the Offering and issued in the Share Exchange, and (iii) the
Exchange Ratio.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
SUBSCRIPTION SHARES EXCHANGE SHARES TOTAL SHARES
TO BE ISSUED TO BE ISSUED OF COMMON
-------------------- --------------------- STOCK TO BE EXCHANGE
AMOUNT PERCENT AMOUNT PERCENT OUTSTANDING RATIO
------------------ ----------------- ----------- ----------- ------------- -------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Minimum.............................. 2,125,000 52.836 1,896,914 47.164 4,021,914 2.4638
Midpoint............................. 2,500,000 52.836 2,231,663 47.164 4,731,663 2.8983
Maximum.............................. 2,875,000 52.836 2,566,413 47.164 5,441,413 3.3333
Adjusted maximum..................... 3,306,250 52.836 2,951,375 47.164 6,257,625 3.8333
</TABLE>
The Bank will pay cash to Minority Stockholders for fractional shares.
Options to purchase Minority Shares will also be converted into and become
options to purchase Common Stock. The number of shares of Common Stock to be
received upon exercise of such options will be determined pursuant to the
Exchange Ratio. The aggregate
7
<PAGE>
exercise price, duration, and vesting schedule of such options will not be
affected. See "The Conversion--Share Exchange Ratio."
EFFECT ON STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY PER SHARE OF THE SHARES EXCHANGED. The
Conversion will increase the stockholders' equity of Minority Stockholders.
At September 30, 1997, the stockholders' equity per share was $14.85 for each
share of Bank Common Stock outstanding, including shares held by the Mutual
Holding Company. Based on the pro forma information set forth in "Pro Forma
Data," assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock at the midpoint
of the Offering Range, the pro forma stockholders' equity per share of Common
Stock was $9.73 and the aggregate pro forma stockholders' equity for the
number of Exchange Shares to be received for each Minority Share was $28.20.
The pro forma stockholders' equity for the aggregate number of Exchange
Shares to be received for each Minority Share was $26.21, $30.20, and $32.51
at the minimum, maximum, and maximum, as adjusted, of the Offering Range.
EFFECT ON EARNINGS PER SHARE OF THE SHARES EXCHANGED. The Conversion
will also affect Minority Stockholders' pro forma earnings per share. For the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, the earnings per share was $1.46 for
each share of Bank Common Stock outstanding, including shares held by the
Mutual Holding Company. Based on the pro forma information set forth in "Pro
Forma Data," assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock at the
midpoint of the Offering Range, the pro forma earnings per share of Common
Stock was $0.63 for such period, and the aggregate pro forma earnings for the
number of Exchange Shares to be received for each Minority Share was $1.83.
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, the aggregate pro forma
earnings for the number of Exchange Shares to be received for each Minority
Share was $1.77, $1.83, and $1.92 at the minimum, maximum, and maximum, as
adjusted, of the Offering Range.
EFFECT ON DIVIDENDS PER SHARE. The Company's Board of Directors
anticipates declaring and paying quarterly cash dividends on the Common Stock
equal to $1.5 million, or $0.373, $0.317, $0.276 and $0.240 per share of
Common Stock on an annual basis, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and
maximum, as adjusted, of the Offering Range, respectively. Dividends, when
and if paid, will be subject to determination and declaration by the Board of
Directors in its discretion, which will take into account the Company's
consolidated financial condition and results of operations, tax
considerations, industry standards, economic conditions, regulatory
restrictions on dividend payments by the Bank to the Company, general
business practices and other factors. See "Dividend Policy." The Bank has
paid a quarterly cash dividend to Minority Stockholders for each of the full
fiscal quarters since the Minority Stock Offering in April 1994. See "Market
for Common Stock" and "Regulation and Supervision--Federal Regulation of
Savings Institutions--Limitation on Capital Distributions." The Bank intends
to continue to pay a quarterly cash dividend of $0.225 per share through the
fiscal quarter ending March 31, 1998. The Mutual Holding Company intends to
waive the receipt of such dividends.
EFFECT ON THE MARKET AND APPRAISED VALUE OF THE SHARES EXCHANGED. The
aggregate Subscription Price of the shares of Common Stock received in
exchange for the Minority Shares is $19.0 million, $22.3 million, $25.7
million, and $30.0 million at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and adjusted
maximum of the Offering Range. The last trade of Bank Common Stock on
September 17, 1997, the day preceding the announcement of the Conversion, was
$28.00 per share, and the price at which Bank Common Stock last traded on
February , 1998, was $ per share.
DISSENTERS' AND APPRAISAL RIGHTS. Under OTS regulations, Minority
Stockholders will not have dissenters' rights or appraisal rights in
connection with the exchange of Minority Shares for shares of Common Stock of
the Company.
TAX CONSEQUENCES OF CONVERSION. The Bank will receive an opinion of
counsel with regard to federal income taxation and will receive an opinion of
counsel or tax advisor with regard to Arkansas taxation, which will indicate
that the adoption and implementation of the Plan of Conversion will not be
taxable for federal or Arkansas income tax purposes to the Bank, the Mutual
Holding Company, the Minority Stockholders, members of the Mutual Holding
Company or the Company. Consummation of the Conversion is conditioned upon
prior receipt by the Bank of such opinions. See "The Conversion--Tax Aspects."
8
<PAGE>
EXCHANGE OF COMPANY STOCK CERTIFICATES. Until the Effective Date, the
Minority Shares will continue to be available for trading on the Nasdaq
"SmallCap" Market. The exchange and conversion of Minority Shares for shares
of the Common Stock will occur automatically on the Effective Date. After the
Effective Date, former holders of the Bank Common Stock will have no further
equity interest in the Bank (other than as stockholders of the Company) and
there will be no further transfers of the Bank Common Stock on its stock
transfer records. For persons holding Minority Shares in street name, the
conversion of Minority Shares to shares of Common Stock will occur without
any action on the part of such stockholder. For persons holding certificated
shares, as soon as practicable after the Effective Date, the Company, or a
transfer agent, bank or trust company designated by the Company, in the
capacity of exchange agent (the "Exchange Agent"), will send a transmittal
form to each Minority Stockholder of record as of the Effective Date. The
transmittal forms are expected to be mailed within five business days after
the Effective Date and will contain instructions with respect to the
surrender of certificates representing the Bank Common Stock ("Converted Bank
Common Stock Certificates"). It is expected that certificates for shares of
the Company's Common Stock will be distributed within five business days
after the receipt of properly executed transmittal forms and other required
documents. See "The Conversion--Exchange of Certificates." BANK STOCKHOLDERS
SHOULD NOT FORWARD STOCK CERTIFICATES TO THE BANK OR THE EXCHANGE AGENT
UNTIL THEY HAVE RECEIVED TRANSMITTAL FORMS.
THE SUBSCRIPTION AND COMMUNITY OFFERINGS
Up to 2,875,000 Subscription Shares (subject to adjustment to up to
3,306,250 shares) will be offered for a subscription price of $10.00 per
share (the "Subscription Price") in the Subscription Offering and, to the
extent shares remain available for sale, in the Community Offering which is
being conducted concurrently with the Subscription Offering (together, the
"Offering"). Common Stock offered in the Subscription Offering shall be
offered in the following order of priority to: (i) Eligible Account Holders;
(ii) the Bank's KSOP in an amount up to 8% of the shares sold in the
Offering; (iii) Supplemental Eligible Account Holders; (iv) Other Members;
and (v) Minority Stockholders.
Common Stock not subscribed for in the Subscription Offering will be
offered in the Community Offering to certain members of the general public,
with preference given, in the Bank's discretion, to natural persons residing
in the Community. The Company and the Bank reserve the absolute right to
reject or accept any orders in the Community Offering, in whole or in part,
either at the time of receipt of an order or as soon as practicable following
the Expiration Date. The Bank and the Company have hired FBR as consultant
and advisor in the Conversion and to assist in soliciting subscriptions in
the Offering. See "The Conversion--Subscription Offering and Subscription
Rights" and "--Community Offering."
The Subscription Offering and Community Offering will terminate at noon,
Central time, on March 18, 1998 (the "Expiration Date") unless extended
by the Bank and the Company, with the approval of the OTS, if necessary. The
Bank and the Company may determine to extend the Subscription Offering and/or
the Community Offering for any reason, whether or not subscriptions have been
received for shares at the minimum, midpoint, or maximum of the Offering
Range, and are not required to give subscribers notice of any such extension.
The Community Offering must be completed within 45 days after the expiration
of the Subscription Offering unless extended by the Bank and the Company with
the approval of the OTS, if necessary.
PROSPECTUS DELIVERY AND PROCEDURE FOR PURCHASING SHARES
To ensure that each purchaser receives a Prospectus at least 48 hours
prior to the Expiration Date, Prospectuses may not be mailed later than five
days prior to such date or be hand delivered later than two days prior to
such date. Order forms and certification forms may only be distributed with a
Prospectus. Execution of a stock order form will confirm receipt or delivery
of the Prospectus. The Bank will accept for processing only properly
completed stock order forms including a signed certification. The Bank will
not be required to accept orders submitted on photocopied or facsimilied
stock order forms. Payment by check, bank draft, certified or teller's check,
money
9
<PAGE>
order, or debit authorization to an existing passbook or certificate of
deposit account at the Bank must accompany each stock order form. See "The
Conversion-- Procedure for Purchasing Shares."
To ensure that each prospective purchaser is properly identified as to
his stock purchase priority, depositors as of the Eligibility Record Date and
Supplemental Eligibility Record Date must list all accounts on the stock
order form giving all names in each account and the account number. In
addition, shareholders of the Bank should list the number of shares held as
of January 21, 1998. Failure to list all accounts or shares may result in a
subscriber's loss of subscription rights. Individuals qualifying for a stock
purchase priority who add individuals with a lower, or no, stock purchase
priority as subscribers on an order form will have their stock purchase
priority reduced or eliminated, based on the priority, if any, of the added
name(s).
RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER OF SUBSCRIPTION RIGHTS AND SHARES
No person may transfer or enter into any agreement or understanding to
transfer the legal or beneficial ownership of the subscription rights issued
under the Plan of Conversion or the shares of Common Stock to be issued upon
their exercise. Each person exercising subscription rights will be required
to certify that a purchase of Common Stock is solely for the purchaser's own
account and that there is no agreement or understanding regarding the sale or
transfer of such shares. See "The Conversion-- Restrictions on Transfer of
Subscription Rights and Shares." The Company and the Bank will pursue any and
all legal and equitable remedies in the event they become aware of the
transfer of subscription rights and will not honor orders known by them to
involve the transfer of such rights.
PURCHASE LIMITATIONS
The minimum number of shares that may be purchased is 25 shares. Except
for the KSOP, no Eligible Account Holder, Supplemental Eligible Account
Holder, Other Member or Minority Stockholder may in their capacities as such
purchase in the Subscription Offering more than 30,000 Subscription Shares;
no person, together with associates of and persons acting in concert with
such person, may purchase in the Offering more than 30,000 Subscription
Shares; and no person together with associates of and persons acting in
concert with such person may purchase in the aggregate more than the number
of Subscription Shares that when combined with Exchange Shares received by
such person together with associates of and persons acting in concert with
such person exceeds 100,000 shares, provided, however, that at any time
during the Offering and without further approval by the members of the Mutual
Holding Company or stockholders of the Bank and without further notice to
subscribers, the Company and the Bank, in their sole discretion, may increase
the maximum purchase limitation to up to 5% of the aggregate number of shares
of Common Stock issued in the Conversion. Such limitation may be further
increased to up to 9.99%, provided that orders for Subscription Shares
exceeding 5% of the Common Stock issued in the Conversion do not exceed in
the aggregate 10.0% of the Common Stock issued in the Conversion. Under
certain circumstances, subscribers for the maximum number of shares will, and
certain large subscribers may, be resolicited to increase their subscriptions
in the event of any such increase. The Company and the Bank may determine to
increase the maximum purchase limitation in their sole discretion whether or
not subscriptions have been received for shares at the minimum, midpoint or
maximum of the Offering Range, subject to any necessary regulatory approval,
for any reason, including to sell the minimum number of shares offered, and
to raise more capital. See "The Conversion--Limitations on Common Stock
Purchases." In the event of an oversubscription, shares will be allocated as
described in "The Conversion-- Subscription Offering and Subscription Rights"
and "--Community Offering," and in accordance with the Plan of Conversion. In
the event of a 15% increase in the total number of shares to be offered, the
additional shares will be distributed and allocated as described herein
without the resolicitation of subscribers as described in "The
Conversion--Subscription Offering and Subscription Rights" and "-- Limitation
on Common Stock Purchases."
10
<PAGE>
STOCK PRICING AND NUMBER OF SHARES TO BE ISSUED
The Plan of Conversion and federal regulations require that the aggregate
purchase price of the Common Stock in the Offering must be based on the
appraised pro forma market value of the Common Stock, as determined by an
independent valuation. The Bank and the Company have retained RP Financial,
Inc. ("RP Financial") to make such valuation (the "Independent Valuation").
The Independent Valuation was prepared based on the assumption that the
aggregate amount of Common Stock sold in the Offering would be equal to the
estimated pro forma market value of the Company multiplied by the percentage
of the Bank Common Stock owned by the Mutual Holding Company at the Effective
Date (the "Majority Ownership Percentage"). The Independent Valuation states
that as of December 12, 1997, the estimated pro forma market value of the
Company ranged from a minimum of $40,219,142 to a maximum of $54,414,133 with
a midpoint of $47,316,638 (the "Valuation Range"). The aggregate offering
price of the Subscription Shares offered in the Offering will be equal to the
Valuation Range multiplied by the Majority Ownership Percentage. The number
of Subscription Shares offered in the Offering will be equal to the aggregate
offering price of the Subscription Shares divided by the Subscription Price.
The number of Subscription Shares offered in the Offering and/or the
aggregate of the offering price of the Subscription Shares are referred to
herein as the "Offering Range." Based on the Valuation Range, the Majority
Ownership Percentage and the Subscription Price, the minimum of the Offering
Range will be 2,125,000 Subscription Shares, the midpoint of the Offering
Range will be 2,500,000 Subscription Shares, and the maximum of the Offering
Range will be 2,875,000 Subscription Shares.
The Board of Directors reviewed the Independent Valuation and, in
particular, considered (i) the Bank's financial condition and results of
operations, (ii) financial comparisons of the Bank in relation to financial
institutions of similar size and asset quality, (iii) stock market conditions
generally and in particular for financial institutions, and (iv) the
historical trading price of the Minority Shares, all of which are set forth
in the Independent Valuation. The Board also reviewed the methodology and the
assumptions used by RP Financial in preparing its appraisal. The Independent
Valuation of the Common Stock is not intended and should not be construed as
a recommendation of any kind as to the advisability of purchasing the Common
Stock in the Offering, nor can any assurance be given that those who purchase
or receive Common Stock in the Conversion will be able to sell such shares
after the Conversion at or above the Subscription Price. Further, the pro
forma stockholders' equity is not intended to represent the fair market value
of the Common Stock and may be greater than amounts that would be available
for distribution to stockholders in the event of liquidation. See "Pro Forma
Data" and "The Conversion--Stock Pricing and Number of Shares to be Issued."
The total number of shares to be issued in the Offering may be increased
or decreased without a resolicitation of subscribers, provided that the total
number of shares to be issued in the Offering is not less than 2,125,000 or
greater than 3,306,250. There is no obligation or understanding on the part
of management or the Board of Directors to take and/or pay for any shares in
order to complete the Conversion. Following commencement of the Subscription
Offering, the maximum of the Valuation Range may be increased by up to 15% to
up to $62,576,253, which will result in a corresponding increase of up to 15%
in the maximum of the Offering Range to 3,306,250 shares, to reflect changes
in the market and financial conditions, without the resolicitation of
subscribers. The minimum of the Valuation Range and the minimum of the
Offering Range may not be decreased without a resolicitation of subscribers.
The Subscription Price of $10.00 per share will remain fixed. See
"--Limitations on Common Stock Purchases" as to the method of distribution
and allocation of additional shares that may be issued in the event of an
increase in the Offering Range to fill unfilled orders in the Subscription
and Community Offerings. See "The Conversion--Stock Pricing" and --Number of
Shares to be Issued."
USE OF PROCEEDS
Estimated net proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock are between
$20.6 million and $28.1 million. Actual net cash proceeds cannot be
determined until the Conversion is completed, and will depend on the number
of shares sold in the Offering and the expenses of the Conversion. The
Company will contribute at least 50% of the estimated adjusted net Offering
proceeds to the Bank. See "Pro Forma Data."
11
<PAGE>
The Company will be unable to utilize any of the net proceeds of
the Offering until the Effective Date. The Company and the Bank may use funds
from the Offering, for general business purposes, including partial repayment
of FHLB advances, investment in one- to four-family residential mortgage
loans and other loans, and investment in short-term and intermediate-term
securities and mortgage-backed securities. In addition, the Bank and the
Company may utilize net proceeds to expand current operations through
internal growth or acquisitions, or for diversification into other
banking-related businesses and for other business and investment purposes.
The Bank acquired three branch offices in January 1998 and intends to
actively explore additional acquisitions, although neither the Company nor
the Bank has any specific plans, arrangements or understandings regarding any
additional expansions or acquisitions at this time, nor have criteria been
established to identify potential candidates for acquisition. Net proceeds
retained by the Company may be used for general business activities
including, subject to applicable limitations, the possible payment of
dividends and repurchases of Common Stock. See "Use of Proceeds."
DIVIDENDS
The Company intends to pay a quarterly cash dividend of $1.5 million, or
$0.373, $0.317, $0.276 and $0.240 per share of Common Stock on an annual
basis at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and maximum, as adjusted, of the
Offering Range, respectively. The first dividend is expected to be declared
for the fiscal quarter ending June 30, 1998. Dividends, when and if paid,
will be subject to determination and declaration by the Board of Directors in
its discretion, which will take into account the Company's consolidated
financial condition and results of operations, tax considerations, industry
standards, economic conditions, regulatory restrictions on dividend payments
by the Bank to the Company, general business practices and other factors. See
"Dividend Policy."
MARKET FOR COMMON STOCK
There is an established market for the Bank Common Stock which is
currently listed on the Nasdaq "SmallCap" Market under the symbol "PFSL," and
the Bank had three market makers as of January 31, 1998. As a newly formed
company, however, the Company has never issued capital stock and consequently
there is no established market for its Common Stock. It is expected that the
Company's Common Stock may be more liquid than the Minority Shares because
there will be significantly more outstanding shares owned by the public.
However, there can be no assurance that an active and liquid trading market
for the Common Stock will develop, or if developed, will be maintained. The
Minority Shares will automatically on the Effective Date, without further
action by the holder thereof, be converted into and become a right to receive
shares of Common Stock based on the Exchange Ratio.
The Company has applied to have its Common Stock listed on the Nasdaq
National Market under the Bank's previous symbol "PFSL." FBR has advised the
Company that upon completion of the Conversion, it intends to act as a market
maker in the Common Stock, depending upon the volume of trading and subject
to compliance with applicable laws and regulatory requirements. FBR will
assist the Company in obtaining additional market makers, but there can be no
assurance that additional market makers will be identified or that the
companies application for listing on the Nasdaq National Market will be
approved.
DIRECTOR AND MANAGEMENT BENEFITS FROM OFFERING
The Bank's KSOP is expected to purchase up to 8% of the shares sold in
the Offering, or 200,000 shares assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares at the
midpoint of the Offering Range, after satisfaction of purchase orders of
Eligible Account Holders. The shares will be purchased by the KSOP at a cost
of $2.0 million (assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares at the midpoint of the
Offering Range) and will be allocated to the accounts of employees without
payment by such persons of additional cash consideration. In addition,
subject to stockholder approval, the Bank or the Company intends to adopt (i)
a recognition and retention plan (the "1998 Recognition Plan") pursuant to
which the Bank or the Company intends to award to employees and directors of
the Bank at no cost to such employees and directors a number of shares of
Common Stock equal to up to 4% of the number of shares sold in the
Offering (or 100,000 shares assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares at the
midpoint of the Offering Range), and (ii) a stock option plan (the "1998
Stock Option Plan") pursuant to which the Company intends to award options to
purchase a number of shares of Common Stock equal to up to 10% of the number
of shares sold in the Offering or (250,000 options, assuming the sale of
2,500,000 shares at the midpoint of the Offering Range), at an exercise price
equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock at the time of the award.
Shares awarded pursuant to the 1998 Recognition Plan or the 1998 Stock Option
Plan may be authorized but unissued shares, or shares of Common Stock
acquired by the Bank, the Company, or such plans in the
12
<PAGE>
open market. If shares of Common Stock for the 1998 Recognition Plan and the
1998 Stock Option Plan were purchased by the Company in the open market at
the Subscription Price per share, the aggregate cost to the Company would be
$3.5 million (at the midpoint of the Offering Range). The exercise of such
options may, and such awards of Recognition Plan shares and KSOP shares from
authorized but unissued shares of the Company would, dilute the interest of
existing stockholders. The Company intends to submit the 1998 Recognition
Plan and 1998 Stock Option Plan to stockholders for approval. See "Management
of the Bank--Benefit Plans."
Voting Power of Directors and Executive Officers
Directors and executive officers of the Company, who currently hold 127,826
shares (including all unexercised stock options) or 7.59% of the outstanding
Bank Common Stock, expect to hold approximately 9.42% to 9.00% of the shares of
Common Stock outstanding upon consummation of the Offering (based upon the
exchange of Bank Common Stock and anticipated purchases of Common Stock by such
directors and executive officers at the minimum and maximum of the Offering
Range, respectively). See "Beneficial Ownership of Common Stock" and
"Subscriptions by Executive Officers and Directors." Executive officers of the
Company, as well as other eligible employees of the Company, also will hold
shares of Common Stock that are allocated to accounts established for them
pursuant to the KSOP. The KSOP intends to purchase 8% of shares of Common Stock
in the Offering (200,000 shares based on the midpoint of the Offering Range).
Under the terms of the KSOP, shares of Common Stock that have not yet been
allocated to the accounts of employee participants or for which no voting
instructions have been received will be voted by the trustees of the ESOP, who
are directors of the Company, in accordance with the direction of the KSOP
committee.
Subject to stockholder approval, the Bank or the Company intends to
adopt the 1998 Recognition Plan pursuant to which up to 4% of the shares sold
in the Offering (100,000 shares based on the midpoint of the Offering Range)
would be awarded to directors and executive officers of the Company at no
cost to them. In addition, subject to stockholder approval, the Company or
the Bank intends to award to directors and executive officers of the Company
options to purchase a number of shares of Common Stock equal to up to 10% of
the number of shares sold in the Offering (or 250,000 shares based on the
midpoint of the Offering Range). Directors and executive officers of the
Company also have been granted 22,030 shares of Bank Common Stock pursuant to
previously approved recognition plans and 55,169 options to purchase Bank
Common Stock pursuant to previously approved stock option plans, which based
on the Exchange Ratio at the midpoint of the Offering Range would amount to
63,850 shares of Common Stock and options to purchase 159,896 shares of
Common Stock. Accordingly, assuming the issuance of awards pursuant to the
1998 Recognition Plan and the 1998 Stock Option Plan, directors and executive
officers of the Company would control the voting of 784,278 shares of Common
Stock (or 16.58% of the to be outstanding shares of Common Stock at the
midpoint of the Offering Range) despite minimal cash outlay. This voting
power, together with additional stockholder support, could preclude or make
more difficult takeover attempts that do not have the support of the
Company's Board of Directors and may tend to perpetuate existing management.
Moreover, such voting control will enable the Company's Board of Directors
and management to block approval of transactions requiring the approval of
80% of the stockholders. See "Risk Factors--Certain Antitakeover
Considerations."
RISK FACTORS
Attention should be given to the matters discussed under "Risk Factors"
which include discussions of the potential impact of changes in interest
rates, tax and accounting consequences of the Conversion, certain
anti-takeover provisions in the Company's and Bank's corporate documents and
compensation plans, the possible increase in the Valuation Range and the
Offering Range and number of shares to be issued.
13
<PAGE>
SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
AND OTHER DATA OF THE BANK AND SUBSIDIARIES
The following tables set forth selected consolidated historical financial
and other data of the Bank (including its subsidiaries) for the periods and
at the dates indicated. The information is derived in part from and should be
read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes
thereto of the Bank contained elsewhere herein.
SELECTED FINANCIAL CONDITION DATA
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
SEPTEMBER 30,
----------------------------------------------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
(In Thousands)
<CAPTION>
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Total assets......................................... $ 383,417 $ 381,562 $ 348,554 $ 311,416 $ 169,787
Cash and cash equivalents............................ 2,805 2,046 1,860 2,318 2,116
Cash surrender value of life insurance............... 5,639 5,439 -- -- --
Investment securities................................ 200,553 219,690 214,425 197,668 60,648
Loans receivable, net (1)............................ 159,690 136,872 116,447 104,083 100,695
Federal Home Loan Bank Stock......................... 10,053 11,608 10,549 2,496 1,831
Deposits............................................. 143,354 116,283 112,458 113,407 119,115
FHLB advances........................................ 190,601 227,221 210,987 49,222 36,366
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase....... 20,685 10,100 -- 119,430 1,300
Stockholders' equity (2)............................. 24,246 22,689 21,008 19,420 11,287
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes loans held for sale.
(2) Retained earnings for fiscal years prior to 1994.
SUMMARY OF OPERATIONS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
-----------------------------------------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
(In Thousands)
<CAPTION>
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Interest income............................................ $ 26,093 $ 25,417 $ 23,300 $ 14,964 $ 12,210
Interest expense........................................... 18,699 18,628 17,241 8,354 5,995
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Net interest income before provision for loan losses..... 7,394 6,789 6,059 6,610 6,215
Provision for loan losses.................................. 60 411 -- -- 193
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Net interest income after provision for loan losses...... 7,334 6,378 6,059 6,610 6,022
Noninterest income......................................... 1,351 1,526 911 574 561
Noninterest expense:
Compensation and benefits................................ 2,954 2,704 2,624 2,478 1,844
Occupancy and equipment.................................. 566 439 377 410 343
Federal deposit insurance premiums(1).................... 108 1,198 279 277 265
Other.................................................... 1,337 1,210 746 743 1,087
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Total noninterest expense.............................. 4,965 5,551 4,026 3,908 3,539
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Income before income taxes................................. 3,720 2,353 2,944 3,276 3,044
Income tax provision....................................... 1,344 386 1,001 1,339 1,151
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Net income............................................... $ 2,376 $ 1,967 $ 1,943 $ 1,937 $ 1,893
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes nonrecurring SAIF premium assessment of approximately $937,000 in
the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996.
14
<PAGE>
Selected Operating Ratios and Other Data (2)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT OR FOR THE YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
-----------------------------------------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Performance Ratios:(6) Return on average equity ratio................ 10.07% 8.98% 9.58% 12.63% 18.36%
Return on average assets............................................. 0.63 0.54 0.58 0.85 1.16
Interest rate spread (3)............................................. 1.83 1.65 1.57 2.73 3.78
Net interest margin (3).............................................. 2.04 1.89 1.85 2.95 3.95
Noninterest expense to average assets ratio.......................... 1.32 1.55 1.20 1.77 2.17
Net interest income after provision for loan losses to noninterest
expense ratio...................................................... 147.68 114.89 150.49 163.94 170.16
Efficiency ratio(7).................................................. 57.17 70.23 57.77 54.40 52.68
Asset Quality Ratios: Average interest-earning assets to average
interest-bearing liabilities....................................... 104.09 104.61 105.49 106.21 104.46
Nonperforming loans to net loans (4)(5).............................. 0.28 0.74 0.43 0.48 0.71
Nonperforming assets to total assets (4)(5).......................... 0.12 0.30 0.20 0.20 1.09
Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans (4)(5).............. 373.45 169.50 273.59 267.60 189.73
Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming assets (4)(5)............. 359.79 152.91 197.81 212.12 73.20
Allowance for loan losses to total loans (4)......................... 1.03 1.21 1.13 1.24 1.30
Capital, Equity and Dividend Ratios: Tangible capital(4)............. 6.32 5.97 6.02 6.20 6.65
Core capital (4)..................................................... 6.32 5.97 6.02 6.20 6.65
Risk-based capital (4)............................................... 16.22 16.75 18.80 18.50 14.89
Average equity to average assets ratio............................... 6.26 5.98 6.06 6.72 6.33
Dividend payout ratio (1)............................................ 60.74 63.40 48.90 -- --
Per Share Data: Book value per share (8)............................. $ 14.85 $ 13.97 $ 13.05 $ 12.06 --
Earnings per share (9)............................................... $ 1.46 $ 1.22 $ 1.21 $ 1.57 --
Other Data: Full-service offices (10)................................ 6 5 5 5 5
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) The fiscal year ended September 30, 1995 was the first full fiscal year that
the Bank was a publicly traded company. Dividend payout ratio is the total
dividends declared divided by net income.
(2) With the exception of period end ratios, ratios are based on average monthly
balances.
(3) Interest rate spread represents the difference between the weighted average
yield on average interest earning assets and the weighted average cost of
average interest bearing liabilities, and net interest margin represents net
interest income as a percent of average interest earning assets.
(4) End of period ratio.
(5) Nonperforming assets consist of nonperforming loans and real estate owned
("REO"). Nonperforming loans consist of non-accrual loans while REO consists
of real estate acquired in settlement of loans.
(6) Excluding the impact of the $937,000 special SAIF assessment in the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1996, the return on average assets ratio, the
return on average equity ratio, the noninterest expense to average assets
ratio and the efficiency ratio would have been 0.7%, 11.8%, 1.3% and 58.37%,
respectively.
(7) The efficiency ratio is the ratio of noninterest expense to the sum of net
interest income and noninterest income.
(8) This calculation is based on 1,632,424, 1,624,594, 1,610,000 and 1,610,000
shares outstanding at September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively.
(9) This calculation is based on weighted average shares outstanding of
1,629,011, 1,617,690, 1,610,000 and 1,236,250 for the fiscal years ended
September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995 and 1994, respectively.
(10) The Bank completed the acquisition in January 1998 of three additional
full-service branch offices.
15
<PAGE>
RECENT DEVELOPMENTS
The following tables set forth certain consolidated financial and other data
of the Bank at and for the periods indicated. Consolidated financial data and
financial ratios and other data at September 30, 1997 have been derived from and
should be read in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements
of the Bank and Notes thereto presented elsewhere in this Prospectus.
Consolidated financial and operating data and financial ratios and other data at
and for the three months ended December 31, 1997 and 1996 were derived from
unaudited consolidated financial statements of the Bank. The results of
operations and ratios and other data presented for the three months ended
December 31, 1997 are not necessarily indicative of the results of operations
for the year ending September 30, 1998.
Selected Financial Condition Data
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
DECEMBER 31, SEPTEMBER 30,
1997 1997
------------ -------------
<S> <C> <C>
(IN THOUSANDS)
Total assets................................................. $ 389,405 $ 383,417
Cash and cash equivalents.................................... 3,013 2,805
Cash surrender value of life insurance....................... 5,690 5,639
Investment securities........................................ 198,096 200,553
Loans receivable, net (1).................................... 167,004 159,690
Federal Home Loan Bank Stock................................. 10,746 10,053
Deposits..................................................... 148,344 143,354
FHLB advances................................................ 210,325 190,601
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase............... 2,054 20,685
Stockholders' equity (2)..................................... 24,755 24,246
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes loans held for sale.
(2) Retained earnings for fiscal years prior to 1994.
Summary of Operations
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
DECEMBER 31, DECEMBER 31,
1997 1996
------------- -------------
<S> <C> <C>
(IN THOUSANDS)
Interest income............................................ $ 6,813 $ 6,476
Interest expense........................................... 4,926 4,616
------ ------
Net interest income before provision for loan losses..... 1,887 1,860
Provision for loan losses.................................. -- 30
------ ------
Net interest income after provision for loan losses...... 1,887 1,830
Noninterest income......................................... 312 353
Noninterest expense:
Compensation and benefits................................ 826 689
Occupancy and equipment.................................. 126 160
Federal deposit insurance premiums(1).................... 22 66
Other.................................................... 322 369
------ ------
Total noninterest expense.............................. 1,296 1,284
------ ------
Income before income taxes................................. 903 899
Income tax provision....................................... 325 315
------ ------
Net income............................................. $ 578 $ 584
------ ------
------ ------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes nonrecurring SAIF premium assessment of approximately $937,000 in
the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996.
16
<PAGE>
Selected Operating Ratios and Other Data (2)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AS OF OR FOR THE
THREE
MONTHS ENDED
DECEMBER 31,
--------------------
1997 1996
--------- ---------
<S> <C> <C>
Performance Ratios:(6)
Return on average equity ratio.......................................... 9.46% 10.18%
Return on average assets................................................ 0.60 0.62
Interest rate spread (3)................................................ 1.80 1.80
Net interest margin (3)................................................. 2.04 2.04
Noninterest expense to average assets ratio............................. 1.34 1.36
Net interest income after provision for loan
losses to noninterest expense ratio................................... 145.68 142.58
Efficiency ratio(7)..................................................... 58.94 58.02
Asset Quality Ratios:
Average interest-earning assets to average interest-bearing
liabilities........................................................... 104.22 104.72
Nonperforming loans to net loans (4)(5)................................. 0.48 0.64
Nonperforming assets to total assets (4)(5)............................. 0.23 0.29
Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans (4)(5)................. 209.41 192.38
Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming assets (4)(5)................ 190.54 160.91
Allowance for loan losses to total loans (4)............................ 1.00 1.21
Capital, Equity and Dividend Ratios:
Tangible capital(4)..................................................... 6.36 6.25
Core capital (4)........................................................ 6.36 6.25
Risk-based capital (4).................................................. 16.18 17.32
Average equity to average assets ratio.................................. 6.32 6.07
Dividend payout ratio (1)............................................... 63.46 58.55
Per Share Data:
Book value per share (8)................................................ $ 15.16 $ 14.32
Earnings per share (9).................................................. $ 0.35 $ 0.36
Other Data:
Full-service offices (10)............................................... 6 6
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) The fiscal year ended September 30, 1995 was the first full fiscal year that
the Bank was a publicly traded company. Dividend payout ratio is the total
dividends declared divided by net income.
(2) With the exception of period end ratios, ratios are based on average monthly
balances.
(3) Interest rate spread represents the difference between the weighted average
yield on average interest earning assets and the weighted average cost of
average interest bearing liabilities, and net interest margin represents net
interest income as a percent of average interest earning assets.
(4) End of period ratio.
(5) Nonperforming assets consist of nonperforming loans and real estate owned
("REO"). Nonperforming loans consist of non-accrual loans while REO consists
of real estate acquired in settlement of loans.
(6) Excluding the impact of the $937,000 special SAIF assessment in the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1996, the return on average assets ratio, the
return on average equity ratio, the noninterest expense to average assets
ratio and the efficiency ratio would have been 0.7%, 11.8%, 1.3% and 58.37%,
respectively.
(7) The efficiency ratio is the ratio of noninterest expense to the sum of net
interest income and noninterest income.
(8) This calculation is based on 1,632,424 and 1,628,153 shares outstanding at
December 31, 1997 and 1996.
(9) This calculation is based on weighted average shares outstanding of
1,632,424 and 1,625,561 for the three months ended December 31, 1997 and
1996, respectively.
(10) The Bank completed the acquisition in January 1998 of three additional
full-service branch offices.
17
<PAGE>
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF RECENT DEVELOPMENTS
GENERAL
In January 1998 the Bank completed the acquisition of three full-service
branch offices. The purchase price included an aggregate of $28.0 million in
deposits, as well as the buildings and land at each branch location.
Financial Condition at December 31, 1997 as compared to September 30, 1997
Total assets increased $6.0 million, or 1.6%, to $389.4 million at December
31, 1997, as compared to $383.4 million at September 30, 1997. This increase was
primarily due to an increase in the loan portfolio of $7.3 million, or 4.6%,
which was partially offset by a decrease of $2.5 million, or 1.2%, in investment
securities. This is consistent with management's strategy to replace maturing
and called investments with higher yielding loans.
Deposits increased $4.9 million, or 3.5%, to $148.3 million at December 31,
1997, as compared to $143.4 at September 30, 1997. This increase was due to
normal growth. Federal Home Loan Bank advances increased $19.7 million, or
10.3%, to $210.3 million at December 31, 1997 as compared to $190.6 million at
September 30, 1997. The additional advances were used to repay securities sold
under agreements to repurchase. As a result, securities sold under agreements to
repurchase decreased $18.6 million or 90.1%.
Results of Operations for the Three Months Ended December 31, 1997 and 1996
For the three months ended December 31, 1997, the Bank had net income of
$578,545 as compared to $584,012 for the three months ended December 31, 1996, a
decrease of $5,467 or 0.9%. Net interest income after provision increased
$57,551 or 3.2%. The increase in net interest income was primarily due to an
increase in the average balance in the Bank's higher-yielding loan portfolio as
compared to investment securities.
Interest income from loans for the three-month period ended December 31,
1997 increased $0.4 million, or 13.8%, to $3.3 million from the three-month
period ended December 31, 1996. The increase in interest income from loans was
partially offset by a decrease in interest income from investment securities.
For the three-month period ended December 31, 1997, interest income from
securities decreased $0.2 million, or 4.2%, to $3.4 million from $3.6 million
from the same period ended December 31, 1996. Total interest income increased
$0.3 million, or 5.2%, to $6.8 million.
Interest expense increased $0.3 million, or 6.7%, to $4.9 million for the
three-month period ended December 31, 1997 as compared to the three-month
period ended December 31, 1996. Such increase was due to an increase in the
Bank's cost of funds during the six-month period ended December 31, 1997 and
a slight increase in total borrowings.
Other income decreased $41,433, primarily the result of a decrease in
dividend income which was the result of lower average FHLB balances outstanding
during the three-month period ended December 31, 1997 as compared to the
three-month period ended December 31, 1996.
Compensation expense increased $136,608, or 19.8%, to $825,857 for the
three-month period ended December 31, 1997 from $689,249 for the three-month
period ended December 31, 1996. Such increase was due to an increase in
personnel in preparation for the purchase of three new branches, adjusted
compensation levels due to changes in responsibilities and normal increases in
compensation as a result of annual evaluations.
Non-Performing Loans and Loan Loss Provision
The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for loan
losses based on management's quarterly asset classification review and
evaluation of the risk inherent in its loan portfolio and changes in the nature
18
<PAGE>
and volume of its loan activity. Such evaluation, which includes a review of all
loans of which full collection may not be reasonably assured, considers among
other matters, the estimated value of collateral, cash flow analysis, historical
loan loss experience, and other factors that warrant recognition in providing
adequate allowances. No provision was made for the quarter ended December 31,
1997, compared to a provision of $30,000 for the same period in 1996. Management
believes that the current allowance for loan loss is adequate to absorb possible
loan losses in the existing portfolio. However, future reviews may require
additional provisions.
The following table sets for the information regarding loans delinquent for
90 days or more and real estate owned by the Bank on the dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
December 31, September 30,
1997 1997
--------------- -----------------
<S> <C> <C>
(Dollars in Thousands)
Delinquent loans:
Single family mortgage..................................... $ 760 $ 422
Other mortgage loans....................................... 7 --
Other loans................................................ 41 31
--- ---
Total delinquent loans................................... 808 453
Total real estate owned (1).................................. 80 17
--- ---
Total non-performing assets.................................. 888 470
Total loans delinquent 90 days or more
to net loans receivable.................................... 0.48% 0.28%
Total loans delinquent 90 days or more to
total assets............................................... 0.21% 0.12%
Total nonperforming loans and REO to total
assets..................................................... 0.23% 0.12%
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Net of valuation allowances.
It is the policy of the Bank to place loans 90 days or more past due on a
nonaccrual status by establishing a specific interest reserve that provides for
a corresponding reduction in interest income. Delinquent loans 90 days or more
past due increased $338,000, or 80.1%, during the period ended December 31,
1997.
Liquidity And Capital Resources
Regulatory liquidity is defined as a percentage of the institution's
average daily balance of net withdrawable deposits and current borrowings,
invested with final maturities no longer than five years. The OTS requires
1.0% total liquidity. The Bank's average liquidity ratio during December 1997
was 9.21% compared to 5.17% during the month of September 1997. At December
31, 1997, the Bank was in compliance with all liquidity requirements.
At December 31, 1997, the Bank had outstanding loan commitments of $2.5
million. Funding of these commitments are expected to be accomplished by
utilizing cash resources from deposits, Federal Home Loan Bank advances and/or
repurchase agreements and principal and interest payments from loans and the
investment portfolio.
The Bank utilizes Federal Home Loan Bank advances and/or repurchase
agreements to leverage its capital to maximize earnings and to maintain a stable
capital-to-asset ratio. At December 31, 1997, the Bank's capital-to-asset ratio
exceeded all regulatory requirements.
19
<PAGE>
RISK FACTORS
The following risk factors, in addition to the other information presented
in this Prospectus, should be considered by prospective investors in deciding
whether to purchase the Common Stock offered hereby.
Potential Negative Effects of Increases in Market Interest Rates
The operations of the Bank are substantially dependent on its net interest
income, which is the difference between the interest income earned on its
interest-earning assets and the interest expense paid on its interest-bearing
liabilities. Like most savings institutions, the Bank's earnings are affected by
changes in market interest rates and other economic factors beyond its control.
The Bank's average interest rate spread for the fiscal years ended September 30,
1997, 1996 and 1995 was 1.83%, 1.65% and 1.57%, respectively, although no
assurance can be given that the Bank's average interest rate spread will not
decrease in future periods. Any such decrease in the Bank's average interest
rate spread could adversely affect the Bank's net interest income. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations--Asset and Liability Management."
If an institution's interest-earning assets have longer duration than its
interest-bearing liabilities, the yield on the institution's interest-earning
assets generally will adjust more slowly than the cost of its
interest-bearing liabilities and, as a result, the institution's net interest
income generally would be adversely affected by material and prolonged
increases in interest rates and positively affected by comparable declines in
interest rates. Based upon certain repricing assumptions, the Bank's
interest-earning liabilities repricing or maturing within one year exceeded
its interest-bearing assets with similar characteristics by $78.0 million or
17.0% of total assets at September 30, 1997. Accordingly, an increase in
interest rates generally would result in a decrease in the Bank's average
interest rate spread and net interest income. In addition, at September 30,
1997, the Bank's mortgage-backed securities portfolio included $153.0 million
of collateralized mortgage obligations with adjustable interest rates but
with lifetime caps on such interest rate adjustments ranging from 9% to 9.5%.
Accordingly, in an environment of material and prolonged interest rate
increases, the yield on these assets could be capped. See "Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations--Assets and Liability Management."
The value of the Bank's portfolio will change as interest rates change.
Rising interest rates will generally decrease the Bank's net portfolio value,
while falling interest rates will generally increase the value of that
portfolio. As of September 30, 1997, if interest rates increased instantaneously
by 200 basis points, the Bank's net portfolio value would decrease by $14.6
million, or 41% of the estimated market value of the Bank's net portfolio value,
as calculated by the OTS. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations--Asset and Liability Management."
At September 30, 1997, ARM loans constituted 73.8% of the Bank's total net
loan portfolio. ARM loans generally pose a risk that as interest rates rise, the
amount of a borrower's monthly loan payment also rises, thereby increasing the
potential for delinquencies and loan losses. At the same time, the marketability
of the underlying property may be adversely affected by higher interest rates.
At September 30, 1997, mortgage-backed securities constituted 44.0% of total
assets. Mortgage-backed and related securities are particularly subject to
reinvestment risk. For example, during periods of falling interest rates, higher
coupon mortgage-backed and related securities are more likely to prepay, and the
Bank may not be able to reinvest the proceeds from prepayments in securities or
other assets with yields similar to those of the prepaying mortgage-backed and
related securities.
DECREASED RETURN ON EQUITY AND INCREASED EXPENSES FOLLOWING THE CONVERSION
At September 30, 1997, the Bank's ratio of equity to assets was 6.32%. The
Company's equity position will be significantly increased as a result of the
Conversion. On a pro forma basis as of September 30, 1997, assuming the sale of
Common Stock at the midpoint of the Offering Range, the Company's ratio of
equity to assets would be
20
<PAGE>
11.38% and, assuming the sale of Common Stock at the adjusted maximum of the
Offering Range, the Company's ratio of equity to assets would be 12.89%. The
Company's ability to leverage this capital will be significantly affected by
industry competition for loans and deposits. The Company currently
anticipates that it will take time to prudently deploy such capital.
In addition, the Company's expenses also are expected to increase because of
(i) the costs associated with the KSOP, (ii) the restricted stock ownership plan
and stock option plan expected to be implemented following the Conversion, and
(iii) certain increases in executive compensation related to the
responsibilities associated with managing the Company as a fully converted
company, the deployment of the net proceeds of the Offering and the successful
integration of the operations associated with the three branch offices expected
to be acquired in January 1998. Because of the expected increases in both equity
and expenses, return on equity is expected to decrease as compared to
performance in recent years. A lower return on equity could reduce the trading
price of the Company's shares of Common Stock.
INDEPENDENT VALUATION AND POTENTIAL NEGATIVE IMPACT ON TRADING PRICE OF
COMMON STOCK
The offering price as a percentage of pro forma tangible book value of the
Common Stock sold in the Offering ranges from 93.98% at the minimum of the
Offering Range to 117.92% at the adjusted maximum of the Offering Range. For the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997 the price to pro forma earnings per share
of the Common Stock sold in the Offering ranges from 13.89x at the minimum of
the Offering Range to 20.00x at the adjusted maximum of the Offering Range. The
price to pro forma tangible book value at which the Common Stock is being sold
in the Offering substantially exceeds the price to pro forma tangible book value
of common stock sold in most mutual-to-stock conversions that do not involve a
mutual holding company conversion or reorganization. Prospective investors
should be aware that as a result of the relatively high valuation, the
after-market performance of the Common Stock is likely to be less favorable
during the period immediately following the Conversion than the price
performance of common stock sold in recent mutual-to-stock conversions that do
not involve a mutual-to-stock conversion of a mutual holding company.
POSSIBLE DILUTIVE EFFECT OF ISSUANCE OF ADDITIONAL SHARES
If the 1998 Recognition Plan is approved by stockholders of the Company,
the 1998 Recognition Plan intends to acquire an amount of Common Stock equal
to 4% of the shares of Common Stock sold in the Conversion. If such shares
are acquired at a per share price equal to the Purchase Price, the cost of
such shares would be $1.15 million, assuming the Common Stock sold in the
Conversion at the maximum of the Offering Range. Such shares of Common Stock
may be acquired in the open market with funds provided by the Company, or
from authorized but unissued shares of Common Stock. In the event that the
1998 Recognition Plan acquires authorized but unissued shares of Common Stock
from the Company, the voting interests of existing stockholders may be
diluted and net income per share and stockholders' equity per share may be
decreased.
If the 1998 Stock Option Plan is approved by stockholders of the Company,
the Company intends to reserve for future issuance pursuant to such plan a
number of shares of Common Stock equal to 10% of the Common Stock sold in the
Offering (250,000 shares, based on the issuance of 2,500,000 shares at the
midpoint of the Offering Range). Such shares may be authorized but previously
unissued shares, treasury shares or shares purchased by the Company in the
open market or from private sources. If only authorized but previously
unissued shares are used under such plan, the issuance of the total number of
shares available under such plan would dilute the voting interests of
stockholders at the time of such award and may decrease net income per share
and stockholders' equity per share.
As of October 31, 1997, there were options outstanding to purchase 48,052
Minority Shares at an average exercise price of $10.00 per share, 33,102 of
which were exercisable within 60 days of such date. On the Effective Date these
options will be converted into and become options to purchase Common Stock of
the Company. The number of shares of Common Stock to be received upon exercise
of such options will be determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio. The exercise
of such currently existing stock options will result in dilution of the Common
Stock holdings of the existing stockholders.
POSSIBLE INCREASE IN OFFERING RANGE AND NUMBER OF SHARES ISSUED
The number of Subscription Shares to be sold in the Conversion may be
increased as a result of an increase in the Offering Range of up to 15% to
reflect changes in market and financial conditions following the commencement of
the Subscription and Community Offerings. In the event that the Offering Range
is so increased, it is expected that the Company will issue up to 3,306,250
shares of Common Stock at the Subscription Price. Such an increase in the number
of shares issued in the Offering will decrease a subscriber's pro forma
annualized net earnings per share and pro forma stockholders' equity per share,
but will increase the Company's consolidated pro forma stockholders' equity and
pro forma net income. See "Pro Forma Data."
21
<PAGE>
ESOP COMPENSATION EXPENSE
In November 1993, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
("AICPA") Accounting Standards Executive Committee issued Statement of Position
93-6 Employers' Accounting for Employee Stock Ownership Plans ("SOP 93-6"). SOP
93-6 requires an employer to record compensation expense in an amount equal to
the fair value of shares committed to be released to employees from an employee
stock ownership plan ("ESOP") or in the present case, the ESOP portion of the
KSOP. Accordingly, future increases and decreases in fair value of Common Stock
committed to be released will have a corresponding effect on compensation
expense related to the ESOP portion of the KSOP. The annual compensation expense
of the ESOP portion of the KSOP will be $123,000 at the midpoint of the Offering
Range, assuming the fair value of shares of Common Stock is equal to the
Subscription Price. To the extent that the fair value of the Bank's KSOP shares
differ from the cost of such shares, the differential will be charged or
credited to equity. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations--Impact of New Accounting Standards."
RISKS RELATED TO COMMERCIAL REAL ESTATE LOANS AND COMMERCIAL BUSINESS LOANS
The Bank has increased its originations of commercial real estate loans and
commercial business loans. Commercial real estate loans and commercial business
loans amounted to $9.6 million and $6.5 million, or 6.0% and 4.1%, respectively,
of the Bank's net loans at September 30, 1997.
Commercial real estate and commercial business lending involves a higher
degree of risk than single-family residential lending due to a variety of
factors, including generally larger loan balances to single borrowers or groups
of related borrowers, the dependency for repayment on successful development and
operation of the project or business and income stream of the borrower, and loan
terms which often do not require full amortization of the loan over its term. In
addition, commercial business loans involve a higher degree of risk because the
collateral may be in the form of intangible assets and/or inventory subject to
market obsolescence. Such risks also can be significantly affected by economic
conditions. In addition, commercial real estate and commercial business lending
requires substantially greater oversight efforts compared to other lending. See
"Business--Lending Activities." As of September 30, 1997, the Bank had $422,000
of non-performing real estate loans, and $31,000 of other non-performing loans.
See "Business-- Asset Quality--Non-Performing Assets."
REGULATORY OVERSIGHT AND LEGISLATION
The Bank is subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination
by the OTS, as its chartering authority, and by the FDIC as insurer of its
deposits up to applicable limits. The Bank is a member of the FHLB system. As
the holding company of the Bank, the Company also will be subject to
regulation and oversight by the OTS. Such regulation and supervision govern
the activities in which an institution can engage and are intended primarily
for the protection of the insurance fund and depositors. Regulatory
authorities have been granted extensive discretion in connection with their
supervisory and enforcement activities which are intended to strengthen the
financial condition of the banking and thrift industries, including the
imposition of restrictions on the operation of an institution, the
classification of assets by the institution and the adequacy of an
institution's allowance for loan losses. Any change in such regulation and
oversight, whether by the OTS, the FDIC or Congress, could have a material
impact on the Company, the Bank and their respective operations. See
"Regulation."
On September 30, 1996, the Deposit Insurance funds ("DIF") Act of 1996 was
enacted into law. The DIF Act contemplates the development of a common charter
for all federally chartered depository institutions and the abolition of
separate charters for national banks and federal savings associations. It is not
known what form the common charter may take and what effect, if any, the
adoption of a new charter would have on the financial condition or results of
operations of the Bank. See "Regulation--Federal Regulation of Savings
Institutions."
Legislation is proposed periodically providing for a comprehensive reform of
the banking and thrift industries, and has included provisions that would (i)
require federal savings associations to convert to a national bank or a
state-chartered bank or thrift, (ii) require all savings and loan holding
companies to become bank holding companies, and (iii) abolish the OTS. It is
uncertain when or if any of this type of legislation will be passed, and, if
passed, in what form the legislation would be passed. As a result, management
cannot accurately predict the possible impact of such legislation on the Bank.
GEOGRAPHIC CONCENTRATION AND EXPOSURE TO ECONOMIC DOWNTURNS
The primary market area of the Bank is the Arkansas counties of Randolph,
Lawrence, Craighead, Sharp and Clay, all of which are located in northeast
Arkansas. As a result, economic conditions in this area will significantly
affect the deposit and loan activities of the Bank, and an economic downturn
in this area could negatively impact the operations of the Bank. Moreover,
the area is rural in nature, and a large portion of the industry in the area
is concentrated in the agriculture and agriculture-related industries.
CERTAIN ANTI-TAKEOVER CONSIDERATIONS
Provisions in the Company's and the Bank's Governing Documents. Provisions
in the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and the Bank's Charter and their
respective Bylaws provide for limitations on stockholder voting rights. In
addition, the Bank's Federal Stock Charter and Bylaws, as well as certain
federal regulations, assist the Company in maintaining its status as an
independent publicly owned corporation. These provisions may prevent a change of
control of the Company even if desired by a majority of stockholders. These
provisions provide for, among other things, supermajority voting, staggered
boards of directors, noncumulative voting for directors, limits on the calling
of special meetings, and certain uniform price provisions for certain business
combinations. In particular, the Company's Certificate of Incorporation provides
that beneficial owners of more than 10% of the Company's outstanding Common
Stock may not vote the shares owned in excess of the 10% limit. The Bank's
Charter also prohibits, until [April 1999], the acquisition of, or offer to,
acquire, directly or indirectly, the beneficial ownership of more than 10% of
the Bank's voting securities. Any person violating this restriction, except for
the Company, may not vote any of the Bank's securities held in excess of the 10%
limitation. In the event that holders of revocable proxies for more than 10% of
the shares of Common Stock of the Company acting as a group or in concert with
other proxy holders attempt actions that could indirectly result in a change in
control of the Bank, management of the Bank will be able to assert this
provision of the Bank's Charter against such holders if it deems such assertion
to be in the best interests of the Bank, the Company and its stockholders. It is
uncertain, however, whether the Bank would be successful in asserting such
provision against such persons.
VOTING CONTROL OF EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS. In addition,
assuming executive officers and directors (i) purchase 63,800 Subscription
Shares in the Offering, (ii) receive Exchange Shares in the Share Exchange as
described herein, (iii) receive a number of shares of Common Stock equal to
4% and 10% of the number of Subscription Shares sold in the Offering pursuant
to the 1998 Recognition Plan and 1998 Stock Option Plan, respectively
(assuming such plans are approved by stockholders, that all awards are vested
and all options exercised, and the 1998 Recognition Plan shares are purchased
in the open market); and (iv) receive all stock benefits that were not vested
as of October 31, 1997, and exercised all such stock options; then executive
officers and directors will own
22
<PAGE>
between % and % of the Common Stock at the minimum and adjusted maximum
of the Offering Range, respectively. Such amount does not include the 56,790
shares, or 3.5% of the Company's Common Stock that will be owned by the KSOP
at the conclusion of the Conversion, assuming it purchases 8.0% of the
Subscription Shares sold in the Offering. The Certificate of Incorporation of
the Company provides for a supermajority vote of 80% of the outstanding
shares of voting stock for: (i) the removal of a director for cause prior to
the expiration of his term; (ii) certain business combinations, including
mergers, consolidations and sales of 25% or more of the assets of the Company
and its subsidiaries with "Interested Stockholders" as defined in
"Restrictions on the Acquisition of the Company and the Bank--Restrictions in
the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws--Shareholder Vote
Required to Approve Business Combinations with Principal Stockholders"; (iii)
amendment of certain provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation; and (iv)
amendment of the Bylaws. The potential voting control by directors and
officers could, together with additional stockholder support or upon exercise
of their options, defeat stockholder proposals requiring an 80% supermajority
vote. As a result, these provisions may preclude takeover attempts that
certain stockholders deem to be in their best interest and may tend to
perpetuate existing management. See "Restrictions on the Acquisition of the
Company and the Bank."
PROVISIONS OF COMPENSATION PLANS AND EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS. Moreover,
the Bank's current employment agreements provide for benefits and cash
payments in the event of a change in control of the Company or the Bank.
Additionally, the Bank's current stock benefit plans, and the 1998
Recognition Plan and 1998 Stock Option Plan may provide for accelerated
vesting in the event of a change in control. These provisions may have the
effect of increasing the cost of acquiring the Company, thereby discouraging
future attempts to acquire control of the Company or the Bank. See
"Restrictions on the Acquisition of the Company and the Bank--Restrictions in
the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws," "Management of the
Bank--Benefits."
23
<PAGE>
Possible Year 2000 Computer Program Problems
A great deal of information has been disseminated about the global computer
crash that may occur in the year 2000. Many computer programs that can only
distinguish the final two digits of the year entered (a common programming
practice in earlier years) are expected to read entries for the year 2000 as the
year 1900 and compute payment, interest or delinquency based on the wrong date
or are expected to be unable to compute payment, interest or delinquency. Rapid
and accurate data processing is essential to the operations of the Bank.
All of the material data processing of the Bank that could be affected by
this problem is provided by a third party service bureau. The service bureau
of the Bank has advised the Bank that it expects to resolve this potential
problem before the year 2000. However, if this service bureau is unable to
resolve this potential problem in time, the Bank would likely experience
significant data processing delays, mistake or failures, which could have a
significant adverse impact on the financial condition and results of
operations of the Bank.
24
<PAGE>
Director and Management Benefits from the Offering
Subject to stockholder approval, the Bank or the Company intends to adopt
the 1998 Recognition Plan pursuant to which the Bank or the Company intends to
award to employees and directors of the Bank, at no cost to such employees and
directors, the number of shares of Common Stock equal to up to 4% of the number
of shares sold in the Offering (or 100,000 shares assuming the sale of 2,500,000
shares at the midpoint of the Offering Range), and (ii) the 1998 Stock Option
Plan pursuant to which the Company intends to award options to purchase a number
of shares of Common Stock equal to up to 10% of the number of shares sold in the
Offering (or 250,000 options assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares at the
midpoint of the Offering Range) at an exercise price equal to the fair market
value of the Common Stock at the time of the award. If shares of Common Stock
from the 1998 Recognition Plan and the 1998 Stock Option Plan were purchased by
the Company in the open market at the subscription price per share, the
aggregate cost to the Company would be $3.5 million (at the midpoint of the
Offering Range). The Bank's KSOP also is expected to purchase up to 8% of the
shares sold in the Offering (or 200,000 shares assuming the sale of 2,500,000
shares at the midpoint of the Offering Range). The shares will be purchased by
the KSOP at a cost of $2.0 million (assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares at the
midpoint of the Offering Range) and will be allocated to the accounts of
executive officers and other employees without payment by such persons of
additional cash consideration.
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH POTENTIAL ACQUISITIONS
In an effort to fully deploy post-Conversion capital, in addition to
attempting to increase its loan and deposit growth, the Company may seek to
expand its banking franchise by acquiring other financial institutions or
branches. The Company's ability to grow through selective acquisitions of
other financial institutions or branches of such institutions will be
dependent on successfully identifying, acquiring and integrating such
institutions or branches. There can be no assurance the Company will be able
to generate internal growth or to identify attractive acquisition candidates,
acquire such candidates on favorable terms or successfully integrate any
acquired institutions or branches into the Company. The Bank acquired three
branch offices in January 1998 and intends to actively explore additional
acquisitions, although neither the Company nor the Bank has any specific
plans, arrangements or understandings regarding any additional expansions or
acquisitions at this time, nor have criteria been established to identify
potential candidates for acquisition.
THE COMPANY
The Company was organized in December 1997 for the purpose of acquiring
all of the outstanding shares of capital stock of the Bank. The Company has
applied to the OTS to become a savings and loan holding company and as such
will be subject to regulation by the OTS. After completion of the Conversion,
the Company will conduct business initially as a unitary savings and loan
holding company. See "Regulation--Company Regulation." Upon consummation of
the Conversion, the Company's assets will be primarily the shares of the
Bank's capital stock acquired in the Conversion and that portion of the net
proceeds of the Conversion permitted by the OTS to be retained by the
Company. The Company initially will have no significant liabilities. See "Use
of Proceeds." The management of the Company is set forth under "Management of
the Company." Initially, the Company will neither own nor lease any property,
but instead will use the premises, equipment and furniture of the Bank. At
the present time, the Company does not intend to employ any persons other
than officers but will utilize the support staff of the Bank from time to
time. Additional employees will be hired as appropriate to the extent the
Company expands its business.
The Conversion will provide the Bank with additional capital to support
future growth and enhance results of operations. Management believes that the
holding company structure will provide the Company with additional flexibility
to diversify its business activities through existing or newly formed
subsidiaries, or through acquisitions of or mergers with other financial
institutions and financial services related companies or for other business or
investment purposes, including the possible repurchase of Common Stock as
permitted by the OTS. Although there are no current arrangements, understandings
or agreements, written or oral, regarding any such opportunities or
transactions, the Company will be in a position after the Conversion, subject to
regulatory limitations and the Company's financial position, to take advantage
of any such acquisition and expansion opportunities that may arise. The initial
activities of the Company are anticipated to be funded by the proceeds permitted
to be retained by the Company and earnings thereon or, alternatively, through
dividends received from the Bank.
The Company's executive office is located at 203 West Broadway, Pocahontas,
Arkansas, and its telephone number is (870) 892-4595.
THE BANK
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association is a federally chartered
savings and loan association headquartered in Pocahontas, Arkansas. The Bank's
deposits are insured by the FDIC under the SAIF. The Bank has been a member of
the FHLB since 1935. At September 30, 1997, the Bank had total assets of $383.4
million, total deposits of $143.4 million, and stockholders' equity of $24.2
million.
The Bank was originally organized in 1935 as a federally chartered mutual
savings and loan association. The Bank was reorganized as a stock savings and
loan association on December 31, 1991, pursuant to a plan of reorganization that
was approved by the OTS. As part of that reorganization, the Mutual Holding
Company was formed as the mutual holding company of the Bank. In April 1994, the
Bank issued 747,500 shares of its common stock in a subscription and community
offering, with the remaining shares of its common stock (862,500 shares, or
53.6% of all outstanding shares) issued to the Mutual Holding Company.
In January 1998, the Bank purchased three full-service branch offices, which
increased the Bank's branches to nine. The purchase included an aggregate of
$ in deposits, as well as the buildings and land at each branch
location. The newly acquired branches are located in Walnut Ridge, Hardy and
Lake City in Arkansas and supplement the Bank's existing branches in Lawrence,
Sharp and Craighead Counties.
The Bank is a community-oriented savings institution that, with the
consummation of the branch acquisition referred to above, operates nine
full-service offices in its market area consisting of the Arkansas counties of
Randolph,
25
<PAGE>
Lawrence, Craighead, Sharp and Clay. The Bank's market area has a diverse
economic base, although it is significantly influenced by agriculture, light
manufacturing, services and wholesale and retail trade. Increasingly, the
economy of the Bank's market area has been influenced by the service sector
and, to a lesser extent, by tourism and by the retirement sector. The Bank is
primarily engaged in the business of attracting deposits from the general
public in its market area, and investing such deposits, together with
borrowed funds, in loans collateralized by single-family residential real
estate, multifamily loans, agricultural loans and commercial real estate
loans, generally secured by property located in its market area. The Bank
also originates commercial business loans and, to a lesser extent, consumer
loans. The Bank also invests in mortgage-backed and related securities and
other investment securities, including CMOs. See "Business of the
Bank--Lending Activities; "--Investment Activities." During the fiscal year
ended September 30, 1997, 74.6% of the loans originated by the Bank were
single-family residential real estate loans. At September 30, 1997, such
loans totaled 86.8% of the Bank's total net loan portfolio. At September 30,
1997, agricultural loans, commercial real estate loans (including land
loans), and commercial business loans comprised 2.9%, 6.0% and 4.1%,
respectively, of the Bank's total net loan portfolio.
The Bank's executive offices are located at 203 West Broadway, Pocahontas,
Arkansas, and its telephone number at that location is (870) 892-4595.
26
<PAGE>
HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA CAPITAL COMPLIANCE
At September 30, 1997, the Bank exceeded all OTS regulatory capital
requirements. Set forth below is a summary of the Bank's compliance with the OTS
capital standards as of September 30, 1997, on a historical and pro forma basis
assuming that the indicated number of shares were sold as of such date, and that
the Company contributes to the Bank a portion of the estimated net proceeds of
the Offering sufficient to increase the Bank's tangible capital to at least 10%
of its adjusted total assets. Accordingly, it has been assumed that 1%, 14%, 23%
and 31% of the net proceeds of the Offering have been retained by the Company
based on the sale of 2,250,000, 2,500,000, 2,875,000 and 3,306,250 shares at the
minimum, midpoint, maximum and maximum, as adjusted, of the Offering Range,
respectively. See "Pro Forma Data" for the assumptions used to determine the net
proceeds of the Offering. For purposes of the table below, the amount expected
to be borrowed by the ESOP portion of the KSOP and the cost of the shares
expected to be acquired by the 1998 Recognition Plan are deducted from pro forma
regulatory capital.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PRO FORMA AT SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, BASED UPON THE SALE OF
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
HISTORICAL AT
SEPTEMBER 30, 1997 2,125,000 SHARES 2,500,000 SHARES 2,875,000 SHARES 3,306,250 SHARES
------------------- ------------------- ------------------- ------------------- ---------------------
PERCENT PERCENT PERCENT PERCENT PERCENT
OF OF OF OF OF
AMOUNT ASSETS (2) AMOUNT ASSETS (2) AMOUNT ASSETS (2) AMOUNT ASSETS (2) AMOUNT ASSETS(2)(3)
------- ---------- ------- ---------- ------- ---------- ------- ---------- ------- ------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
GAAP capital...... $24,246 6.32% $40,107 10.00% $40,147 10.00% $40,182 10.00% $40,214 10.00%
Tangible capital:
Capital level... $24,246 6.32% $40,106 10.00% $40,146 10.00% $40,181 10.00% $40,213 10.00%
Requirement..... 5,754 1.50% 6,018 1.50% 6,023 1.50% 6,028 1.50% 6,033 1.50%
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
Excess........ $18,492 4.82% $34,088 8.50% $34,123 8.50% $34,153 8.50% $34,180 8.50%
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
Core capital:
Capital level... $24,246 6.32% $40,106 10.00% $40,146 10.00% $40,181 10.00% $40,213 10.00%
Requirement
(3)........... 11,509 3.00% 12,035 3.00% 12,046 3.00% 12,056 3.00% 12,067 3.00%
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
Excess........ $12,737 3.32% $28,071 7.00% $28,100 7.00% $28,125 7.00% $28,146 7.00%
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
Risk-based
capital:
Capital level
(4)........... $25,913 16.22% $41,774 24.79% $41,814 24.78% $41,849 24.78% $41,881 24.77%
Requirement..... 12,781 8.00% 13,483 8.00% 13,497 8.00% 13,510 8.00% 13,525 8.00%
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
Excess........ $13,132 8.22% $28,291 16.79% $28,317 16.78% $28,339 16.78% $28,356 16.77%
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- ----- ------- -----
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) As adjusted to give effect to an increase in the number of shares which
could occur due to a 15% increase in the Offering Range to reflect changes
in market or general financial conditions following the commencement of the
Offering.
(2) Tangible and core capital levels are shown as a percentage of total
adjusted assets. Risk-based capital levels are shown as a percentage of
risk-weighted assets. Pro forma total adjusted and risk-weighted assets
used for the capital calculations include the proceeds of the KSOP's
purchase of 8% of the Subscription Shares. Pro forma total adjusted
assets were $401.2 million, $401.5 million, $401.7 million, $402.0 million,
respectively, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and maximum, as adjusted,
of the Offering Range. Pro forma risk-weighted assets were $168.5
million, $168.7 million, $168.9 million and $169.1 million, respectively,
at the minimum, midpoint, maximum, and maximum, as adjusted, of the
Offering Range.
(3) The current OTS core capital requirement for savings banks is 3% of total
adjusted assets. The OTS has proposed core capital requirements which would
require a core capital ratio of 3% of total adjusted assets for savings
banks that receive the highest supervisory rating for safety and soundness,
and a 4% to 5% core capital ratio requirement for all other savings banks.
See "Regulation--Federal Regulation of Savings Institution--Capital
Requirements."
(4) Pro forma amounts and percentages assume net proceeds are invested in assets
that carry a 50% risk-weighting.
27
<PAGE>
USE OF PROCEEDS
Although the actual net proceeds from the sale of the Subscription Shares
cannot be determined until the Offering is completed, it is presently
anticipated that the net proceeds will be between $20.6 million and $28.1
million (or $32.3 million if the Offering Range is increased by 15%). See "Pro
Forma Data" and "The Conversion --Exchange Ratio" and "--Stock Pricing and
Number of Shares to be Issued" as to the assumptions used to arrive at such
amounts. The Company will be unable to utilize any of the net proceeds of the
Offering until the consummation of the Conversion.
The Company is expected to contribute to the Bank a portion of the net
proceeds of the Offering sufficient to increase the Bank's tangible capital to
at least 10% of its adjusted total assets. Such portion of the net proceeds will
be added to the Bank's general funds which the Bank currently intends to utilize
for general corporate purposes, including the partial repayment of FHLB
advances, investment in one-to-four family residential real estate loans and
other loans and investment in short-term and intermediate-term securities and
mortgage-backed securities. The Bank may also use such funds to expand
operations through the establishment or acquisition of branch offices, and the
acquisition of other financial institutions or other financial services
companies. To the extent the 1998 Recognition Plan is not funded with authorized
but unissued common stock of the Company, the Company or Bank may use net
proceeds from the Offering to fund the purchase of stock to be awarded under
such plan. See "Management of the Bank--Benefit Plans".
The Company intends to use a portion of the net proceeds to loan funds to
the KSOP to enable the KSOP to purchase 8% of the Subscription Shares issued in
the Offering. The Company and Bank may alternatively choose to fund the KSOP's
stock purchases through a loan by a third party financial institution. See
"Management of the Bank--Benefit Plans." The net proceeds retained by the
Company may also be used to support the future expansion of operations through
branch acquisitions, the establishment of new branch offices, and the
acquisition of other financial institutions or diversification into other
banking related businesses. The Bank entered into an agreement in August 1997
for the acquisition of three branch offices, and the Company and the Bank intend
to actively explore additional acquisitions, although neither the Company nor
the Bank has any specific plans, arrangements or understandings regarding any
additional expansions or acquisitions at this time, nor have criteria been
established to identify potential candidates for acquisition.
Upon completion of the Conversion, the Board of Directors of the Company
will have the authority to repurchase stock, subject to statutory and
regulatory requirements. Unless approved by the OTS, the Company, pursuant to
OTS policy, will be prohibited from repurchasing any shares of the Common
Stock for three years except (i) for an offer to all stockholders on a pro
rata basis, or (ii) for the repurchase of qualifying shares of a director.
Notwithstanding the foregoing and except as provided below, beginning one
year following completion of the Conversion, the Company may repurchase its
Common Stock so long as: (i) the repurchases within the following two years
are part of an open-market program not involving greater than 5% of its
outstanding capital stock during a twelve-month period; (ii) the repurchases
do not cause the Bank to become "undercapitalized" within the meaning of the
OTS prompt corrective action regulation; and (iii) the Company provides to
the Regional Director of the OTS no later than ten days prior to the
commencement of a repurchase program written notice containing a full
description of the program to be undertaken and such program is not
disapproved by the Regional Director.
Based upon facts and circumstances following the Conversion and subject to
applicable regulatory requirements, the Board of Directors may determine to
repurchase stock in the future. Such facts and circumstances may include but not
be limited to (i) market and economic factors such as the price at which the
stock is trading in the market, the volume of trading, the attractiveness of
other investment alternatives in terms of the rate of return and risk involved
in the investment, the ability to increase the book value and/ or earnings per
share of the remaining outstanding shares, and the opportunity to improve the
Company's return on equity; (ii) the avoidance of dilution to stockholders by
not having to issue additional shares to cover the exercise of stock options or
to fund employee stock benefit plans; and (iii) any other circumstances in which
repurchases would be in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders.
In the event the Company determines to repurchases stock, such repurchases may
be made at
28
<PAGE>
market prices which may be in excess of the Subscription Price in the
Offering. To the extent that the Company repurchases stock at market prices
in excess of the per share book value, such repurchases may have a dilutive
effect upon the interests of existing stockholders.
DIVIDEND POLICY
The Company intends to pay a quarterly cash dividend of $1.5 million, or
$0.373, $0.317, $0.276 and $0.240 per share of Common Stock on an annual basis,
at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and maximum, as adjusted, of the Offering
Range, respectively. The first dividend is expected to be declared for the
fiscal quarter ending June 30, 1998. Declarations of dividends by the Company's
Board of Directors will depend upon a number of factors, including the amount of
the net proceeds from the Offering retained by the Company, investment
opportunities available to the Company or the Bank, capital requirements,
regulatory limitations, the Company's and the Bank's financial condition and
results of operation, tax considerations and general economic conditions.
Consequently, there can be no assurance that dividends will in fact be paid on
the Common Stock or that, if paid, such dividends will not be reduced or
eliminated in future periods. See "Market for the Common Stock."
The Bank will not be permitted to pay dividends to the Company on its
capital stock if its stockholders' equity would be reduced below the amount
required for the liquidation account. See "The Conversion and
Reorganization--Liquidation Rights." For information concerning federal and
state law and regulations which apply to the Bank in determining the amount of
proceeds which may be retained by the Company and regarding a savings
institution's ability to make capital distributions including payment of
dividends to its holding company, see "Federal and State Taxation--Federal
Taxation--Distributions" and "Regulation--Federal Regulation of Savings
Institutions--Limitation on Capital Distributions."
Unlike the Bank, the Company is not subject to OTS regulatory restrictions
on the payment of dividends to its stockholders, although the source of such
dividends will be dependent on the net proceeds retained by the Company and
earnings thereon and may be dependent, in part, upon dividends from the Bank.
The Company is subject, however, to the requirements of Delaware law, which
generally limit dividends to an amount equal to the excess of the net assets of
the Company (the amount by which total assets exceed total liabilities) over its
statutory capital (generally defined as the aggregate par value of the
outstanding shares of the Company's capital stock without par value) or, if
there is no such excess, to its net profits for the current and/or immediately
preceding fiscal year.
Additionally, in connection with the Conversion, the Company and the Bank
have committed to the OTS that during the one-year period following the
consummation of the Conversion and the Reorganization, the Company will not take
any action to declare an extraordinary dividend to stockholders which would be
treated by recipient stockholders as a tax-free return of capital for federal
income tax purposes without prior approval of the OTS.
Since the completion of the first full fiscal quarter following the initial
sale by the Bank of the Bank Common Stock in April 1994, the Bank has paid
average annual cash dividends on the Bank Common Stock of $.725 per share, which
amounts to a quarterly dividend of $.181 per share. The Bank's current quarterly
cash dividend is $0.225 per share, and the Bank intends to continue to pay
regular quarterly cash dividends through the fiscal quarter ending March 31,
1998.
MARKET FOR THE COMMON STOCK
There is an established market for the Bank Common Stock which is currently
listed on the Nasdaq "SmallCap" Market under the symbol, "PFSL," and the Bank
had three market makers as of September 30, 1997. As a newly formed company,
however, the Company has never issued capital stock and consequently there is no
established market for its Common Stock. It is expected that the Common Stock
will be more liquid than the Bank Common Stock since there will be significantly
more outstanding shares owned by the public. However, there can be no assurance
that an active and liquid trading market for the Common Stock will develop, or
if developed, will be maintained. Minority Shares will automatically, without
further action by the holders thereof, be converted into
29
<PAGE>
and become a right to receive a number of shares of Company Common Stock that
is determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio. See "The Conversion and
Reorganization--Share Exchange Ratio."
The Company has applied to have its Common Stock listed on the Nasdaq
National Market under the Bank's previous symbol "PFSL." One of the
requirements for quotation of the Common Stock on the Nasdaq National Market
is that there be at least three market makers for the Common Stock. The
Company will seek to encourage and assist at least three market makers to
make a market in its Common Stock. Making a market involves maintaining bid
and ask quotations and being able, as principal, to effect transactions in
reasonable quantities at those quoted prices, subject to various securities
laws and other regulatory requirements. Although not legally or contractually
required to do so, FBR has advised the Company that upon completion of the
Conversion, it intends to act as a market maker in the Common Stock,
depending upon the volume of trading and subject to compliance with
applicable laws and regulatory requirements. While the Company has attempted
to obtain commitments from other broker-dealers to act as market makers, and
anticipates that prior to the completion of the Conversion it will be able to
obtain the commitment from at least two other broker-dealers to act as market
makers for the Common Stock, there can be no assurance there will be three or
more market makers for the Common Stock or that the Company's application for
listing on the Nasdaq National Market will be approved.
Additionally, the development of a public market having the desirable
characteristics of depth, liquidity and orderliness depends on the existence of
willing buyers and sellers, the presence of which is not within the control of
the Company, the Bank or any market maker. In the event that institutional
investors buy a relatively large proportion of the Offering, the number of
active buyers and sellers of the Common Stock at any particular time may be
limited. There can be no assurance that persons purchasing the Common Stock will
be able to sell their shares at or above the Subscription Price. Therefore,
purchasers of the Common Stock should have a long-term investment intent and
should recognize that a possibly limited trading market may make it difficult to
sell the Common Stock after the Conversion and may have an adverse effect on the
price of the Common Stock.
The following table sets forth the high and low bid quotes for the
Minority Shares since the completion of the Minority Stock Offering in which
the Minority Shares were sold for $10.00 per share, together with the cash
dividends declared subsequent thereto. These quotations represent prices
between dealers and do not include retail markups, markdowns, or commissions
and do not reflect actual transactions. This information has been obtained
from monthly statistical summaries provided by the Nasdaq Stock Market. As of
February 1, 1997 there were 769,924 Minority Shares outstanding.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
HIGH LOW
1997 BID BID
- ------------------------------- --------- ---------
<S> <C> <C>
1st Quarter Ended 12-31-96 $ 17.50 $ 14.25
2nd Quarter Ended 3-31-97 $ 20.00 $ 16.75
3rd Quarter Ended 6-30-97 $ 20.75 $ 17.75
4th Quarter Ended 9-30-97 $ 36.00 $ 20.00
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
HIGH LOW
1996 BID BID
- ------------------------------- --------- ---------
<S> <C> <C>
1st Quarter Ended 12-31-95 $ 16.75 $ 14.00
2nd Quarter Ended 3-31-96 $ 17.25 $ 15.75
3rd Quarter Ended 6-30-96 $ 15.75 $ 14.25
4th Quarter Ended 9-30-96 $ 15.63 $ 14.25
</TABLE>
30
<PAGE>
Cash Dividends Declared in Fiscal 1997:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
RECORD PAYMENT DIVIDEND
DATE DATE PER SHARE
- --------- --------- -----------
<S> <C> <C>
12/15/96 01/03/97 $ 0.210
03/15/97 04/03/97 $ 0.225
06/15/97 07/03/97 $ 0.225
09/15/97 10/03/97 $ 0.225
</TABLE>
Cash Dividends Declared in Fiscal 1996:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
RECORD PAYMENT DIVIDEND
DATE DATE PER SHARE
- --------- --------- -----------
<S> <C> <C>
12/15/95 01/03/96 $ 0.170
03/15/96 04/03/96 $ 0.190
06/15/96 07/03/96 $ 0.200
09/16/96 10/03/96 $ 0.210
</TABLE>
At September 17, 1997 (the day immediately preceding the public announcement
of the Conversion) and at February , 1997, the last sale of Minority
Shares as reported on the Nasdaq "SmallCap" Market was at a price of $28.00 per
share and $ per share, respectively. At October 31, 1997, the Bank had
291 stockholders of record. All Minority Shares, including shares held by the
Bank's officers and directors, will on the Effective Date be automatically
converted into and become the right to receive a number of shares of Common
Stock of the Company determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio, and options to
purchase Minority Shares will be converted into options to purchase a number of
shares of Common Stock determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio, for the same
aggregate exercise price. See "Beneficial Ownership of Common Stock.
CAPITALIZATION
The following table presents the historical consolidated capitalization of
the Bank at September 30, 1997, and the pro forma consolidated capitalization of
the Company after giving effect to the Conversion, based upon the assumptions
set forth in the "Pro Forma Data" section.
31
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED CAPITALIZATION
BASED UPON THE SALE FOR $10.00 PER SHARE OF
--------------------------------------------------
HISTORICAL 2,125,000 2,500,000 2,875,000 3,306,250
CAPITALIZATION SHARES SHARES SHARES SHARES (1)
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Deposits (2)................................................... $ 143,354 $ 143,354 $ 143,354 $ 143,354 $ 143,354
Borrowed funds................................................. 211,286 211,286 211,286 211,286 211,286
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Total deposits and borrowed funds.............................. $ 354,640 $ 354,640 $ 354,640 $ 354,640 $ 354,640
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Stockholders' equity:
Preferred Stock, $.01 par value, 10,000,000 shares authorized;
none to be issued (3)...................................... -- -- -- -- --
Common Stock, $.01 par value, 30,000,000 shares authorized;
shares to be issued as reflected (3)....................... 163 40 47 54 63
Additional paid-in capital (4)............................... 14,914 35,675 39,384 43,092 47,357
Retained income (5).......................................... 9,273 9,734 9,734 9,734 9,734
Less:
Common Stock acquired by KSOP.............................. (104) (104) (104) (104) (104)
Additional Common Stock to be acquired by ESOP (6)......... -- (1,700) (2,000) (2,300) (2,645)
Common Stock to be acquired by 1998 Recognition Plan (7) -- (850) (1,000) (1,150) (1,323)
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Total stockholders' equity............................... $ 24,246 $ 42,795 $ 46,061 $ 49,326 $ 53,082
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Total stockholders' equity as a percentage of pro forma total
assets..................................................... 6.32% 10.66% 11.38% 12.09% 12.89%
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) As adjusted to give effect to an increase in the number of shares which
could occur due to a 15% increase in the Offering Range to reflect changes
in market or general financial conditions following the commencement of the
Subscription and Community Offerings.
(2) Does not reflect withdrawals from deposit accounts for the purchase of
Common Stock in the Conversion. Such withdrawals would reduce pro forma
deposits by the amount of such withdrawals.
(3) The Bank has 10,000,000 authorized shares of preferred stock.
(4) Does not include proceeds from the Offering that the Company intends to
lend to the KSOP to enable it to purchase shares of Common Stock in the
Offering. No effect has been given to the issuance of additional shares
of Common Stock pursuant to the 1998 Stock Option Plan and 1998
Recognition Plan expected to be adopted by the Company. If such plans are
approved by stockholders, an amount equal to 10% of the shares of Common
Stock issued in the Offering will be reserved for issuance upon the
exercise of options under the 1998 Stock Option Plan, and the 1998
Recognition Plan will acquire an amount of Common Stock equal to 4% of
the number of shares sold in the Offering, either through open market
purchases or from authorized but unissued shares. No effect has been
given to the exercise of options currently outstanding. See "Management
of the Bank-- Benefits." The Bank has 20,000,000 authorized shares of
Bank Common Stock, par value $.10 per share.
(5) Pro forma retained income reflects consolidation of $461,000 of Mutual
Holding Company assets in conjunction with the Offering. The retained income
of the Bank will be substantially restricted after the Conversion, see "The
Conversion--Liquidation Rights" and "Regulation and Supervision-- Federal
Regulations of Savings Institutions--Limitations on Capital Distributions."
(6) Assumes that 8% of the shares issued in the Offering will be acquired by
the ESOP portion of the KSOP financed by a loan from the Company. The
loan will be repaid principally from the Bank's contributions to the
KSOP. Since the Company will finance the ESOP debt, the ESOP debt will be
eliminated through consolidation and no liability will be reflected on
the Company's consolidated financial statements. Accordingly, the amount
of stock acquired by the ESOP is shown in this table as a reduction of
total stockholders' equity.
(7) Assumes a number of shares of Common Stock equal to 4% of the Common
Stock to be sold in the Offering will be purchased by the 1998
Recognition Plan in open market puchases. The dollar amount of Common
Stock to be purchased is based on the $10.00 per share Subscription Price
in the Offering and represents unearned compensation and is reflected as
a reduction of capital. Such amount does not reflect possible increases
or decreases in the value of such stock relative to the Subscription
Price in the Offering. As the Bank accrues compensation expense to
reflect the vesting of such shares pursuaht to the 1998 Recognition Plan,
the charge against capital will be reduced accordingly. Implementation of
the 1998 Recognition Plan will require stockholder approval. If the
shares to fund the Plan are assumed to come from authorized but unissued
shares purchased by the 1998 Recognition Plan from the Company at the
Subscription Price, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and the maximum, ad
adjusted, of the offering Range, the number of outstanding shares would
be 4,106,914, 4,831,663, 5,556,413 and 6,389,925, respectively, and total
stockholders' equity would be $43.6 million, $47.1 million, $50.5 million
and $54.4 million, respectively, at September 30, 1997. As a result of
the plan acquiring authorized but unissued shares from the Company,
stockholders' ownership in the Company would be diluted by approximately
2.07%.
PRO FORMA DATA
The actual net proceeds from the sale of the Common Stock in the Offering
cannot be determined until the Conversion is completed. However, net proceeds
are currently estimated to be between $20.6 million and $28.1 million based upon
the following assumptions: (i) 63,800 shares are sold in the Offering to the
Bank's directors, officers, employees and their families and remaining shares
are sold in the Subscription Offering; (ii) 8% of the shares sold in the
Offering are purchased by the KSOP; (iii) FBR receives no fee for the sale of
shares to the KSOP and the Bank's directors, officers, employees and their
families; and (iv) Conversion expenses, excluding marketing fees described
above, are $422,500.
Actual Conversion expenses may vary from those estimated, because the fees
paid will depend upon the percentages and total number of the shares sold in the
Offering and other factors. Under the Plan of Conversion, the Common Stock must
be sold in the Offering at an aggregate Subscription Price not less than nor
greater than the Offering Range, which is subject to adjustment. The Offering
Range, as established by the Board of Directors is
32
<PAGE>
between a minimum of $21.2 million and a maximum of $28.8 million, with a
midpoint of $25.0 million. This represents a range between a minimum of
2,125,000 shares and a maximum of 2,875,000 shares, based upon the
Subscription Price of $10.00 per share. If the Offering Range is increased by
up to 15% to reflect market or general financial conditions following the
commencement of the Offering, the adjusted maximum number of shares of Common
Stock to be issued would be 3,306,250 for estimated gross proceeds of $33.1
million.
Pro forma consolidated net income of the Company for the fiscal year
ended September 30, 1997 has been calculated as if the Company had been in
existence and estimated net proceeds received by the Company and the Bank had
been invested at an assumed interest rate of 5.44% for the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1997. The reinvestment rate was calculated based on the one
year U.S. Treasury bill rate. The use of this rate is viewed to be more
relevant in the current low interest rate environment than the use of an
arithmetic average of the weighted average yield earned on interest-earning
assets and the weighted average rate paid on deposits during such periods.
The effect of withdrawals from deposit accounts for the purchase of Common
Stock has not been reflected. The pro forma after-tax yield on the estimated
net proceeds is assumed to be 3.36% for the fiscal year ended September 30,
1997, based on an effective combined federal and state tax rate of 38.3%.
Historical and pro forma per share amounts have been calculated by dividing
historical and pro forma amounts by the indicated number of shares of Common
Stock. No effect has been given in the pro forma stockholders' equity
calculations for the assumed earnings on the net proceeds. It has been
assumed that the Company has contributed to the Bank a portion of the net
proceeds of the Offering sufficient to increase the Bank's tangible capital
to at least 10% of its adjusted total assets.
The following pro forma information may not be representative of the
financial effects of the foregoing transactions at the dates on which such
transactions actually occur and should not be taken as indicative of future
results of operations. Pro forma consolidated stockholders' equity represents
the difference between the stated amount of assets and liabilities of the
Company computed in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles
("GAAP"). The pro forma stockholders' equity is not intended to represent the
fair market value of the Common Stock and may be greater than amounts that
would be available for distribution to stockholders in the event of
liquidation.
33
<PAGE>
The following table summarizes historical data of the Bank and pro forma
data of the Company at or for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, based
on assumptions set forth above and in the table and should not be used as a
basis for projections of market value of the Common Stock following the
Conversion. No effect has been given in the tables to the possible issuance
of additional shares reserved for future issuance pursuant to currently
outstanding stock options or the 1998 Stock Option Plan, nor does book value
give any effect to the liquidation account to be established in the
Conversion or the bad debt reserve in liquidation. See "The
Conversion--Liquidation Rights," and "Management of the Bank-- Directors'
Compensation," and "--Executive Compensation."
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT OR FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997
BASED UPON THE SALE FOR $10.00 OF
--------------------------------------------------
2,125,000 2,500,000 2,875,000 3,306,250
SHARES SHARES SHARES SHARES (1)
----------- ---------- ----------- -----------
(DOLLARS AND SHARES IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Gross proceeds................................ $ 21,250 $ 25,000 $ 28,750 $ 33,063
Expenses...................................... 618 653 687 720
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------
Estimated net proceeds...................... $ 20,632 $ 24,347 $ 28,063 $ 32,343
Common stock purchased by KSOP (2).......... (1,700) (2,000) (2,300) (2,645)
Common stock purchased by 1998
Recognition Plan (3)....................... (850) (1,000) (1,150) (1,323)
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------
Estimated net proceeds, as adjusted...... $ 18,082 $ 21,347 $ 24,613 $ 28,375
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------
----------- ----------- ----------- ----------
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997:
Net income:
Historical.................................. $ 2,376 $ 2,376 $ 2,376 $ 2,376
Pro forma adjustments:
Income on adjusted net proceeds............. 607 717 826 952
KSOP (2).................................... (105) (123) (142) (163)
1998 Recognition Plan (3)................... (105) (123) (142) (163)
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Pro forma net income..................... $ 2,773 $ 2,847 $ 2,918 $ 3,002
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Net income per share (4):
Historical (8).............................. $ 0.61 $ 0.52 $ 0.45 $ 0.39
Pro forma adjustments:
Income on net proceeds...................... 0.17 0.17 0.16 0.17
KSOP (2).................................... (0.03) (0.03) (0.03) (0.03)
1998 Recognition Plan (3)................... (0.03) (0.03) (0.03) (0.03)
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Pro forma net income per share (4) (5).. $ 0.72 $ 0.63 $ 0.55 $ 0.50
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Pro forma price to earnings................... 13.89x 15.87x 18.05x 20.00x
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Number of shares used in price to earnings
ratio calculations........................... 3,868,914 4,551,663 5,234,413 6,019,575
At September 30, 1997:
Stockholders' equity:
Historical (8).............................. $ 24,707 $ 24,707 $ 24,707 $ 24,707
Estimated net proceeds...................... 20,632 24,347 28,063 32,343
Less: Common stock acquired by KSOP (2)..... (1,700) (2,000) (2,300) (2,645)
Common Stock acquired by 1998
Recognition Plan (3)................. (850) (1,000) (1,150) (1,323)
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Pro forma stockholders' equity (6)............ $ 42,789 $ 46,054 $ 49,320 $ 53,082
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Stockholders' equity per share (7):
Historical.................................. $ 6.14 $ 5.22 $ 4.54 $ 3.95
Estimated net proceeds...................... 5.13 5.14 5.15 5.16
Less: Common stock acquired by KSOP (2)..... (0.42) (0.42) (0.42) (0.42)
Common Stock acquired by 1998
Recognition Plan (3).................. (0.21) (0.21) (0.21) (0.21)
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Pro forma stockholders' equity per
share (6)(7)............................... $ 10.64 $ 9.73 $ 9.06 $ 8.48
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Offering price as a percentage of pro forma
stockholders' equity per share.............. 93.98% 102.77% 110.38% 117.92%
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Number of shares used in book value per
share calculations.......................... 4,021,914 4,731,663 5,441,413 6,257,625
Pro forma equity as a percent
of pro forma assets......................... 10.66% 11.38% 12.09% 12.89%
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) As adjusted to give effect to an increase in the number of shares which
could occur due to a 15% increase in the Offering Range to reflect changes
in market and financial conditions following the commencement of the
Offering.
34
<PAGE>
(footnotes continued)
(2) Assumes that 8% of shares of Common Stock sold in the Offering will be
purchased by the ESOP portion of the KSOP. For purposes of this table,
the funds used to acquire such shares are assumed to have been borrowed
by the ESOP portion of the KSOP from the net proceeds of the Offering
retained by the Company. The Bank intends to make annual contributions to
the KSOP in an amount at least equal to the principal of the debt. The
Bank's total annual payments on the KSOP debt is based upon ten equal
annual installments of principal. Statement of Position 93-6 requires
that an employer record compensation expense in an amount equal to the
fair value of the shares committed to be released to employees. The pro
forma adjustments assume that the KSOP shares are allocated in equal
annual installments based on the number of loan repayment installments
assumed to be paid by the Bank, the fair value of the Common Stock
remains at the Subscription Price and the KSOP expense reflects an
effective combined federal and state tax rate of 38.3%. The unallocated
KSOP shares are reflected as a reduction of stockholders' equity. No
reinvestment is assumed on proceeds contributed to fund the KSOP. The pro
forma net income further assumes (i) that 17,000, 20,000, 23,000 and
26,450 shares were committed to be released with respect to the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1997, in each case at the minimum, midpoint,
maximum, and adjusted maximum of the Offering Range, respectively, and
(ii) in accordance with SOP 93-6, only the KSOP shares committed to be
released during the respective period were considered outstanding for
purposes of net income per share calculations. See "Management of the
Bank--Benefit Plans--Employee Stock Ownership Plan and Trust."
(3) Subject to the approval of the Company's stockholders, the 1998 Recognition
Plan intends to purchase an aggregate number of shares of Common Stock equal
to 4% of the shares to be issued in the Offering. The shares may be acquired
directly from the Company, or through open market purchases. The funds to be
used by the 1998 Recognition Plan to purchase the shares will be provided by
the Bank or the Company. See "Management of the Bank--Benefit Plans--1998
Recognition Plan." Assumes that the 1998 Recognition Plan acquires the
shares through open market purchases at the Subscription Price with funds
contributed by the Bank, and that 20% of the amount contributed to the 1998
Recognition Plan is amortized as an expense during the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1997, and the 1998 Recognition and Retention Plan expense
reflects an effective combined federal and state tax rate of 38.3%.
Assuming Stockholder approval of the plan and that the plan shares are
awarded through the use of authorized-but-unissued shares of Common Stock,
Stockholders would have their voting interests diluted by approximately
2.07%.
(4) Per share figures include shares of Common Stock that will be exchanged for
Minority Shares in the Share Exchange. Net income per share computations are
determined by taking the number of subscription shares assumed to be sold in
the Offering and the number of Exchange Shares assumed to be issued in the
Share Exchange and, in accordance with SOP 93-6, subtracting the KSOP shares
which have not been committed for release during the respective period. See
Note 2 above. The number of shares of Common Stock actually sold and the
corresponding number of Exchange Shares may be more or less than the assumed
amounts.
(5) No effect has been given to the issuance of additional shares of Common
Stock pursuant to the 1998 Stock Option Plan, which is expected to be
adopted by the Company following the Offering and presented to stockholders
for approval. If the 1998 Stock Option Plan is approved by stockholders, an
amount equal to 10% of the Common Stock sold in the Offerings will be
reserved for future issuance upon the exercise of options to be granted
under the 1998 Stock Option Plan. The issuance of authorized but previously
unissued shares of Common Stock pursuant to the exercise of options under
such plan would dilute existing stockholders' interests. Assuming
stockholder approval of the plan, that all the options were exercised at the
end of the period at an exercise price equal to the Subscription Price, and
that the 1998 Recognition Plan purchases shares in the open market at the
Subscription Price, (i) pro forma net income per share for the fiscal year
ended September 30, 1997 would be $0.70, $0.61, $0.55 and $0.49, and the pro
forma stockholders' equity per share at September 30, 1997 would be $10.60,
$9.75, $9.11 and $8.56, in each case at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and
adjusted maximum of the Offering Range, respectively.
(6) The retained income of the Bank will be substantially restricted after the
Conversion. See "Dividend Policy," "The Conversion--Liquidation Rights" and
"Regulation and Supervision--Federal Regulation of Savings
Institutions--Limitation on Capital Distributions."
(7) Per share figures include shares of Common Stock that will be exchanged for
Minority Shares in the Share Exchange. Stockholders' equity per share
calculations are based upon the sum of (i) the number of Subscription Shares
assumed to be sold in the Offering, and (ii) Exchange Shares equal to the
minimum, midpoint, maximum and adjusted maximum of the Offering Range,
respectively. The Exchange Shares reflect an Exchange Ratio of 2.4638,
2.8985, 3.3333 and 3.8333, respectively, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum,
and adjusted maximum of the Offering Range, respectively. The number of
Subscription Shares actually sold and the corresponding number of Exchange
Shares may be more or less than the assumed amounts.
(8) Includes $461,000 in Mutual Holding Company assets.
35
<PAGE>
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
GENERAL
The Bank's net income is primarily affected by its net interest income,
which is the difference between interest income earned on its loan,
mortgage-backed securities, and investment portfolios, and its cost of funds
consisting of interest paid on deposits and borrowed funds, including FHLB
advances. The Bank's net income also is affected by its provisions for losses
on loans and investments in real estate, as well as the amount of noninterest
income (including fees and service charges and gains or losses on sales of
loans), and noninterest expense, including salaries and employee benefits,
premises and equipment expense, data processing expense, federal deposit
insurance premiums and income taxes. Net income of the Bank also is affected
significantly by general economic and competitive conditions, particularly
changes in market interest rates, government policies, and actions of
regulatory authorities.
MARKET RISK ANALYSIS
GENERAL. It is the objective of the Bank to minimize, to the degree
prudently possible, its exposure to interest rate risk, while maintaining an
acceptable interest rate spread. Interest rate spread is the difference
between the Bank's yield on its interest-earning assets and its cost of
interest-bearing liabilities. Interest rate risk is generally understood to
be the sensitivity of the Bank's earnings, net asset values, and
stockholders' equity to changes in market interest rates.
Changes in interest rates affect the Bank's earnings. The effect on
earnings of changes in interest rates generally depends on how quickly the
Bank's yield on interest-earning assets and cost of interest-bearing
liabilities react to the changes in market rates of interest. If the Bank's
cost of deposit accounts reacts more quickly to changes in market interest
rates than the yield on the Bank's mortgage loans and other interest-earnings
assets, then an increasing interest rate environment is likely to adversely
affect the Bank's earnings and a decreasing interest rate environment is
likely to favorably affect the Bank's earnings. On the other hand, if the
Bank's yield on its mortgage loans and other interest-earnings assets reacts
more quickly to changes in market interest rates than the Bank's cost of
deposit accounts, then an increasing interest rate environment is likely to
favorably affect the Bank's earnings and a decreasing interest rate
environment is likely to adversely affect the Bank's earnings.
36
<PAGE>
The following table presents the difference between the Bank's
interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities at September 30,
1997 expected to reprice or mature, based on certain assumptions, in each of
the future time periods shown. This table does not necessarily indicate the
impact of general interest rate movements on the Bank's net interest income
because the repricing of certain assets and liabilities is subject to
competitive and other limitations. As a result, certain assets and
liabilities indicated as maturing or otherwise repricing within a stated
period may in fact mature or reprice at different times and at different
volumes. This table also does not reflect the impact of $40 million in
notional amount of interest rate caps purchased by the Bank with expiration
dates ranging from December 1998 to December 1999. The effect of such
interest rate caps would reduce the Bank's one year cumulative interest rate
sensitivity gap to a negative 9.26% at September 30, 1997.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
MORE THAN
MORE THAN THREE YEARS
WITHIN ONE YEAR TO TO FIVE OVER
ONE YEAR THREE YEARS YEARS FIVE YEARS TOTAL
---------- ----------- ------------ ----------- ----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Interest-earning assets:
Mortgage loans:
Fixed-rate........................................ $ 6,001 $ 4,076 $ 2,110 $ 4,858 $ 17,045
Adjustable-rate................................... 53,178 51,173 17,153 -- 121,504
Non-mortgage loans:
Fixed-rate........................................ 10,429 15,685 -- -- 26,114
Adjustable rate................................... -- -- -- -- --
Securities held to maturity:
Investment securities............................. 512 26,373 5 4,823 31,713
Mortgage-backed securities........................ 154,672 7,442 3,789 2,937 168,840
Federal Home Loan Bank stock...................... 10,053 -- -- -- 10,053
--------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------
Total interest-earning assets....................... $ 234,845 $ 104,749 $ 23,057 $ 12,618 $ 375,269
--------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------
--------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------
Interest-bearing liabilities:
Deposits:
Demand accounts................................... $ -- $ -- $ -- $ 17,350 $ 17,350
Savings accounts.................................. 9,069 -- -- 8,655 17,724
Certificates of deposit........................... 89,363 18,064 853 -- 108,280
Other Liabilities
FHLB advances--Fixed Rate......................... $ 114,001 $ -- $ -- $ -- $ 114,001
FHLB advances--Variable Rate...................... 76,600 -- -- -- 76,600
Reverse repurchase agreements..................... 20,685 -- -- -- 20,685
ESOP Loan......................................... (104) -- -- -- (104)
--------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------
Total interest-bearing liabilities.................. $ 309,614 $ 18,064 $ 853 $ 26,005 $ 354,536
--------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------
--------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------
Excess (deficiency) of interest-earning assets
over interest-bearing liabilities................. (74,769) 86,685 22,204 (13,387) 20,733
Cumulative excess (deficiency) of interest-earning
assets over interest-bearing liabilities.......... (74,769) 11,916 34,120 20,733
Cumulative ratio of excess (deficiency) of
interest-earning assets as a percentage of total
assets............................................ (19.49)% 3.11% 8.89% 5.40%
</TABLE>
37
<PAGE>
In preparing the table above, it has been assumed, in assessing the
interest rate sensitivity of the Bank, that: (i) mortgage loans will prepay
at a rate of 12.0% per year, (ii) fixed maturity deposits will not be
withdrawn prior to maturity; and (iii) demand and savings accounts will decay
at the following rates:
OVER 1 OVER 3
1 YEAR THROUGH THROUGH OVER 5
OR LESS 3 YEARS 5 YEARS YEARS
--------- --------- --------- --------
Demand accounts.......... 37.0% 32.0% 17.0% 17.0%
Savings accounts......... 17.0% 17.0% 16.0% 14.0%
Certain shortcomings are inherent in the method of analysis presented in
the preceding table. For example, although certain assets and liabilities may
have similar maturities or periods to repricing, they may react in different
degrees to changes in market interest rates. In addition, the interest rates
on certain types of assets and liabilities may fluctuate in advance of
changes in market interest rates, while interest rates on other types may lag
behind changes in market rates. Certain assets, such as adjustable-rate
mortgage loans, have features which restrict changes in interest rates on a
short-term basis and over the life of the assets. Further, in the event of a
change in interest rates, prepayment and early withdrawal levels would likely
deviate significantly from those assumed in calculating the table. Finally,
the ability of many borrowers to make payments on their adjustable-rate debt
may decrease in the event of an interest rate increase.
NET PORTFOLIO VALUE. The value of the Bank's loan and investment
portfolio will change as interest rates change. Rising interest rates will
generally decrease the Bank's net portfolio value, while falling interest
rates will generally increase the value of that portfolio. The following
table sets forth, quantitatively, as of September 30, 1997 the OTS estimate
of the projected changes in net portfolio value ("NPV") in the event of a
100, 200, 300 and 400 basis point instantaneous and permanent increase and
decrease in market interest rates:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
CHANGE IN NPV
AS A PERCENTAGE OF
CHANGE IN ESTIMATED MARKET
INTEREST RATES NET PORTFOLIO VALUE VALUE OF ASSETS
IN BASIS POINTS ------------------------------------- ----------------------
(RATE SHOCK) AMOUNT $CHANGE % CHANGE NPV RATIO CHANGE
- --------------- ---------- ------------ ----------- ----------- --------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
+400 $ 2,203 $ (33,549) (94)% 0.62% $ (844)
+300 11,914 (23,838) (67) 3.24 (582)
+200 21,171 (14,582) (41) 5.61 (345)
+100 29,115 (6,637) (19) 7.53 (153)
+0 35,752 -- -- 9.06 --
(100) 37,922 2,170 6 9.53 47
(200) 37,544 1,792 5 9.43 37
(300) 40,071 4,319 12 9.98 92
(400) 43,335 7,583 21 10.68 162
</TABLE>
Computations of prospective effects of hypothetical interest rate changes
are calculated by the OTS from data provided by the Bank and are based on
numerous assumptions, including relative levels of market interest rates,
loan repayments and deposit runoffs, and should not be relied upon as
indicative of actual results. Further, the computations do not contemplate
any actions the Bank may undertake in response to changes in interest rates.
Management cannot predict future interest rates or their effect on the
Bank's NPV in the future. Certain shortcomings are inherent in the method of
analysis presented in the computation of NPV. For example, although
38
<PAGE>
certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods to
repricing, they may react in differing degrees to changes in market interest
rates. Additionally, certain assets, such as adjustable rate loans, which
represent the Bank's primary loan product, have features which restrict
changes in interest rates during the initial term and over the remaining life
of the asset. In addition, the proportion of adjustable rate loans in the
Bank's portfolio could decrease in future periods due to refinancing activity
if market interest rates decrease. Further, in the event of a change in
interest rates, prepayment and early withdrawal levels could deviate
significantly from those assumed in the table. Finally, the ability of many
borrowers to service their adjustable-rate debt may decrease in the event of
an interest rate increase.
COMPARISON OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
GENERAL. The Bank's total assets increased $1.8 million, or 0.5%, from
$381.6 million at September 30, 1996 to $383.4 million at September 30, 1997.
Total assets increased $33.0 million, or 9.5%, from $348.6 million at
September 30, 1995 to $381.6 million at September 30, 1996.
LOANS RECEIVABLE, NET. The Bank's net loans receivable increased by $22.8
million, or 16.7%, and $20.4 million, or 17.5%, in fiscal years 1997 and
1996, respectively from the prior years. The increases in both periods were
due to significant increases in loan origination activity, reflecting
increased loan demand in the Bank's lending area during 1997 and 1996.
INVESTMENT SECURITIES. The investment securities portfolio decreased by
$19.1 million, or 8.7%, to $200.6 million at September 30, 1997 as principal
paydowns and maturities of investments were used to fund loan growth. The
investment securities portfolio increased $5.3 million, or 2.5%, to $219.7
million at September 30, 1996 compared to $214.4 million at September 30,
1995. The slowdown in growth in the investment securities portfolio during
fiscal 1996 was due to the increased loan demand and the utilization of
available funds to fund mortgage loan originations.
CASH SURRENDER VALUE OF LIFE INSURANCE. During the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1996, the Bank purchased life insurance on the lives of certain
executive officers and members of the board of directors. Such life insurance
had cash surrender value of approximately $5.6 million and $5.4 million at
September 30, 1997 and 1996, respectively. The increase in fiscal 1997 was
due to earnings on the cash surrender value, net of premiums.
DEPOSITS. Historically, deposits have provided the Bank with a stable
source of relatively low cost funding. The market for deposits is
competitive, which has caused the Bank to utilize primarily certificate
accounts that are more responsive to market interest rates rather than
passbook accounts. The Bank offers a traditional line of deposit products
that currently includes checking, interest-bearing checking, savings,
certificate of deposit, commercial checking and money market accounts. The
$27.1 million, or 23.3%, increase in deposits during the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1997 was primarily due to the Bank's initiation of a national
certificate of deposit marketing program. During the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1997, deposits represented by certificates of deposit increased
by $26.4 million, or 32.3%. The $3.8 million, or 3.4%, increase in deposits
during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996 was due to regular deposit
inflow and marketing of the Bank's deposit products.
FHLB ADVANCES AND REVERSE REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS. The Bank also relies
upon FHLB advances and reverse repurchase agreements as a primary source of
funds to fund assets. Approximately 55.1% and 62.2% of the Bank's assets were
funded with FHLB advances and reverse repurchase agreements as of September
30, 1997 and 1996, respectively. At September 30, 1997, FHLB advances and
reverse repurchase agreements totaled $211.3 million, a decrease of $26.0
million, or 11.0%, from 1996, reflecting, in part, the increased deposits
resulting from the Bank's national certificate of deposit marketing program
in fiscal 1997. FHLB advances and reverse repurchase agreements totaled
$237.3 million at September 30, 1996, an increase of $26.3 million, or 12.5%,
from 1995.
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY. Stockholders' equity increased by $1.6 million, or
6.9%, to $24.2 million at September 30, 1997. The increase was attributable
to net income of $2.4 million for the fiscal year ended September
39
<PAGE>
30, 1997. Stockholders' equity increased by $1.7 million, or 8.1%, to $22.7
million at September 30, 1996. The increase reflected net income of $2.0
million for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996. Stockholders' equity
includes no contributed capital from the issuance of 862,500 shares of common
stock to Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company.
BUSINESS STRATEGY
The Bank's business objective is to operate as a profitable independent
community-oriented savings association dedicated primarily to financing home
ownership while maintaining capital in excess of regulatory requirements. To
achieve this objective, the Bank has adopted a business strategy designed to:
(1) emphasize the origination of single family residential mortgage loans and
commercial, commercial real estate, agricultural and multifamily residential
real estate loans, particularly in the area in and around the City of
Jonesboro, the fastest growing area within the Bank's market area; (2)
maintain or improve asset quality; (3) reduce interest rate risk exposure by
better matching asset and liability maturities and rates; (4) closely monitor
the needs of customers in order to provide personal, quality customer
service; and (5) utilize FHLB advances to fund the Bank's leverage strategy,
to help manage interest rate risk, and to reduce the overall cost of
interest-bearing liabilities. Management intends to continue this strategy
upon completion of the Offering.
Highlights of the principal elements of the Bank's business strategy are
as follows:
MANAGED GROWTH IN RETAIL BANKING. Following the initial issuance of Bank
Common Stock in 1994, management implemented a strategy of leveraging capital
by investing in mortgage-backed securities and other investment securities
for the purpose of increasing return on equity and earnings per share. More
recently, as the purchased mortgage-backed securities have matured and as
demand for higher yielding real estate and other loans in the Bank's market
area has increased, mortgage-backed securities and investment securities as a
percentage of the Bank's total assets have decreased. Management expects to
continue to emphasize the origination of higher-yielding single family
residential mortgage loans, and commercial, commercial real estate,
agricultural and multifamily residential real estate loans following the
Conversion. For this purpose, the Bank will seek to increase its loan
originations particularly in the Jonesboro area, which is the fastest growing
area within the Bank's market area. The City of Jonesboro, which recently was
designed a Metropolitan Statistical Area, has recently experienced an influx
of a number of small- and medium-sized manufacturing plants, accompanied by
steady population growth. The Bank has recently added a commercial loan
officer in Jonesboro and the Bank recently acquired another branch office
located in the Jonesboro area. The Bank will continue to invest in
mortgage-backed securities as needed to supplement local mortgage demand, as
well as to improve the Bank's interest rate sensitivity gap and to reduce the
overall credit risk of its assets.
ASSET QUALITY. The Bank has continued to focus on the origination of
single-family residential mortgage loans collateralized by properties in its
market area. At September 30, 1997, single family residential mortgage loans
constituted $138.5 million, or 86.8% of the Bank's total net loan portfolio.
The Bank also invests in mortgage-backed securities, which are securities
collateralized by FNMA and FHLMC mortgage-backed securities. Mortgage-backed
securities increase the credit quality of the Bank's assets because of the
federal government or agency guarantees that back them. Single-family
residential mortgage loans typically have less credit risk than commercial,
commercial real
40
<PAGE>
estate, agricultural and multifamily residential real estate loans. In
addition, the Bank has sought to reduce its nonperforming assets by
restructuring or foreclosing upon and selling such assets. The Bank's ability
to reduce its real estate owned ("REO"), however, substantially depends on
market conditions in the Bank's market area. There can be no assurance that
the Bank will be able to dispose of REO properties promptly and at current
estimated fair values. At September 30, 1997, the Bank's nonperforming assets
constituted 0.12% of total assets. See "Business of the Bank--Lending
Activities--Delinquencies and Classified Assets-- Nonperforming Assets" and
"--Classification of Assets."
INTEREST RATE RISK MANAGEMENT. Deposit accounts typically react more
quickly to changes in market interest rates than mortgage loans because of
the shorter average maturities of deposits compared to mortgage loans. As a
result, sharp increases in interest rates may adversely affect the Bank's
earnings while decreases in interest rates may beneficially affect earnings.
However, this effect on earnings may be mitigated by interest rate risk
management strategies. In order to reduce the potential volatility of the
Bank's earnings in a rapidly changing interest rate environment, management
has implemented the following strategies to improve the match of asset and
liability maturities, repricing opportunities and rates, while maintaining an
acceptable interest rate spread. At September 30, 1997, the Bank's one-year
cumulative interest rate sensitivity gap was a negative 19.49%. After
including the impact of interest rate caps purchased by the Bank (and
described below), the Bank's one year cumulative interest rate sensitivity
gap would be reduced to a negative 9.26% at September 30, 1997. See "--Asset
and Liability Management--Interest Rate Sensitivity Analysis" for the
assumptions used in calculating this interest rate sensitivity gap.
- The Bank has made its loan portfolio more interest rate sensitive by
originating ARM loans for retention in its loan portfolio, and by
generally selling into the secondary mortgage market fixed rate mortgage
loans with maturities greater than 15 years. While the Bank's ability to
originate ARM loans depends to a great extent on market interest rates and
borrowers' preferences, the Bank has succeeded in increasing its ARM loan
originations in recent years. ARM loan originations totaled 85% of total
loan originations for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997. At
September 30, 1997, ARM loans constituted 73.8% of the Bank's total net
loan portfolio. While the current low interest rate environment has
resulted in a decrease in the interest rates on newly originated loans,
management of the Bank has determined that this reduction in yield is
offset by the reduced interest rate risk in a rising market interest rate
environment offered by ARM loans. See "Risk Factors--Potential Effects of
Changes in Interest Rates and the Current Interest Rate Environment" for a
discussion of this and other considerations presented by the Bank's
portfolio of ARM loans. The amount of fixed rate loans retained in the
Bank's loan portfolio is monitored by predetermined interest rate risk
criteria administered by the Bank's Asset-Liability Management Committee.
- In addition, the Bank invests in floating-rate mortgage-backed securities.
As of September 30, 1997, floating rate mortgage-backed securities totaled
$151.8 million, or 89.9% of the Bank's total portfolio of mortgage-backed
securities and 39.6% of the Bank's total assets.
- The Bank's Asset-Liability Management Committee models the Bank's interest
rate risk quarterly and based upon the results of the model determines
whether additional interest rate risk protection is needed. If deemed
necessary, the Bank may purchase interest rate caps in an effort to
mitigate the effects of interest rate fluctuations. At September 30, 1997,
the Bank owned interest rate caps with a total notional amount of $40
million, with expiration dates ranging from December 1998 to December
1999.
CUSTOMER SERVICE. As a locally based financial institution, the Bank
traditionally has been able to offer customers personalized service.
Management believes that it can compete effectively against larger
institutions in its market area by continuing to offer personalized service,
including customer access to senior management. The Bank seeks to keep
informed of customer needs by surveying customers and monitoring overall
customer service on an ongoing basis.
41
<PAGE>
FHLB ADVANCES. Management has utilized FHLB advances to reduce the
overall cost of interest-bearing liabilities. FHLB advances, unlike deposit
accounts, do not require the Bank to incur the operating expenses associated
with attracting and servicing customer accounts, such as federal deposit
insurance premiums, employee salaries and benefits, and advertising. In
addition, FHLB advances can be accessed immediately and in specified amounts;
deposits must be attracted with higher deposit interest rates that must be
paid also to existing depositors, thereby increasing the average cost of
funds for the Bank's overall base of deposits. For the fiscal years ended
September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, the average balance of the Bank's FHLB
advances was $203.8 million, $224.7 million and $167.8 million, respectively.
The Bank intends to use the net proceeds of the Offering initially to reduce
the balance of its FHLB advances. See "Use of Proceeds."
42
<PAGE>
Average Balance Sheet
The following table sets forth certain information relating to the Bank's
average balance sheet and reflects the average yield on assets and average
cost of liabilities for the periods indicated and the average yields earned
and rates paid. Such yields and costs are derived by dividing income or
expense by the average balance of assets or liabilities, respectively, for
the periods presented. Average balances are derived from monthly average
balances.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
1997
----------------
ACTUAL YIELD/
BALANCE COST
-------- ------
<S> <C> <C>
Interest-earning
assets: (1)
Loans receivable,
net (6)............. $159,690 7.99%
Investment
securities.......... 210,605 6.86
-------- ------
Total
interest-earning
assets.......... 370,295 7.34
Noninterest-earning
cash.................. 736
Other
noninterest-earning
assets................ 12,386
--------
Total
assets.......... $383,417
--------
--------
Interest-bearing
liabilities:
Deposits.............. 143,354 4.85
Borrowed funds
(5)................. 211,286 5.65
-------- ------
Total
interest-bearing
liabilities..... 354,640 5.33
Noninterest-bearing
liabilities (2)....... 4,531
--------
Total
liabilities..... 359,171
Net worth............. 24,246
--------
Total
liabilities
and net
worth.......... $383,417
--------
--------
Net interest
income...............
Net interest rate
spread (3)........... 2.01%
Interest-earning
assets and net
interest margin
(4)...............
Ratio of average
interest-earning
assets to average
interest-bearing
liabilities.......
<CAPTION>
FISCAL YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995
---------------------------- ---------------------------- ----------------------------
AVERAGE AVERAGE AVERAGE
AVERAGE YIELD/ AVERAGE YIELD/ AVERAGE YIELD/
BALANCE INTEREST COST BALANCE INTEREST COST BALANCE INTEREST COST
-------- -------- ------- -------- -------- ------- -------- -------- -------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Interest-earning
assets: (1)
Loans receivable,
net (6)............. $147,317 $12,007 8.15% $124,609 $10,517 8.44% $109,658 $ 9,108 8.31%
Investment
securities.......... 214,953 14,086 6.55 232,291 14,900 6.41 217,814 14,192 6.53
-------- -------- ------- -------- -------- ------- -------- -------- -------
Total
interest-earning
assets.......... 362,270 26,093 7.20 356,900 25,417 7.11 327,472 23,300 7.12
Noninterest-earning
cash.................. 775 723 672
Other
noninterest-earning
assets................ 14,041 8,770 6,819
-------- -------- --------
Total
assets.......... $377,086 $366,393 $334,969
-------- -------- --------
-------- -------- --------
Interest-bearing
liabilities:
Deposits.............. $127,347 $ 5,939 4.66 $113,779 $ 5,380 4.73 $120,498 $ 5,589 4.64
Borrowed funds
(5)................. 220,690 12,760 5.78 227,403 13,248 5.83 189,921 11,652 6.14
-------- -------- ------- -------- -------- ------- -------- -------- -------
Total
interest-bearing
liabilities..... 348,037 18,699 5.37 341,182 18,628 5.46 310,419 17,241 5.55
-------- ------- -------- ------- -------- -------
Noninterest-bearing
liabilities (2)....... 5,447 3,302 4,266
-------- -------- --------
Total
liabilities....... 353,484 344,484 314,685
Net worth 23,602 21,909 20,284
-------- -------- --------
Total
liabilities
and
stockholders'
equity.......... $377,086 $366,393 $334,969
-------- -------- --------
-------- -------- --------
Net interest
income................ $ 7,394 $ 6,789 $ 6,059
-------- -------- --------
-------- -------- --------
Net interest rate
spread (3)............ 1.83% 1.65% 1.57%
------- ------- -------
------- ------- -------
Interest-earning
assets and net
interest margin
(4)................... $362,270 2.04% $356,900 1.89% $327,472 1.85%
-------- ------- -------- ------- -------- -------
-------- ------- -------- ------- -------- -------
Ratio of average
interest-earning
assets to average
interest-bearing
liabilities........... 104.09% 104.61% 105.49%
------- ------- -------
------- ------- -------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) All interest-earning assets are disclosed net of loans in process,
unamortized yield adjustments, and valuation allowances.
(2) Escrow accounts are noninterest-bearing and are included in
noninterest-bearing liabilities.
(3) Net interest spread represents the difference between te average yield on
interest-earning assets and the average cost of interest-bearing
liabilities.
(4) Net interest margin represents net interest income as a percentage of
average interest-earning assets.
(5) Includes FHLB advances and securities sold under agreements to repurchase.
(6) Does not include interest on nonaccrual loans. Non-performing loans are
included in loans receivable, net.
43
<PAGE>
RATE/VOLUME ANALYSIS. The following table describes the extent to which
changes in interest rates and changes in volume of interest-related assets
and liabilities have affected the Bank's interest income and expense during
the periods indicated. For each category of interest-earning assets and
interest-bearing liabilities, information is provided on changes attributable
to (i) changes in volume (change in volume multiplied by prior year rate),
(ii) changes in rate (change in rate multiplied by prior year volume), and
(iii) total change in rate and volume. The combined effect of changes in both
rate and volume has been allocated to the change due to volume.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 VS. 1996 1996 VS. 1995 1995 VS. 1994
---------------------------------- ---------------------------------- -----------------------------------
INCREASE/(DECREASE) INCREASE/(DECREASE) INCREASE/(DECREASE)
DUE TO DUE TO DUE TO
--------------------- TOTAL --------------------- TOTAL ----------------------- TOTAL
RATE/ INCREASE RATE/ INCREASE RATE/ INCREASE
VOLUME RATE VOLUME (DECREASE) VOLUME RATE VOLUME (DECREASE) VOLUME RATE VOLUME (DECREASE)
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Interest income:
Loans
receivable...... $1,908 $(312) $(106) $1,490 $1,242 $ 143 $ 24 $1,409 $ 639 $ 82 $ 11 $ 732
Investment
securities...... (1,112) 325 (27) (814) 943 (218) (17) 708 5,209 1,338 1,057 7,604
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
Total
interest-earning
assets...... $ 796 $ 13 $(133) $ 676 $2,185 $ (75) $ 7 $2,117 $5,848 $ 1,420 $1,068 $8,336
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
Interest expense:
Deposits.......... $ 642 $ (80) $ (3) $ 559 $(312 ) $ 109 $ (6) $ (209) $ 69 $ 1,410 $ 22 $1,501
Borrowed funds.... (391 ) (114) 17 (488) 2,302 (589) (117) 1,596 4,546 1,379 1,461 7,386
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
Total
interest-bearing
liabilities... $ 251 $(194) $ 14 $ 71 $1,990 $(480) $(123) $1,387 $4,615 $ 2,789 $1,483 $8,887
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
Net change in net
interest income... $ 545 $ 207 $(147) $ 605 $ 195 $ 405 $ 130 $ 730 $1,233 $(1,369) $(413 ) $ (551)
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ----- ------ ---------- ------ ------- ------ ----------
</TABLE>
44
<PAGE>
COMPARISON OF RESULT OF OPERATIONS
OVERVIEW. Reference is made to the Summary of Operations table in
Selected Consolidated Financial and Other Data of the Bank and Subsidiaries
beginning on page 13 of this Prospectus. Net income was $2.4 million for
fiscal 1997, compared to $2.0 million and $1.9 million for fiscal 1996 and
1995, respectively. The Bank's average interest earning assets have increased
over the three year period ended September 30, 1997 from $335.0 million to
$377.1 million, which has resulted in higher levels of interest income. The
favorable results were offset by a special Savings Association Insurance Fund
("SAIF") premium of $937,000 which was assessed in fiscal 1996. The Deposit
Insurance Funds Act of 1996 required a special one-time assessment on Savings
Association Insurance Fund ("SAIF") assessable deposits of 65.7 basis points
to recapitalize the SAIF. The Bank's net interest rate spread increased to
1.83% for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997 from 1.65% for the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1996 and 1.57% for the fiscal year ended September
30, 1995. The increase in net interest rate spread is a result of an increase
in average loans outstanding, a decrease in average investments outstanding,
a decrease in the average cost of borrowed funds and, in fiscal 1997, an
increase in deposits and a decrease in borrowed funds. The Bank's strategy
has been to utilize the run-off and principal pay-downs from investment
securities to fund loan growth within the Bank's local market. Such loans
generally have higher yields than investment securities.
NET INTEREST INCOME. The Bank's results of operations depend primarily
on its net interest income, which is the difference between interest income
on interest-earning assets and interest expense on interest-bearing
liabilities. The Bank's net interest rate spread is impacted by changes in
general market interest rates, including changes in the relation between
short and long-term interest rates (the "yield curve"), and the Bank's
interest rate sensitivity position. While management seeks to manage its
business to limit the exposure of the Bank's net interest income to changes
in interest rates, different aspects of its business nevertheless remain
subject to risk from interest rate changes. Net interest income was $7.4
million for fiscal 1997 compared to $6.8 million and $6.1 million, for fiscal
1996 and 1995, respectively.
The Bank's interest-earning assets are primarily comprised of
single-family mortgage loans and investment securities, which are primarily
mortgage-backed securities. Interest-bearing liabilities primarily include
deposits and FHLB advances. The increases in average interest-earning assets
during fiscal 1997, 1996 and 1995 reflected increases in the loan portfolio,
funded primarily with deposits and FHLB advances. See "Discussion of Changes
in Financial Condition" for a discussion of the Bank's asset portfolio and
"Capital Resources and Liquidity" for discussion of borrowings.
Increased net interest income resulted from higher average loans
outstanding and improved net interest rate spreads during fiscal 1997 and
1996. Increased net interest income in fiscal 1995 resulted primarily from
higher average loans outstanding. The average balance of interest earning
assets increased $5.4 million, $29.4 million and $106.8 million in fiscal
1997, 1996 and 1995, respectively. The net interest rate spread increased 18
basis points and 8 basis points in fiscal 1997 and 1996, respectively. The
net interest rate spread decreased 116 basis points in fiscal 1995 due to the
increase in the investment portfolio portion of total assets. Average loans
receivable increased to 40.7% of average total interest earning assets in
fiscal 1997 from 34.9% in fiscal 1996 and 33.5% in fiscal 1995.
The majority of the Bank's interest-earning assets are comprised of
adjustable-rate assets. The Bank's adjustable-rate loans and investment
securities are subject to periodic interest rate caps. Periodic caps limit
the amount by which the interest rate on a particular mortgage loan may
increase at its next interest rate reset date. In a rising rate environment,
the interest rate spread could be negatively impacted if the repricing of
interest-earning assets lags behind market interest rate movements, as a
result of periodic interest rate caps.
During fiscal 1997, market interest rates remained relatively flat and
loan demand remained relatively strong, resulting in an increase in mortgage
loans outstanding, an increase in the net interest rate spread and an
increase of $0.6 million, or 8.9%, in net interest income. The average yield
on interest earnings assets increased to 7.20% in fiscal 1997 compared to
7.11% and 7.12% in fiscal 1996 and 1995, respectively, while the average cost
of interest bearing liabilities decreased to 5.37% in fiscal 1997 from 5.46%
and 5.55% in fiscal 1996 and 1995, respectively. The increase in the average
yield on interest earning assets was largely due to an increase in average
loans receivable,
45
<PAGE>
net and a decrease in average investments receivable. The decrease in average
cost of interest bearing liabilities was primarily due to an increase in
average deposits and decrease in average borrowed funds.
PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES. The Bank made a provision for loan losses of
$60,000 and $411,200, respectively, in the fiscal years ended September 30,
1997 and 1996 and made no provision in the fiscal year ended September 30,
1995. Management considered several factors in determining the necessary
level of its allowance for loan losses and as a derivative of the process,
the necessary provision for loan losses. For the fiscal year ended September
30, 1996, the closing of a local plant by one of the largest employers in the
Bank's lending area, a 65% increase in nonperforming assets and a 20%
increase in commercial lending were among the reasons considered in
increasing the allowance for loan losses from $1,357,000 at September 30,
1996. For the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, consideration was given
to the improvement in nonperforming assets, but this positive factor was
somewhat offset by management's concern that the full impact of the plant
closing by the large employer in the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996 had
not been fully felt in the local economy due to compensation continuation
plans and public support. Therefore, while the allowance for loan losses was
decreased to $1,691,000 at September 30, 1997, management determined that
this level should be maintained as long as the present economic factors
remain unimproved. The provision for loan losses and the adequacy of the
allowance for loan losses is generally evaluated periodically by management
of the Bank based on the Bank's past experience, known and inherent risks in
the loan portfolio, adverse situations which may affect the borrowers'
ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral and
current economic conditions.
NONINTEREST INCOME. Non-interest income totaled $1.4 million for the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, compared to $1.5 million for the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1996 and $0.9 million for the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1995. These fluctuations were due primarily to increases and
decreases in the amount of FHLB dividends received in the periods.
NONINTEREST EXPENSE. Non-interest expense consisting primarily of
salaries and employee benefits, premises and equipment, data processing and
federal deposit insurance premiums totaled $5.0 million for the fiscal year
ended September 30, 1997, compared to $5.6 million for the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1996, a decrease of 10.6%. The decrease was the result of the
$937,000 special SAIF assessment in fiscal 1996, net of general cost
increases in fiscal 1997. This assessment was the primary reason for the
increase from $4.0 million for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1995.
The Bank has contacted its major computer service vendors and has
received assurances that those computer services will properly function on
January 1, 2000, the date that computer problems are expected to develop
worldwide. Internally, the Bank has determined that certain computer programs
must be revised in advance of the year 2000. The Bank does not believe that
the costs associated with its actions and those of its vendors will be
material to the Bank. The Bank is currently working with its computer service
provider to develop a testing plan and contingency. However, in the event a
major vendor of the Bank is unable to fulfill its contractual obligation to
the Bank, the Company and the Bank could experience material cost. See "Risk
Factors--Possible Year 2000 Computer Program Problems."
INCOME TAXES. Income tax expense for the fiscal year ended September 30,
1997 was $1.3 million, an increase of $958,000, or 248.0%. The increase was
due primarily to an increase in net income before tax, a decrease in tax
exempt income and a change in an estimate in the fiscal year ended September
30, 1996. Income tax expense for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996 was
$386,000 a decrease of $614,000, or 61.3%. The decrease in income tax expense
was due to change in estimate and removal of a valuation allowance on certain
deferred tax assets in the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996.
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
The Bank is required to maintain minimum levels of liquid assets as
defined by OTS regulations. This requirement, which varies from time to time
depending upon economic conditions and deposit flows, is based upon a
percentage of deposits and short-term borrowings. The required ratio is
currently 4%. The Bank adjusts liquidity
46
<PAGE>
as appropriate to meet its asset and liability management objectives. At
September 30, 1997, the Bank was in compliance with such liquidity
requirements.
The Bank's primary sources of funds are deposits, amortization and
prepayment of loans and mortgage-backed securities, maturities of investment
securities, FHLB advances, and earnings and funds provided from operations.
While scheduled principal repayments on loans, and mortgage-backed securities
are a relatively predictable source of funds, deposit flows, loan prepayments
and mortgage-backed securities prepayments are greatly influenced by general
interest rates, economic conditions, and competition. The Bank manages the
pricing of its deposits to maintain a desired deposit balance. For additional
information about cash flows from the Bank's operating, financing, and
investing activities, see Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows included in
the Consolidated Financial Statements.
At September 30, 1997, the Bank had contractual commitments to extend
credit (exclusive of undisbursed loans in process) of $8.4 million.
Certificates of deposit scheduled to mature in less than one year at
September 30, 1997, totaled $89.4 million, or 62.3% of total deposits. Based
on prior experience, management believes that a significant portion of such
deposits will remain with the Bank. Management also believes that it will
have sufficient liquidity to meet maturing certificates of deposit that do
not remain with the Bank.
At September 30, 1997, the Bank exceeded all of its regulatory capital
requirements.
IMPACT OF INFLATION AND CHANGING PRICES
The consolidated financial statements of the Bank and notes thereto,
presented elsewhere herein, have been prepared in accordance with generally
accepted accounting principles, which require the measurement of financial
position and operating results in terms of historical dollars without
considering the change in the relative purchasing power of money over time
due to inflation. The impact of inflation is reflected in the increased cost
of the Bank's operations. Unlike most industrial companies, nearly all the
assets and liabilities of the Bank are monetary. As a result, interest rates
have a greater impact on the Bank's performance than do the effects of
general levels of inflation. Interest rates do not necessarily move in the
same direction or to the same extent as the price of goods and services.
FDIC INSURANCE PREMIUMS AND ASSESSMENT
In September of 1995, the FDIC announced that the Bank Insurance Fund
(the "BIF") was fully capitalized at the end of May 1995. The FDIC has
reduced the deposit insurance premiums paid by "well-capitalized"
institutions insured by the BIF. The Bank's deposits are insured by the
Savings Association Insurance Fund (the "SAIF").
In September 1996, Congress enacted legislation to recapitalize the SAIF
by a one-time assessment on all SAIF-insured deposits held as of March 31,
1995. The assessment was 65.7 basis points per $100 in deposits, payable on
November 30, 1996. For the Bank, the assessment amounted to $937,000 (or
$618,000 after consideration of tax benefits), based on the Bank's
SAIF-insured deposits of $142.6 million. In addition, beginning January 1,
1997, pursuant to the legislation, interest payments on FICO bonds issued in
the late 1980's by the Financing Corporation to recapitalize the now defunct
Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation will be paid jointly by
BIF-insured institutions and SAIF-insured institutions. The FICO assessment
will be 1.29 basis points per $100 in BIF deposits and 6.44 basis points per
$100 in SAIF deposits. Beginning January 1, 2000, the FICO interest payments
will be paid pro-rata by banks and thrifts based on deposits (approximately
2.4 basis points per $100 in deposits). The BIF and SAIF will be merged on
January 1, 1999, provided the saving association charter is eliminated by
that date. In that event, pro-rata FICO sharing will begin on January 1, 1999.
47
<PAGE>
IMPACT OF NEW ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
In October 1995, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, Accounting for
Stock-Based Compensation ("SFAS 123"). SFAS 123 establishes financial
accounting and reporting standards for stock-based compensation plans. Those
plans include all arrangements by which employees receive shares of stock or
other equity instruments of the employer. SFAS No. 123 defines a fair value
based method of accounting for an employee stock option or similar equity
instrument. Under the fair value based method, compensation cost is measured
at the grant date based on the value of the award and is recognized over the
service period, which is usually the vesting period. Accounting Principles
Board ("APB") Opinion 25, requires compensation cost for stock-based employee
compensation plans to be recognized based on the difference, if any, between
the quoted market price of the stock and the amount an employee must pay to
acquire the stock. SFAS No. 123 permits an entity in determining its net
income to continue to apply the accounting provisions of APB Opinion 25 to
its stock-based employee compensation arrangements. An entity that continues
to apply APB Opinion 25 must comply with the disclosure requirements of SFAS
123. SFAS 123 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15,
1995. The Bank adopted SFAS 123 during the year ended September 30, 1997,
with no material effect on the Bank's consolidated financial statements.
The FASB has issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 125,
Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and
Extinguishments of Liabilities, ("SFAS 125"), as amended by SFAS No. 127.
This statement provides accounting and reporting standards for transfers and
servicing of financial assets and extinguishments of liabilities. The
statement is effective for transfers and servicing of financial assets and
extinguishments of liabilities occurring after December 31, 1996. SFAS 127
delayed the effective date of certain provisions of SFAS 125 until December
31, 1997. The adoption of SFAS 125, as amended by SFAS 127, is not expected
to have a material effect on the Bank's financial position or results of
operations.
In February 1997, the FASB issued Statement No. 128, "Earnings Per Share"
("SFAS 128"). SFAS 128 establishes standards for computing and presenting
earnings per share ("EPS"), simplifying the standards previously found in APB
Option No. 15, "Earnings Per Share." The current presentation of primary EPS
is replaced with a presentation of basic EPS. Dual presentation of basic and
diluted EPS will be required on the face of the income statement as well as a
reconciliation of the numerator and denominator of the basic EPS computation
to the numerator and denominator of the diluted EPS computation. Basic EPS
excludes dilution and is computed by dividing income available to common
stockholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding for
the period. Diluted EPS is computed similarly to fully diluted EPS pursuant
to APB Opinion No. 15. Also in February 1997, the FASB issued Statement No.
129, "Disclosure of Information about Capital Structure" ("SFAS 129"),
establishing standards for disclosing information about an entity's capital
structure. SFAS 129 calls for summary form information regarding rights and
privileges of various securities outstanding and other capital instrument
information. SFAS 128 and 129 are effective for financial statements issued
for periods ending December 15, 1997, including interim periods. The adoption
of SFAS 128 and 129 is not expected to have a material effect on the Bank's
financial condition or results of operations.
In June 1997, the FASB issued Statement No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive
Income" ("SFAS 130"). SFAS 130 establishes standards for reporting and
display of comprehensive income and its components. SFAS 130 requires that
all items that are required to be recognized under accounting standards as
components of comprehensive income be reported in a financial statement that
is displayed with the same prominence as other financial statements. The Bank
will be required to classify items of other comprehensive income separately
from retained earnings and additional paid-in capital in the equity section
of the statement of financial condition. Also in June 1997, the FASB issued
Statement No. 131, "Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related
Information" ("SFAS 131"), establishing standards for the way public
enterprises report information about operating segments in interim financial
reports issued to shareholders. It also establishes standards for related
disclosures about products and services, geographic areas, and major
customers. SFAS 130 and 131 are effective for fiscal years beginning after
December 15, 1997, with reclassification of earlier periods. The adoption of
SFAS 130 and 131 is not expected to have a material effect on the Bank's
financial condition or results of operations.
48
<PAGE>
BUSINESS OF THE BANK
GENERAL
The profitability of the Bank depends primarily on its net interest
income, which is the difference between interest income on interest-earning
assets, principally loans, mortgage-backed securities and investment
securities and interest expense on interest-bearing deposits and borrowed
funds. The Bank's net income also is dependent, to a lesser extent, on the
level of its other operating income (including service charges) and operating
expenses, such as salaries and employee benefits, net occupancy expense,
deposit insurance premiums, professional fees, data processing and
miscellaneous other expenses, as well as federal and state income tax
expenses.
MARKET AREA
The Bank's market area is comprised of the Arkansas counties of Randolph,
Lawrence, Craighead, Sharp and Clay, all of which are located in northeast
Arkansas. The Bank has at least one branch office in each of these counties.
The northeastern section of Arkansas has an economy based on agriculture,
manufacturing, services and wholesale/retail trade. Agriculture and related
industries, which constitute the historical basis of the markets area
economy, continue to be prominent throughout the market area, particularly in
the eastern portions of the market area. Manufacturing employment in the
market area is fairly diverse and represents a relatively high portion of the
earnings in the market area. Notably, the largest manufacturer in the
Randolph County market area, Brown Shoe Company, went out of business in
1995, which resulted in the loss of more than 600 jobs. This loss of jobs is
gradually being absorbed by the local economy, which will be aided by the
opening of two factories in Pocahontas that will add approximately 250 jobs
to the local economy. The City of Jonesboro, a Metropolitan Statistical Area,
is located in Craighead county and is the economic center of the market area.
The Jonesboro economy is more diverse and vibrant compared to the other
markets served by the Bank, with the relative affluence of the Jonesboro
economy being supported by Arkansas State University, numerous small- to
medium-sized manufacturing plants, and the benefits derived from being a
regional medical center.
As of 1990, according to the latest available census data, the population
of the Bank's market area was approximately 150,000. The population in the
Bank's market area is estimated to have increased only slightly since 1990.
The median household income for Craighead county is estimated to be
approximately $28,000, while the median household income for the other
counties that comprise the Bank's market area is estimated to be
approximately $19,500. The unemployment rate in the Bank's market area varies
by county, with Craighead and Sharp counties having consistently lower levels
of unemployment than the other counties in the Bank's market area. As of
September 1997, according to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, the
unemployment rate in Randolph county was 8.4%, Lawrence county was 5.3%, Clay
county was 4.2%, Sharp county was 6.0% and Craighead county was 4.0%. This
compares to an unemployment rate of 4.7% for the nation generally.
LENDING ACTIVITIES
LOAN PORTFOLIO COMPOSITION. The Bank's net loan portfolio consists
primarily of first mortgage loans collateralized by single-family residential
real estate and, to a lesser extent, multifamily residential real estate,
commercial real estate and agricultural real estate loans. At September 30,
1997, the Bank's net loan portfolio totaled $159.7 million, of which $138.5
million, or 86.8% were single-family residential real estate mortgage loans,
$1.6 million, or 1.0%, were multifamily residential real estate loans, $9.6
million, or 6.0%, were commercial real estate loans (including land loans),
and $4.7 million, or 2.9%, were agricultural real estate loans. The remainder
of the Bank's loans at September 30, 1997 included commercial business loans
(i.e., crop production, equipment and livestock loans) which totaled $6.5
million, or 4.1%, of the Bank's total net loan portfolio as of September 30,
1997. Other loans, including automobile loans and loans collateralized by
deposit accounts, totaled $3.8 million, or 2.3%, of the Bank's net loan
portfolio as of September 30, 1997.
49
<PAGE>
ANALYSIS OF LOAN PORTFOLIO
Set forth below is selected data relating to the composition of the
Bank's loan portfolio, including loans held for sale, by type of loan as of
the dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994
----------------------- ----------------------- ----------------------- -----------------------
AMOUNT PERCENT AMOUNT PERCENT AMOUNT PERCENT AMOUNT PERCENT
---------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ---------- -----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Real estate loans:
Single-family
residential............ $ 138,539 86.8% $ 118,291 86.4% $ 100,100 86.0% $ 88,725 86.0%
Multifamily residential.. 1,600 1.0 4,729 3.5 3,500 3.0 3,673 3.5
Agricultural............. 4,654 2.9 4,532 3.3 3,995 3.4 4,519 4.3
Commercial............... 9,606 6.0 6,703 4.9 5,246 4.5 4,781 4.6
---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- -----
Total real estate
loans................ 154,399 96.7 134,275 98.1 112,841 96.9 101,698 97.6
Other loans:
Savings account loans.... 1,015 0.6 886 0.6 896 0.8 893 0.9
Commercial business
(1).................... 6,533 4.1 5,729 4.2 4,466 3.8 3,736 3.6
Other (2).............. 2,726 1.7 1,913 1.4 2,137 1.9 1,353 1.3
---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- -----
Total other loans...... 10,274 6.4 8,528 6.2 7,499 6.5 5,982 5.8
---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- -----
Total loans
receivable........... 164,673 103.1 142,803 104.3 120,340 103.4 107,680 103.4
Less:
Undisbursed loan
proceeds............... 2,815 1.8 3,715 2.7 1,942 1.7 1,611 1.5
Unearned discount and net
deferred loan fee...... 467 0.3 482 0.4 594 0.5 656 0.6
Allowance for loan
losses................. 1,691 1.0 1,734 1.3 1,357 1.2 1,330 1.3
---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- -----
Total loans receivable
net.................. $ 159,690 100.0% $ 136,872 100.0% $ 116,447 100.0% $ 104,083 100.0%
---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- -----
---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- ----- ---------- -----
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
-----------------------
1993
-----------------------
AMOUNT PERCENT
---------- -----------
<S> <C> <C>
Real estate loans:
Single-family
residential............ $ 83,662 83.1%
Multifamily residential.. 4,227 4.2
Agricultural............. 3,499 3.4
Commercial............... 5,738 5.7
---------- -----
Total real estate
loans................ 97,126 96.4
Other loans:
Savings account loans.... 1,003 1.0
Commercial business
(1).................... 4,109 4.1
Other (2)................ 1,308 1.3
---------- -----
Total other loans...... 6,420 6.4
---------- -----
Total loans
receivable........... 103,546 102.8
Less:
Undisbursed loan
proceeds............... 872 0.9
Unearned discount and net
deferred loan fee...... 630 0.6
Allowance for loan
losses................. 1,349 1.3
---------- -----
Total loans receivable
net.................. $ 100,695 100.0%
---------- -----
---------- -----
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes crop-production loans, livestock loans and equipment loans.
(2) Includes second mortgage loans, unsecured personal lines of credit and
automobile loans.
50
<PAGE>
LOAN MATURITY SCHEDULE. The following table sets forth certain
information as of September 30, 1997, regarding the dollar amount of gross
loans maturing in the Bank's portfolio based on their contractual terms to
maturity. Demand loans, loans having no stated schedule of repayments, and
overdrafts are reported as due in one year or less. Adjustable and floating
rate loans are included in the period in which interest rates are next
scheduled to adjust rather than in which they mature, and fixed rate loans
are included in the period in which the final contractual repayment is due.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
BEYOND
WITHIN 1-3 3-5 5-10 10-20 20
1 YEAR YEARS YEARS YEARS YEARS YEARS TOTAL
-------- --------- ---------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
(IN THOUSANDS)
Fixed rate loans............ $ 9,037 $ 5,699 $ 14,121 $ 3,442 $ 6,625 $ 4,245 $ 43,169
Variable rate loans......... 32,815 42,756 43,057 2,876 -- -- 121,504
-------- --------- ---------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
Total..................... $41,852 $ 48,455 $ 57,178 $ 6,318 $ 6,625 $ 4,245 $ 164,673
-------- --------- ---------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
-------- --------- ---------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
</TABLE>
The following table sets forth at September 30, 1997, the dollar amount
of all fixed rate and adjustable rate loans due after September 30, 1998.
FIXED ADJUSTABLE TOTAL
--------- ----------- ----------
(IN THOUSANDS)
Real estate loans:
Single-family residential........ $ 15,847 $ 87,522 $ 103,369
Multifamily residential.......... 845 1,167 2,012
Agricultural....................... 1,533 -- 1,533
Commercial......................... 13,675 -- 13,675
Other.............................. 2,232 -- 2,232
--------- ----------- ----------
Total............................ $ 34,132 $ 88,689 $ 122,821
--------- ----------- ----------
--------- ----------- ----------
SINGLE-FAMILY RESIDENTIAL REAL ESTATE LOANS. The Bank's primary lending
activity is the origination of single-family, owner-occupied, residential
mortgage loans collateralized by properties located in the Bank's market
area. The Bank generally does not originate single-family residential loans
collateralized by properties outside of its market area. At September 30,
1997, the Bank had $138.5 million, or 86.8%, of its total net loan portfolio
invested in single-family residential mortgage loans, substantially all of
which were collateralized by properties located in the Bank's market area or
in counties contiguous with the Bank's market area.
The Bank's single-family, fixed rate, residential real estate loans
generally are originated and underwritten according to standards that qualify
such loans for resale in the secondary mortgage market. The Bank's fixed rate
loans are currently originated with terms ranging from 10 to 30 years and
amortize on a monthly basis with principal and interest due each month.
Generally, fixed rate loans with maturities in excess of 15 years are sold in
the secondary market. Conforming fixed rate loans with maturities of 15 years
are generally sold in the secondary market, while non-conforming 15 year
fixed rate loans are held in portfolio. The Bank generally retains in its
loan portfolio adjustable rate mortgage ("ARM") loans that it originates.
Whether the Bank can or will sell fixed rate loans, however, depends on a
number of factors including the yield and the term of the loan, market
conditions, and the Bank's current interest rate gap position. At September
30, 1997 and 1996, loans held for sale were insignificant. During the fiscal
years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, the Bank sold into the
secondary market $2.2 million, $1.3 million and $0.8 million, respectively,
of single-family, fixed rate, residential mortgage loans, generally from
current period originations. The Bank generally does not retain the servicing
rights on loans it has sold.
The Bank currently offers single-family residential mortgage loans with
terms typically ranging from 10 to 30 years, and with adjustable or fixed
interest rates. Single-family residential real estate loans often remain
outstanding for significantly shorter periods than their contractual terms
because borrowers may refinance or prepay
51
<PAGE>
loans at their option. The average length of time that the Bank's
single-family residential mortgage loans remain outstanding varies
significantly depending upon trends in market interest rates and other
factors. Accordingly, estimates of the average length of single-family loans
that remain outstanding cannot be made with any degree of accuracy.
Originations of fixed-rate loans versus ARM loans are monitored on an ongoing
basis and are affected significantly by the level of market interest rates,
customer preference, the Bank's interest rate gap position, and loan products
offered by the Bank's competitors. Particularly in a relatively low interest
rate environment, borrowers may prefer fixed rate loans to ARM loans.
However, management's strategy is to emphasize ARM loans, and the Bank has
been successful in maintaining a level of ARM loan originations acceptable to
management.
The following table sets forth the Bank's portfolio of fixed rate
loans and adjustable rate loans as of the periods indicated:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
----------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1994
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
(IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Adjustable-rate loans................................ $ 121,504 $ 100,825 $ 86,205 $ 75,077 $ 67,960
Fixed-rate loans..................................... 43,169 36,047 30,242 29,006 32,735
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Total loans.......................................... $ 164,673 $ 136,872 $ 116,447 $ 104,083 $ 100,695
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
</TABLE>
The Bank's ARM loans are generally originated for terms of 30 years, with
interest rates that adjust annually. The Bank establishes various annual and
life-of-the-loan caps on ARM loan interest rate adjustments. The Bank's
current index on its ARM loans is the one-year constant maturity treasury
("CMT") rate for one-year ARM loans, a three-year CMT rate for three-year ARM
loans, and a five-year CMT rate for five-year ARM loans, plus a range of
margin of 225 to 300 basis points, subject to change based on market
conditions. The Bank determines whether a borrower qualifies for an ARM loan
based on the fully indexed rate of the ARM loan at the time the loan is
originated.
The primary purpose of offering ARM loans is to make the Bank's loan
portfolio more interest rate sensitive. ARM loans carry increased credit risk
associated with potentially higher monthly payments by borrowers as general
market interest rates increase. It is possible, therefore, that during
periods of rising interest rates, the risk of default on ARM loans may
increase due to the upward adjustment of interest costs to the borrower.
Management believes that the Bank's credit risk associated with its ARM loans
is reduced because of the lifetime interest rate adjustment limitations on
such loans. However, interest rate caps and the changes in the CMT rate,
which is a lagging market index to which the Bank's ARM loans are indexed,
may reduce the Bank's net earnings in a period of rising market interest
rates.
The Bank's single-family residential first mortgage loans customarily
include due-on-sale clauses, which are provisions giving the Bank the right
to declare a loan immediately due and payable in the event, among other
things, that the borrower sells or otherwise disposes of the underlying real
property serving as security for the loan. Due-on-sale clauses are an
important means of adjusting the rates on the Bank's fixed rate mortgage loan
portfolio.
Regulations limit the amount that a savings association may lend relative
to the appraised value of the real estate securing the loan, as determined by
an appraisal at the time of loan origination. Such regulations permit a
maximum loan-to-value ratio of 100% for residential property and a lower
percentage for other real estate loans, depending on the type of loan. The
Bank's lending policies limit the maximum loan-to-value ratio on both fixed
rate and ARM loans without private mortgage insurance to 90% of the lesser of
the appraised value or the purchase price of the property to serve as
collateral for the loan. The Bank generally requires fire and casualty
insurance, as well as title insurance regarding good title, on all properties
securing real estate loans made by the Bank.
52
<PAGE>
MULTIFAMILY RESIDENTIAL REAL ESTATE LOANS. Although the Bank does not
emphasize multi family residential loans and has not been active in this
area, the Bank has originated loans collateralized by multifamily residential
real estate. Such loans constituted approximately $1.6 million, or 1.0%, of
the Bank's total net loan portfolio at September 30, 1997, compared to $4.7
million, or 3.5%, of the Bank's total net loan portfolio at September 30,
1996, $3.5 million, or 3.0%, of the total net loan portfolio at September 30,
1995, $3.7 million, or 3.5%, of the total net loan portfolio at September 30,
1994 and $4.2 million, or 4.2%, of the total net loan portfolio at September
30, 1993. The Bank's multifamily real estate loans are primarily
collateralized by multifamily residences, such as apartment buildings.
Multifamily residential real estate loans are offered with fixed and
adjustable interest rates and are structured in a number of different ways
depending upon the circumstances of the borrower and the type of multifamily
project. Fixed interest rate loans generally have five-to seven-year terms
with a balloon payment based on a 15 to 25 year amortization schedule.
Loans collateralized by multifamily real estate generally involve a
greater degree of credit risk than single-family residential mortgage loans
and carry individually larger loan balances. This increased credit risk is a
result of several factors, including the concentration of principal in a
limited number of loans and borrowers, the effects of general economic
conditions on income producing properties, and the increased difficulty of
evaluating and monitoring these types of loans. Furthermore, the repayment of
loans collateralized by multifamily real estate typically depends upon the
successful operation of the related real estate property. If the cash flow
from the project is reduced, the borrower's ability to repay the loan may be
impaired.
AGRICULTURAL REAL ESTATE LOANS. In recent years the Bank has increased
its originations of agricultural real estate loans for the purchase of
farmland in the Bank's market area. Loans collateralized by farmland
constituted approximately $4.7 million, or 2.9%, of the Bank's total net loan
portfolio at September 30, 1997, compared to $4.6 million, or 3.3%, $4.0
million, or 3.4%, $4.5 million, or 4.3%, and $3.5 million, or 3.4% of the
Bank's total net loan portfolio at September 30, 1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993,
respectively.
Agricultural mortgage loans have various terms up to 10 years with a
balloon payment based on a 20-year amortization schedule. Such loans are
originated with fixed rates and generally include personal guarantees. The
loan-to-value ratio on agricultural mortgage loans is generally limited to
75%. The Bank earns higher yields on agricultural mortgage loans than on
single-family residential mortgage loans. Agricultural related lending,
however, involves a greater degree of risk than single-family residential
mortgage loans because of the typically larger loan amounts and a somewhat
more volatile market. In addition, repayments on agricultural mortgage loans
are substantially dependent on the successful operation or management of the
farm property collateralizing the loan, which is affected by many factors,
such as weather and changing market prices, outside the control of the
borrower.
COMMERCIAL REAL ESTATE LOANS. Loans collateralized by commercial real
estate, including land loans, constituted approximately $9.6 million, or 6.0%
of the Bank's total net loan portfolio at September 30, 1997 compared to $6.7
million, or 4.9%, $5.2 million, or 4.5%, $4.8 million, or 4.6%, and $5.7
million, or 5.7% of the Bank's total net loan portfolio at September 30,
1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively. The Bank's commercial real estate
loans are collateralized by improved property such as office buildings,
churches and other nonresidential buildings. At September 30, 1997,
substantially all of the Bank's commercial real estate loans were
collateralized by properties located within the Bank's market area.
Commercial real estate loans currently are offered with fixed rates only
and are structured in a number of different ways depending upon the
circumstances of the borrower and the nature of the project. Fixed rate loans
generally have five- to seven-year terms with a balloon payment based on a 15
to 25 year amortization schedule. The loan-to-value ratio on commercial real
estate loans is generally limited to 75%. In addition, the Bank generally
requires personal guarantees on such loans.
Loans collateralized by commercial real estate generally involve a
greater degree of credit risk than single-family residential mortgage loans
and carry larger loan balances. This increased credit risk is a result of
several factors, including the concentration of principal in a limited number
of loans and borrowers, the effects of general
53
<PAGE>
economic conditions on income producing properties, and the increased
difficulty of evaluating and monitoring these types of loans. Furthermore,
the repayment of loans collateralized by commercial real estate is typically
dependent upon the successful operation of the related real estate property.
If the cash flow from the project is reduced, the borrower's ability to repay
the loan may be impaired.
OTHER LOANS. The Bank originates various consumer loans, including
automobile, deposit account loans and second mortgage loans, principally in
response to customer demand. At September 30, 1997, such loans totaled $3.7
million, or 2.3% of the Bank's total net loan portfolio as compared to $2.8
million, or 2.0%, $3.0 million, or 2.7%, $2.2 million, or 2.2%, and $2.3
million, or 2.3 % of the Bank's total net loan portfolio at September 30,
1996, 1995,1994 and 1993, respectively. Consumer loans are offered primarily
on a fixed rate basis with maturities generally of less than ten years.
In recent years, the Bank has emphasized the origination of commercial
business loans, which principally include agricultural-related commercial
loans to finance the purchase of livestock, cattle, farm machinery and
equipment, seed, fertilizer and other farm-related products. Such loans
comprised $6.5 million, or 4.1% of the Bank's total net loan portfolio at
September 30, 1997 as compared to $5.7 million, or 4.2%, $4.5 million, or
3.8%, $3.7 million, or 3.6%, and $4.1 million, or 4.1% of the Bank's total
net loan portfolio as of September 30, 1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993,
respectively.
As with agricultural real estate loans, agricultural operating loans
involve a greater degree of risk than residential mortgage loans because the
payments on such loans are dependent on the successful operation or
management of the farm property for which the operating loan is utilized. See
"--Agricultural Real Estate Loans" for the various risks associated with
agricultural operating loans.
ORIGINATION, PURCHASE AND SALE OF LOANS AND MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES.
The table below shows the Bank's originations, purchases and sales of loans
and mortgage-backed securities for the periods indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
----------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
(IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Total loans receivable, net at beginning of year..... $ 136,872 $ 116,447 $ 104,083 $ 100,695 $ 97,801
Loans originated:
Real estate:
Single-family residential........................ 49,215 48,568 28,295 21,046 23,139
Multifamily residential.......................... 93 -- -- -- 480
Commercial....................................... 3,467 299 552 667 344
Agricultural..................................... 2,863 1,596 1,654 1,648 918
Other:
Commercial business.............................. 6,697 5,743 4,510 3,254 2,998
Savings account loans............................ 926 826 682 688 776
Other............................................ 2,684 2,023 1,630 1,348 1,207
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Total loans originated........................... 65,945 59,055 37,323 28,651 29,862
Loans purchased...................................... -- -- 385 72 106
Loans to facilitate sale of REO...................... (349) (145) (205) (472) (119)
Loans sold........................................... (2,156) (1,321) (752) (311) (263)
Loans transferred to REO............................. (294) (233) (88) (468) (879)
Loan repayments...................................... (40,004) (36,470) (24,350) (23,961) (25,300)
Other loan activity (net)............................ (324) (461) 51 (123) (513)
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Total loans receivable, net at end of year....... $ 159,690 $ 136,872 $ 116,447 $ 104,083 $ 100,695
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Mortgage-backed securities, net at beginning of
year............................................... $ 179,359 $ 163,287 $ 121,925 $ 48,830 $ 34,116
Purchases............................................ -- 38,430 50,176 90,270 33,515
Sales................................................ -- (10,020) -- -- --
Repayments........................................... (10,669) (13,575) (8,978) (17,270) (18,827)
Discount (premium) amortization...................... 146 1,237 164 95 26
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Mortgage-backed and related securities, net at end of
year............................................... $ 168,836 $ 179,359 $ 163,287 $ 121,925 $ 48,830
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Total loans receivable, net and mortgage-backed and
related securities, net at end of year............. $ 328,526 $ 316,231 $ 279,734 $ 226,008 $ 149,525
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
</TABLE>
54
<PAGE>
LOANS TO ONE BORROWER. The maximum loans that a savings association may
make to one borrower or a related group of borrowers is 15% of the savings
association's unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus, and an additional
amount equal to 10% of unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus if the loan
is collateralized by readily marketable collateral (generally, financial
instruments and bullion, but not real estate). At September 30, 1997, the
Bank's largest real estate related borrower had an aggregate principal
outstanding balance of $1.5 million, or 6.2% of unimpaired capital.
ASSET QUALITY
When a borrower fails to make a required payment on a loan, the Bank
attempts to cure the deficiency by contacting the borrower and seeking the
payment. Depending upon the type of loan, late notices are sent and/or
personal contacts are made. In most cases, deficiencies are cured promptly.
While the Bank generally prefers to work with borrowers to resolve such
problems, when a mortgage loan becomes 90 days delinquent, the Bank generally
institutes foreclosure or other proceedings, as necessary, to minimize any
potential loss.
Loans are placed on non-accrual status when, in the judgement of
management, the probability of collection of interest is deemed to be
insufficient to warrant further accrual. When a loan is placed on non-accrual
status, previously accrued but unpaid interest is deducted from interest
income. The amount of interest that would have been recorded in the year
ended September 30, 1997 if the loans had been current in accordance with
their original terms and had been outstanding throughout the year or since
orgination, if held for part of the period was $14,981 and the amount of
interest included in interest income was $1,824. The Bank generally does not
accrue interest on loans past due 90 days or more. Loans may be reinstated to
accrual status when payments are made to bring the loan under 90 days past
due and, in the opinion of management, collection of the remaining balance
can be reasonably expected.
Real estate acquired by the Bank as a result of foreclosure or by deed in
lieu of foreclosure is classified as real estate owned ("REO") until such
time as it is sold. REO is initially recorded at its estimated fair value,
less estimated selling expenses. Valuations are periodically performed by
management, and any subsequent decline in fair value is charged to operations.
The following table sets forth information regarding loans delinquent for
90 days or more and real estate owned by the Bank at the dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30
-----------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
Nonperforming loans:
Single-family residential real estate.................................. $ 422 $ 766 $ 409 $ 253 $ 635
All other mortgage loans............................................... -- 195 32 178 71
Other loans............................................................ 31 62 55 66 5
--- --------- --- --- ---------
Total delinquent loans............................................... 453 1,023 496 497 711
Total real estate owned.................................................. 17 111 190 130 1,132
--- --------- --- --- ---------
Total nonperforming assets........................................... $ 470 $ 1,134 $ 686 $ 627 $ 1,843
--- --------- --- --- ---------
--- --------- --- --- ---------
Total loan delinquent 90 days or more to net loans receivable............ 0.28% 0.74% 0.43% 0.48% 0.71%
Total loans delinquent 90 days or more to total assets................... 0.12% 0.27% 0.14% 0.16% 0.42%
Total nonperforming loans and REO to total assets........................ 0.12% 0.30% 0.20% 0.20% 1.09%
</TABLE>
CLASSIFICATION OF ASSETS. Federal regulations provide for the
classification of loans and other assets such as debt and equity securities
considered by the OTS to be of lesser quality as "substandard," "doubtful,"
or "loss" assets. An asset is considered "substandard" if it is inadequately
protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of
the collateral pledged, if any. "Substandard" assets include those
characterized by the "distinct possibility" that the savings institution will
sustain "some loss" if the deficiencies are not corrected. Assets classified
as "doubtful" have all of the weaknesses inherent in those classified
"substandard," with the added characteristic that the weaknesses present make
"collection or liquidation in full," on the basis of currently existing
facts, conditions, and values, "highly questionable and improbable." Assets
classified as "loss" are those considered "uncollectible" and of such little
value that their continuance as assets without the establishment of a
specific loss reserve is not
55
<PAGE>
warranted. Assets that do not expose the savings institution to risk
sufficient to warrant classification in one of the aforementioned categories,
but which possess some weaknesses, are required to be designated "special
mention" by management. Loans designated as special mention are generally
loans that, while current in required payments, have exhibited some potential
weaknesses that, if not corrected, could increase the level of risk in the
future.
A savings institution's determination as to the classification of its
assets and the amount of its valuation allowances is subject to review by
federal regulators, who can order the establishment of additional general or
specific loss allowances.
The following table sets forth the aggregate amount of the Bank's
classified assets at the dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30
-----------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
(IN THOUSANDS)
Substandard assets............................................... $ 1,640 $ 3,515 $ 3,074 $ 3,991 $ 1,713
Doubtful assets.................................................. -- -- -- 26 2,448
Loss assets...................................................... 25 89 155 212 73
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
Total classified assets (1)...................................... $ 1,665 $ 3,604 $ 3,229 $ 4,229 $ 4,234
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
--------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) With respect to assets classified "doubtful" and "loss," the Bank has
established aggregate specific loan loss reserves of $25,000, $89,000,
$155,000, $212,000 and $73,000 (in actual dollars) for the years ended
September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.
ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES. It is management's policy to provide for
estimated losses on the Bank's loan portfolio based on management's
evaluation of the potential losses that may be incurred. The Bank regularly
reviews its loan portfolio, including problem loans, to determine whether any
loans require classification or the establishment of appropriate reserves or
allowances for losses. Such evaluation, which includes a review of all loans
for which full collection of interest and principal may not be reasonably
assured, considers, among other matters, the estimated fair value of the
underlying collateral. Other factors considered by management include the
size and risk exposure of each segment of the loan portfolio, present
indicators such as delinquency rates and the borrower's current financial
condition, and the potential for losses in future periods. Management
calculates the general allowance for loan losses in part based on past
experience, and in part based on specified percentages of loan balances.
While both general and specific loss allowances are charged against earnings,
general loan loss allowances are added back to capital, subject to a
limitation of 1.25% of risk-based assets, in computing risk-based capital
under OTS regulations.
During the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995, 1994 and
1993, the Bank added $60,000, $411,200, $0, $0 and $193,299, respectively, to
its allowance for loan losses. The Bank's allowance for loan losses totaled
$1.7 million, $1.7 million, $1.4 million, $1.3 million and $1.3 million at
September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.
56
<PAGE>
ANALYSIS OF THE ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES. The following table sets forth
the analysis of the allowance for loan losses for the periods indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
----------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Total loans outstanding.............................. $ 164,663 $ 142,802 $ 120,340 $ 107,680 $ 103,546
Average net loans outstanding........................ 147,316 124,609 109,658 102,368 98,127
Allowance balances (at beginning of year)............ $ 1,734 $ 1,357 $ 1,330 $ 1,349 $ 1,263
Provision for losses:
Real estate loans.................................. 30 -- -- -- 90
Other loans........................................ 30 411 -- -- 103
Charge-offs:
Real estate loans.................................. (11) (17) (19) (19) (98)
Other loans........................................ (93) (32) (4) -- (9)
Recoveries:
Real estate loans.................................. 1 15 50 -- --
Other loans........................................ -- -- -- -- --
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Allowance balance (at end of year)................... $ 1,691 $ 1,734 $ 1,357 $ 1,330 $ 1,349
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ----------
Allowance for loan losses as a percent of total loans
receivable at end of year.......................... 1.03% 1.21% 1.13% 1.24% 1.30%
Net loans charged off as a percent of average net
loans outstanding.................................. 0.07% 0.04% (0.02)% 0.02% 0.11%
Ratio of allowance for loan losses to total
nonperforming loans at end of year................. 373.45% 169.50% 273.59% 267.60% 189.73%
Ratio of allowance for loan losses to total
nonperforming loans and REO at end of year......... 359.79% 152.91% 197.81% 212.12% 73.20%
</TABLE>
57
<PAGE>
ALLOCATION OF ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES. The following table sets forth the
allocation of allowance for loan losses by loan category for the periods
indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994
------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------ ------------------------
% OF LOANS % OF LOANS % OF LOANS % OF LOANS
IN EACH IN EACH IN EACH IN EACH
CATEGORY TO CATEGORY TO CATEGORY TO CATEGORY TO
AMOUNT TOTAL LOANS AMOUNT TOTAL LOANS AMOUNT TOTAL LOANS AMOUNT TOTAL LOANS
--------- ------------- --------- ------------- --------- ------------- --------- -------------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
Balance at end of
period applicable
to:
Mortgage loans.... $ 927 96.7% $ 903 93.9% $ 894 93.8% $ 863 94.4%
Non-mortgage
loans........... 764 3.3 831 6.1 463 6.2 467 5.6
--------- ----- --------- ----- --------- ----- --------- -----
Total allowance
for loan
losses........ $ 1,691 100.0% $ 1,734 100.0% $ 1,357 100.0% $ 1,330 100.0%
--------- ----- --------- ----- --------- ----- --------- -----
--------- ----- --------- ----- --------- ----- --------- -----
<CAPTION>
Year Ended September 30,
------------------------
1993
------------------------
% OF LOANS
IN EACH
CATEGORY TO
AMOUNT TOTAL LOANS
--------- -------------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C>
Balance at end of
period applicable
to:
Mortgage loans.... $ 957 93.8%
Non-mortgage
loans........... 392 6.2
--------- -----
Total allowance
for loan
losses...... $ 1,349 100.0%
--------- -----
--------- -----
</TABLE>
58
<PAGE>
INVESTMENT ACTIVITIES
Mortgage-Backed Securities. Mortgage-backed securities represent a
participation interest in a pool of single-family or multifamily mortgages, the
principal and interest payments on which are passed from the mortgagors, through
intermediaries that pool and repackage the participation interests in the form
of securities, to investors such as the Bank. Mortgage-backed securities
typically are issued with stated principal amounts. The securities are backed by
pools of mortgages that have loans with interest rates that are within a range
and have varying maturities. The underlying pool of mortgages can be composed of
either fixed-rate mortgages or ARM loans. As a result, the interest rate risk
characteristics of the underlying pool of mortgages, i.e., fixed-rate or
adjustable-rate, as well as the prepayment risk, are passed on to the
certificate holder. The Bank invests in mortgage-backed securities to supplement
local single-family loan originations as well as to reduce interest rate risk
exposure, because mortgage-backed securities are more liquid than mortgage
loans.
59
<PAGE>
Set forth below is selected data relating to the composition of the Bank's
mortgage-backed securities portfolio as of the dates indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994
--------------------- --------------------- --------------------- ---------------------
$ % $ % $ % $ %
---------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------- ---------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Mortgage-backed securities:
Adjustable................... $ 151,766 89.9% $ 155,949 86.9% $ 126,654 77.6% $ 80,380 65.9%
Fixed........................ 17,070 10.1 23,410 13.1 36,633 22.4 41,545 34.1
Total mortgage-backed
securities, net.......... $ 168,836 100.0% $ 179,359 100.0% $ 163,287 100.0% $ 121,925 100.0%
---------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------- ---------
---------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------- --------- ---------- ---------
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
--------------------
1993
--------------------
$ %
--------- ---------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C>
Mortgage-backed securities:
Adjustable................... $ 28,663 58.7%
Fixed........................ 20,167 41.3
Total mortgage-backed
securities, net.......... $ 48,830 100.0%
--------- ---------
--------- ---------
</TABLE>
60
<PAGE>
At September 30, 1997, mortgage-backed securities aggregated $168,836
million, or 44.0%, of the Bank's total assets. At September 30, 1997, all of the
Bank's mortgage-backed securities were classified as held-to-maturity.
OTHER INVESTMENT SECURITIES. The Bank's investment portfolio, excluding
mortgage-backed securities and FHLB stock, consists of obligations of the United
States Government and agencies thereof, municipal bonds, and interest-earning
deposits in other institutions. The carrying value of this portion of the Bank's
investment portfolio totaled $31.7 million, $40.3 million, $51.1 million, $75.7
million and $11.7 million at September 30, 1997, 1996, 1995, 1994 and 1993,
respectively. At September 30, 1997, $0.5 million, or 1.22%, of the Bank's
investment securities, excluding mortgage-backed securities, had a remaining
term to maturity of one year or less, and $19.3 million, or 9.6%, of the Bank's
investment securities portfolio had a remaining term to maturity of five years
or less.
The Bank is required under federal regulations to maintain a minimum amount
of liquid assets that may be invested in specified short-term securities and
certain other investments. See "Regulation Liquidity Requirements." The Bank
generally has maintained a portfolio of liquid assets that exceeds regulatory
requirements. Liquidity levels may be increased or decreased depending upon the
yields on investment alternatives and upon management's judgment as to the
attractiveness of the available yields in relation to other opportunities,
management's expectation of the level of yield that will be available in the
future, as well as management's projections of short term demand for funds in
the Bank's loan origination and other activities.
The following table sets forth the carrying value of the Bank's investment
portfolio and FHLB stock at the dates indicated. At September 30, 1997, the
market value of the Bank's investment portfolio was $213.0 million.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
---------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------
(IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Investment securities:
Mortgage-backed securities.......................... $ 168,836 $ 179,359 $ 163,287 $ 121,925 $ 48,830
U.S. Government treasury obligations................ -- 1,000 2,948 3,148 8,352
U.S. Government agency obligations.................. 26,858 38,871 47,721 72,445 3,316
Municipal bonds..................................... 4,859 459 469 150 150
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------
Total investment securities....................... 200,553 219,689 214,425 197,668 60,648
FHLB stock............................................ 10,053 11,608 10,549 2,496 1,831
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------
Total investments................................. $ 210,606 $ 231,297 $ 224,974 $ 200,164 $ 62,479
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------
</TABLE>
61
<PAGE>
INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO MATURITIES. The following table sets forth the
scheduled maturities, carrying values, market values and average yields for the
Bank's investment securities at September 30, 1997.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30, 1997
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
ONE YEAR ONE TO FIVE YEARS FIVE TO TEN YEARS OVER TEN YEARS
--------------------- --------------------- -------------------- ---------------------
<CAPTION>
ANNUALIZED ANNUALIZED ANNUALIZED ANNUALIZED
WEIGHTED WEIGHTED WEIGHTED WEIGHTED
CARRYING AVERAGE CARRYING AVERAGE CARRYING AVERAGE CARRYING AVERAGE
VALUE YIELD VALUE YIELD VALUE YIELD VALUE YIELD
-------- ---------- -------- ---------- -------- ---------- -------- ----------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Investment securities:
U.S. Government agency
securities.................. $ 501 8.63% $ 19,264 6.32% $ 7,093 7.34% $ -- -%
State and municipal
obligations (1)............. 5 5.11 20 5.35 55 5.91 4,779 5.32
CMOs (2)...................... -- -- 924 6.86 315 8.60 136,598 6.81
Mortgage-backed securities.... 530 5.73 3,670 6.44 10,188 6.77 16,611 7.50
-------- ---------- -------- ---------- -------- ---------- -------- ---
Total investment securities... 1,036 7.12% 23,878 6.36% 17,651 7.03% 157,988 6.84%
---------- ---------- ---------- ---
---------- ---------- ---------- ---
FHLB stock.................... -- -- -- --
Accrued interest on
investments................. 11 209 128 590
-------- -------- -------- ----------
Total investment securities,
including accrued interest.. $1,047 $24,087 $ 17,779 $158,578
-------- -------- -------- --------
-------- -------- -------- --------
<CAPTION>
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
TOTAL
----------------------------------------
ANNUALIZED
AVERAGE WEIGHTED
CARRYING MARKET LIFE IN AVERAGE
VALUE VALUE YEARS YIELD
-------- ------- ------- ----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Investment securities:
U.S. Government agency
securities.................. $ 26,858 $27,076 2.59 6.63%
State and municipal
obligations (1)............. 4,859 4,948 16.39 5.33
CMOs (2)...................... 137,837 139,081 24.63 6.81
Mortgage-backed securities.... 30,999 31,792 12.69 7.10
-------- ------- ------- ---
Total investment securities... 200,553 202,897 6.80
-------
-------
FHLB stock.................... 10,053 10,053 5.96
Accrued interest on
investments................. 938 938
-------- -------
Total investment securities,
including accrued interest.. $211,544 $213,888
-------- -------
-------- -------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) The yield on these tax-exempt obligations has not been compiled on a
tax-equivalent basis.
(2) The average life in years is based on actual stated maturities; however,
management anticipates a shorter life on these securities.
62
<PAGE>
SOURCES OF FUNDS
GENERAL.
Deposits are a significant source of the Bank's funds for lending and other
investment purposes. In addition to deposits, the Bank derives funds from FHLB
advances, the amortization and prepayment of loans and mortgage-backed
securities, the sale or maturity of investment securities, and operations.
Scheduled loan principal repayments are a relatively stable source of funds,
while deposit inflows and outflows and loan prepayments are influenced
significantly by general interest rates and market conditions. Borrowings may be
used on a short-term basis to compensate for reductions in the availability of
funds from other sources or on a longer term basis for general business
purposes.
DEPOSITS. Consumer and commercial deposits are received principally from
within the Bank's market area through the offering of a broad selection of
deposit instruments including NOW accounts, passbook savings, money market
deposit accounts, term certificate accounts and individual retirement accounts.
The Bank also markets term certificate accounts nationally to attract deposits.
Deposit account terms vary according to the minimum balance required, the period
of time during which the funds must remain on deposit, and the interest rate,
among other factors. The maximum rate of interest the Bank must pay is not
established by regulatory authority. The Bank regularly evaluates its internal
cost of funds, surveys rates offered by competing institutions, reviews the
Bank's cash flow requirements for lending and liquidity, and executes rate
changes when deemed appropriate. As of September 30, 1997, the Bank did not have
any brokered deposits.
TIME DEPOSIT RATES. The following table sets forth the certificates of
deposit of the Bank classified by rates as of the dates indicated:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AT SEPTEMBER 30,
------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
---------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
(IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Rate:
2.00-3.99%................................................ $ 16 $ 17 $ 126 $ 35,529 $ 72,268
4.00-5.99%................................................ 76,094 75,615 51,125 42,154 8,339
6.00-7.99%................................................ 32,170 6,205 32,916 817 1,989
8.00-9.99%................................................ -- 20 20 836 2,004
---------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
$ 108,280 $ 81,857 $ 84,187 $ 79,336 $ 84,600
---------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
---------- --------- --------- --------- ---------
</TABLE>
TIME DEPOSIT MATURITIES. The following table sets forth the amount and
maturities of certificates of deposit at September 30, 1997.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
MATURITY
--------------------------------------------------------
3 MONTHS 3 TO 6 6 TO 12 OVER 12
OR LESS MONTHS MONTHS MONTHS TOTAL
----------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
(IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Certificates of deposit less than $100,000................ $ 26,659 $ 28,726 $ 16,757 $ 15,727 $ 87,869
Certificates of deposit greater than $100,000............. 3,988 5,924 7,306 3,193 20,411
----------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
Total certificates of deposit............................. $ 30,647 $ 34,650 $ 24,063 $ 18,920 $ 108,280
----------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
----------- --------- --------- --------- ----------
</TABLE>
BORROWINGS
Deposits of the Bank are a significant source of funds as is short term and
long term advances from the FHLB. FHLB advances are collateralized by the Bank's
stock in the FHLB, investment securities and a blanket lien on the Bank's
mortgage portfolio. Such advances are made pursuant to different credit
programs, each of which has its own interest rate and range of maturities. The
maximum amount that the FHLB will advance to member institutions, including the
Bank, for purposes other than meeting withdrawals, fluctuates from time to time
in accordance with the policies of the FHLB. The maximum amount of FHLB advances
to a member institution generally is reduced by borrowings from any other
source. At September 30, 1997, the Bank's FHLB advances totaled $190.6 million.
63
<PAGE>
The Bank sells securities under agreements to repurchase with selected
dealers (reverse repurchase agreements) as a means of obtaining short-term funds
as market conditions permit. In a reverse repurchase agreement, the Bank sells a
fixed dollar amount of securities to a dealer under an agreement to repurchase
the securities at a specific price within a specific period of time, typically
not more than 180 days. Reverse repurchase agreements are treated as a liability
of the Bank. The dollar amount of securities underlying the agreements remain an
asset of the Bank. At September 30, 1997, the Bank's securities sold under
agreements to repurchase totaled $20.7 million.
The following table sets forth certain information regarding borrowings by
the Bank during the periods indicated.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30,
---------------------------------------------------------
1997 1996 1995 1994 1993
---------- ---------- ---------- ---------- ---------
(DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Weighted average rate paid on: (1)
FHLB advances....................................... 5.54% 5.64% 6.17% 3.78% 5.43%
Other borrowings (2)................................ 5.81% 5.59% 5.75% 4.48% 3.46%
FHLB advances:
Maximum balance..................................... $ 230,317 $ 239,686 $ 210,987 $ 49,369 $ 36,366
Average balance..................................... $ 203,835 $ 224,719 $ 167,766 $ 31,254 $ 26,109
Other borrowings: (2)
Maximum balance..................................... $ 21,060 $ 10,306 $ 131,500 $ 119,430 $ 1,450
Average balance..................................... $ 17,684 $ 2,940 $ 67,000 $ 53,784 $ 1,355
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Calculated using monthly weighted average interest rates.
(2) Includes borrowings under reverse repurchase agreements.
SUBSIDIARIES' ACTIVITIES
The Bank has two wholly owned subsidiaries, Sun Realty, Inc. ("Sun") and
P.F. Service, Inc. ("P.F. Service"). Both are Arkansas corporations and both are
substantially inactive.
At September 30, 1997, the Bank had a $18,723 equity investment in Sun, and
a $363,428 equity investment in P.F. Service. For the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1997, Sun had net loss of $1,117 and P.F. Service had net income
of $1,665. At September 30, 1997, Sun had $19,223 in total assets, $500 in total
liabilities and $18,723 in stockholder's equity. At September 30, 1997, P.F.
Service had $383,228 in total assets, $19,800 in total liabilities and $363,428
in stockholder's equity.
PERSONNEL
The Bank and its subsidiaries had 55 full-time employees and 9 part-time
employees at September 30, 1997. None of these employees is party to a
collective bargaining agreement, and the Bank believes that it enjoys good
relations with its personnel.
COMPETITION
The Bank faces strong competition both in attracting deposits and in
origination of loans. Competitors for deposits include thrift institutions,
commercial banks, credit unions, money market funds, and other investment
alternatives, such as mutual funds, full service and discount broker-dealers,
brokerage accounts, and savings bonds or other government securities. Primary
competitive factors include convenience of locations, variety of deposit or
investment options, rates or terms offered, and quality of customer service.
64
<PAGE>
The Bank competes for mortgage loan originations with thrift institutions,
banks and mortgage companies, including many large financial institutions, which
have greater financial and marketing resources available to them. Primary
competitive factors include service quality and speed, relationships with
builders and real estate brokers, and rates and fees.
The Bank believes that it has been able to compete effectively in its
principal markets, and that competitive pressures have not materially interfered
with the Bank's ongoing operations.
PROPERTIES
The Bank conducts its business through its main office and eight
full-service branch offices located in five counties in Northeast Arkansas. Each
office is owned by the Bank. The following table sets forth certain information
concerning the main office and each branch office of the Bank at September 30,
1997. The aggregate net book value of the Bank's premises and equipment at these
locations was $1.8 million at September 30, 1997.
Main Office:
203 W. Broadway
Pocahontas, Arkansas
(Opened 1935)
<TABLE>
<S> <C>
Branch Offices:
Walnut Ridge Branch Corning Branch
120 W. Main Street Walnut 309 Missouri Avenue
Ridge, AR Corning, Arkansas
(Opened 1968) (Opened 1983)
Jonesboro Branch Hardy Branch
700 S.W. Drive Highway 62
Jonesboro, Arkansas Hardy, Arkansas
(Opened 1976) (Opened 1983)
Jonesboro Branch
2213 Caraway Road
Jonesboro, Arkansas
(Opened 1996)
</TABLE>
In January 1998, the Bank completed it acquisition of three additional
full-service branch offices located in Lawrence, Sharp and Craighead Counties,
Arkansas. The addresses of these newly acquired branches are set forth below.
The aggregate net book value of the Bank's premises and equipment at these
branch offices was $ million as of January 22, 1998.
<TABLE>
<S> <C>
Lake City Hardy
100 Cobean Boulevard 522 Main
Lake City, Arkansas 72437 Hardy, Arkansas 72542
Walnut Ridge
300 W. Main Walnut
Ridge, Arkansas 72476
</TABLE>
65
<PAGE>
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
There are various claims and lawsuits in which the Bank is periodically
involved incident to the Bank's business. In the opinion of management, no
material loss is expected from any of such pending claims or lawsuits.
REGULATION
As a federally chartered SAIF-insured savings association, the Bank is
subject to examination, supervision and extensive regulation by the OTS and
the FDIC. The Bank is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") system.
This regulation and supervision establishes a comprehensive framework of
activities in which an institution can engage and is intended primarily for
the protection of the insurance fund and depositors. The Bank also is subject
to regulation by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the
"Federal Reserve Board") governing reserves to be maintained against deposits
and certain other matters. The OTS examines the Bank and prepares reports for
the consideration of the Bank's Board of Directors on any deficiencies that
they may find in the Bank's operations. The FDIC also examines the Bank in
its role as the administrator of the SAIF. The Bank's relationship with its
depositors and borrowers also is regulated to a great extent by both federal
and state laws especially in such matters as the ownership of savings
accounts and the form and content of the Bank's mortgage documents. Any
change in such regulation, whether by the FDIC, OTS, or Congress, could have
a material impact on the Company and the Bank and their operations.
FEDERAL REGULATION OF SAVINGS INSTITUTIONS
BUSINESS ACTIVITIES. The activities of savings institutions are governed
by the Home Owners' Loan Act, as amended (the "HOLA") and, in certain
respects, the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (the "FDI Act") and the
regulations issued by the agencies to implement these statutes. These laws
and regulations delineate the nature and extent of the activities in which
savings association may engage. The description of statutory provisions and
regulations applicable to savings associations set forth herein does not
purport to be a complete description of such statutes and regulations and
their effect on the Bank.
LOANS TO ONE BORROWER. Under the HOLA, savings institutions are generally
subject to the national bank limits on loans to a single or related group of
borrowers. Generally, this limit is 15% of the Bank's unimpaired capital and
surplus plans and an additional 10% of unimpaired capital and surplus, if such
loan is secured by readily-marketable collateral, which is defined to include
certain financial instruments and bullion. The OTS by regulation has amended the
loans to one borrower rule to permit savings associations meeting certain
requirement to extend loans to one borrower in additional amounts under
circumstances limited essentially to loans to develop or complete residential
housing units.
QUALIFIED THRIFT LENDER TEST. In general, savings associations are required
to maintain at least 65% of their portfolio assets in certain qualified thrift
investments (which consist primarily of loans and other investments related to
residential real estate and certain other assets). A savings association that
fails the qualified thrift lender test is subject to substantial restrictions on
activities and to other significant penalties. Recent legislation permits a
savings association to qualify as a qualified thrift lender not only by
maintaining 65% of portfolio assets in qualified thrift investments (the "QTL
test") but also, in the alternative, by qualifying under the Code as a "domestic
building and loan association." the Bank is a domestic building and loan
association as defined in the Code.
Recent legislation also expands the QTL test to provide savings associations
with greater authority to lend and diversify their portfolios. In particular,
credit card and education loans may now be made by savings associations without
regard to any percentage-of-assets limit, and commercial loans may be made in an
amount up to 10 percent of total assets, plus an additional 10 percent for small
business loans. Loans for personal, family and household purposes (other than
credit card, small business and educational loans) are now included without
limit with other assets
66
<PAGE>
that, in the aggregate, may account for up to 20% of total assets. At
September 30, 1997, under the expanded QTL test, approximately 85.5% of the
Bank's portfolio assets were qualified thrift investments.
LIMITATION ON CAPITAL DISTRIBUTIONS. OTS regulations impose limitations
upon all capital distributions by savings institutions, such as cash
dividends, payments to repurchase or otherwise acquire its shares, payments
to stockholders of another institution in a cash-out merger and other
distributions charged against capital. The rule establishes three tiers of
institutions, which are based primarily on an institution's capital level. An
institution, such as the Bank, that exceeds all fully phased-in capital
requirements before and after a proposed capital distribution ("Tier 1
Association") and has not been advised by the OTS that it is in need of more
than normal supervision, could, after prior notice but without the approval
of the OTS, make capital distributions during a calendar year equal to the
greater of: (i) 100% of its net earnings to date during the calendar year
plus the amount that would reduce by one-half its "surplus capital ratio"
(the excess capital over its fully phased-in capital requirements) at the
beginning of the calendar year; or (ii) 75% of its net earnings for the
previous four quarters; provided that the institution would not be
undercapitalized, as that term is defined in the OTS Prompt Corrective Action
regulations, following the capital distribution. Any additional capital
distributions would require prior regulatory approval. In the event the
Bank's capital fell below its fully-phased in requirement or the OTS notified
it that it was in need of more than normal supervision, the Bank's ability to
make capital distributions could be restricted. In addition, the OTS could
prohibit a proposed capital distribution by any institution, which would
otherwise be permitted by the regulation, if the OTS determines that such
distribution would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice.
LIQUIDITY. The Bank is required to maintain an average daily balance of
specified liquid assets equal to a monthly average of not less than a specified
percentage (currently 4%) of its net withdrawable deposit accounts plus
borrowings payable in one year or less. Monetary penalties may be imposed for
failure to meet these liquidity requirements. The Bank's average liquidity ratio
for the quarter ended September 30, 1997 was 10.01%, which exceeded the then
applicable requirements. The Bank has never been subject to monetary penalties
for failure to meet its liquidity requirements.
COMMUNITY REINVESTMENT ACT AND FAIR LENDING LAWS. Savings association share
a responsibility under the Community Reinvestment Act ("CRA") and related
regulations of the OTS to help meet the credit needs of their communities,
including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods. In addition, the Equal Credit
Opportunity Act and the Fair Housing Act (together, the "Fair Lending Laws")
prohibit lenders from discriminating in their lending practices on the basis of
characteristics specified in those statutes. An institution's failure to comply
with the provisions of CRA could, at a minimum, result in regulatory
restrictions on its activities, and failure to complete with the Fair Lending
Laws could result in enforcement actions by the OTS, as well as other federal
regulatory agencies and the Department of Justice. The Bank received a
"satisfactory" CRA rating under the current CRA regulations in its most recent
federal examination by the OTS.
TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES. The Bank's authority to engage in
transactions with related parties or "affiliates" (i.e., any company that
controls or is under common control with an institution, including the Company
and any non-savings institution subsidiaries) or to make loans to certain
insiders, is limited by Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act ("FRA").
Section 23A limits the aggregate amount of transactions with any individual
affiliate to 10% of the capital and surplus of the savings institution and also
limits the aggregate amount of transactions with all affiliates to 20% of the
savings institution's capital and surplus. Certain transactions with affiliates
are required to be secured by collateral in an amount and of a type described in
Section 23A and the purchase of low quality assets from affiliates is generally
prohibited. Section 23B provides that certain transactions with affiliates,
including loans and asset purchases, must be on terms and under circumstances,
including credit standards, that are substantially the same or at least as
favorable to the institution as those prevailing at the time for comparable
transactions with non-affiliated companies.
ENFORCEMENT. Under the FDI Act, the OTS has primary enforcement
responsibility over savings institutions and has the authority to bring
enforcement action against all "institution-related parties," including
stockholders, and any attorneys, appraisers and accountants who knowingly or
recklessly participate in wrongful action likely to have
67
<PAGE>
an adverse effect on an insured institution. Formal enforcement action may
range from the issuance of a capital directive or cease and desist order to
removal of officers and/or directors of the institutions, receivership,
conservatorship or the termination of deposit insurance. Civil penalties
cover a wide range of violations and actions, and range up to $25,000 per
day, unless a finding of reckless disregard is made, in which case penalties
may be as high as $1 million per day. Under the FDI Act, the FDIC has the
authority to recommend to the Director of OTS that enforcement action be
taken with respect to a particular savings institution. If action is not
taken by the Director, the FDIC has authority to take such action under
certain circumstances.
STANDARDS FOR SAFETY AND SOUNDNESS. The FDI Act requires each federal
banking agency to prescribe for all insured depository institutions standards
relating to, among other things, internal controls, information systems and
audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate risk
exposure, asset growth, and compensation fees and benefits and such other
operational and managerial standards as the agency deems appropriate. The
federal banking agencies adopted a final regulation and Interagency Guidelines
Prescribing Standards for Safety and Soundness ("Guidelines") to implement the
safety and soundness standards required under the FDI Act. The Guidelines set
forth the safety and soundness standards that the federal banking agencies use
to identify and address problems at insured depository institutions before
capital becomes impaired. The Guidelines address internal controls and
information systems; internal audit system; credit underwriting; loan
documentation; interest rate risk exposure; asset growth; and compensation, fees
and benefits. If the appropriate federal banking agency determines that an
institution fails to meet any standard prescribed by the Guidelines, the agency
may require the institution to submit to the agency an acceptable plan to
achieve compliance with the standard, as required by the FDI Act. The final
regulations establish deadlines for the submission and review of such safety and
soundness compliance plans.
CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS. The OTS capital regulations require savings
institutions to meet three capital standards: a 1.5% tangible capital standard,
a 3% leverage (core capital) ratio and an 8% risk based capital standard. Core
capital is defined as common stockholder's equity (including retained earnings),
certain non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus, minority
interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries less intangibles other
than certain mortgage servicing rights ("MSRs") and credit card relationships.
The OTS regulations require that, in meeting the leverage ratio, tangible and
risk-based capital standards institutions generally must deduct investments in
and loans to subsidiaries engaged in activities not permissible for a national
bank. In addition, the OTS prompt corrective action regulation provides that a
savings institution that has a leverage capital ratio of less than 4% (3% for
institutions receiving the highest CAMEL examination rating) will be deemed to
be "undercapitalized" and may be subject to certain restrictions. See "--Prompt
Corrective Regulatory Action."
The risk-based capital standard for savings institutions requires the
maintenance of total capital (which is defined as core capital and supplementary
capital) to risk-weighted assets of 8%. In determining the amount of
risk-weighted assets, all assets, including certain off-balance sheet assets,
are multiplied by a risk-weight of 0% to 100%, as assigned by the OTS capital
regulation based on the risks OTS believes are inherent in the type of asset.
The components of core capital are equivalent to those discussed earlier under
the 3% leverage standard. The components of supplementary capital currently
include cumulative preferred stock, long-term perpetual preferred stock,
mandatory convertible securities, subordinated debt and intermediate preferred
stock and, within specified limits, the allowance for loan and lease losses.
Overall, the amount of supplementary capital included as part of total capital
cannot exceed 100% of core capital.
At September 30, 1997, the Bank met each of its capital requirements. See
"Historical and Pro Forma Capital Compliance" for a table which sets forth in
terms of dollars and percentages the OTS tangible, leverage and risk-based
capital requirements, the Bank's historical amounts and percentages at September
30, 1997, and pro forma amounts and percentages based upon the issuance of the
shares within the Offering Range and assuming that a portion of the net proceeds
are retained by the Company.
THRIFT CHARTER. Congress has been considering legislation in various forms
that would require federal thrifts, such as the Bank, to convert their charters
to national or state bank charters. Recent legislation required the Treasury
Department to prepare for Congress a comprehensive study on development of a
common charter for federal savings
68
<PAGE>
association and commercial banks; and, in the event that the thrift charter
was eliminated by January 1, 1999, would require the merger of the BIF and
the SAIF into a single deposit insurance fund on that date. The Bank cannot
determine whether, or in what form, such legislation may eventually be
enacted and there can be no assurance that any legislation that is enacted
would not adversely affect the Bank and the Company.
PROMPT CORRECTIVE REGULATORY ACTION
Under the OTS Prompt Corrective Action regulations, the OTS is required to
take certain supervisory actions against undercapitalized institutions, the
severity of which depends upon the institution's degree of capitalization.
Generally, a savings institution that has total risk-based capital of less than
8.0% or a leverage ratio or a Tier 1 core capital ratio that is less than 4.0%
is considered to be undercapitalized. A savings institution that has the total
risk-based capital less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 core risk-based capital ratio of
less than 3.0% or a leverage ratio that is less than 3.0% is considered to be
"significantly undercapitalized" and a savings institution that has a tangible
capital to assets ratio equal to or less than 2.0% is deemed to be "critically
undercapitalized." Subject to a narrow exception, the banking regulator is
required to appoint a receiver or conservator for an institution that is
"critically undercapitalized." The regulation also provides that a capital
restoration plan must be filed with the OTS within 45 days of the date an
institution receives notice that it is "undercapitalized," "significantly
undercapitalized" or "critically undercapitalized." In addition, numerous
mandatory supervisory actions become immediately applicable to the institution,
including, but not limited to, restrictions on growth, investment activities,
capital distributions, and affiliate transactions. The OTS could also take any
one of a number of discretionary supervisory actions, including the issuance of
a capital directive and the replacement of senior executive officers and
directors.
INSURANCE OF DEPOSIT ACCOUNTS
The FDIC has adopted a risk-based insurance assessment system. The FDIC
assigns an institution to one of three capital categories based on the
institution's financial information, as of the reporting period ending seven
months before the assessment period, consisting of (1) well capitalized, (2)
adequately capitalized or (3) undercapitalized, and one of three supervisory
subcategories within each capital group. The supervisory subgroup to which an
institution is assigned is based on a supervisory evaluation provided to the
FDIC by the institution's primary federal regulator and information which the
FDIC determines to be relevant to the institution's financial condition and the
risk posed to the deposit insurance funds. An institution's assessment rate
depends on the capital category and supervisory category to which it is
assigned. The FDIC is authorized to raise the assessment rates in certain
circumstances. The FDIC has exercised this authority several times in the past
and may raise insurance premiums in the future. If such action is taken by the
FDIC, it could have an adverse effect on the earnings of the Bank.
FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK SYSTEM
The Bank is a member of the FHLB System, which consists of 12 regional
FHLBs. The FHLB provides a central credit facility primarily for member
institutions. The Bank, as a member of the FHLB, is required to acquire and hold
shares of capital stock in that FHLB in an amount at least equal to 1% of the
aggregate principal amount of its unpaid residential mortgage loans and similar
obligations at the beginning of each year, or 1/20 of its advances (borrowings)
from the FHLB, whichever is greater. As of September 30, 1997, the Bank was in
compliance with this requirement.
The FHLBs are required to provide funds for the resolution of insolvent
thrifts and to contribute funds for affordable housing programs. These
requirements could reduce the amount of dividends that the FHLBs pay to their
members and could also result in the FHLBs imposing a higher rate of interest on
advances to their members.
69
<PAGE>
FEDERAL RESERVE SYSTEM
The Federal Reserve Board regulations require savings institutions to
maintain non-interest-earning reserves against their transaction accounts
(primarily NOW and regular checking accounts). The Federal Reserve Board
regulations generally require that reserves be maintained against aggregate
transaction accounts as follows: for accounts aggregating $49.3 million or
less (subject to adjustment by the Federal Reserve Board) the reserve
requirement is 3%; and for accounts greater than $49.3 million, the reserve
requirement is $1.5 million (subject to adjustment by the Federal Reserve
Board between 8% and 14%) against that portion of total transaction accounts
in excess of $49.3 million. The first $4.4 million of otherwise reservable
balances (subject to adjustments by the Federal Reserve Board) are exempted
from the reserve requirements. The Bank is in compliance with the foregoing
requirements. The balances maintained to meet the reserve requirements
imposed by the FRB may be used to satisfy liquidity requirements imposed by
the OTS.
HOLDING COMPANY REGULATION
THE COMPANY. The Company will be a non-diversified unitary savings and
loan holding company within the meaning of the HOLA. As such, the Company
will be required to register with the OTS and will be subject to OTS
regulations, examinations, supervision and reporting requirements. In
addition, the OTS has enforcement authority over the Company and its
non-savings institution subsidiaries. Among other things, this authority
permits the OTS to restrict or prohibit activities that are determined to be
a serious risk to the subsidiary savings institution. The Bank must notify
the OTS 30 days before declaring any dividend to the Company.
As a unitary savings and loan holding company, the Company generally will
not be restricted under existing laws as to the types of business activities
in which it may engage, provided that the Bank continues to be a QTL. See
"--Federal Regulation of Savings Institutions--Qualified Thrift Lender Test"
for a discussion of the QTL requirements. Upon any non-supervisory
acquisition by the Company of another savings association, the Company would
become a multiple savings and loan holding company (if the acquired
institution is held as a separate subsidiary) and would be subject to
extensive limitations on the types of business activities in which it could
engage. The HOLA limits the activities of a multiple savings and loan holding
company and its non-insured institution subsidiaries primarily to activities
permissible for bank holding companies under Section 4(c)(8) of the Bank
Holding Company ("BHC") Act, subject to the prior approval of the OTS, and to
other activities authorized by OTS regulation. Recently proposed legislation
would treat all savings and loan holding companies as bank holding companies
and limit the activities of such companies to those permissible for bank
holding companies. See "Risk Factors-- Regulatory Oversight and Possible
Legislation."
The HOLA prohibits a savings and loan holding company, directly or
indirectly, or through one or more subsidiaries, from acquiring another
savings institution or holding company thereof, without prior written
approval of the OTS. It also prohibits the acquisition or retention of, with
certain exceptions, more than 5% of a non-subsidiary savings institution, a
non-subsidiary holding company, or a non-subsidiary company engaged in
activities other than those permitted by the HOLA; or acquiring or retaining
control of an institution that is not federally insured. In evaluating
applications by holding companies to acquire savings institutions, the OTS
must consider the financial and managerial resources, future prospects of the
company and institution involved, the effect of the acquisition on the risk
to the insurance fund, the convenience and needs of the community and
competitive factors.
The OTS is prohibited from approving any acquisition that would result in
a multiple savings and loan holding company controlling savings institutions
in more than one state, subject to two exceptions: (i) the approval of
interstate supervisory acquisitions by savings and loan holding companies,
and (ii) the acquisition of a savings institution in another state if the
laws of the state of the target savings institution specifically permit such
acquisitions. The states vary in the extent to which they permit interstate
savings and loan holding company acquisitions.
THE MUTUAL HOLDING COMPANY. The Mutual Holding Company is a non-diversified
mutual savings and loan holding company within the meaning of the HOLA, as
amended. As such, the Mutual Holding Company is registered
70
<PAGE>
with the OTS and is subject to OTS regulations, examinations, supervision and
reporting requirements. In addition, the OTS has enforcement authority over
the Mutual Holding Company and any non-savings institution subsidiaries.
Among other things, this authority permits the OTS to restrict or prohibit
activities that are determined to be a serious risk to the subsidiary savings
institution.
Pursuant to Section 10(o) of the HOLA and OTS regulations and policy, a
mutual holding company may engage in the following activities: (i) investing
in the stock of a savings association; (ii) acquiring a mutual association
through the merger of such association into a savings association subsidiary
of such holding company or an interim savings association subsidiary of such
holding company; (iii) merging with or acquiring another holding company; one
of whose subsidiaries is a savings association; (iv) investing in a
corporation, the capital stock of which is available for purchase by a
savings association under federal law or under the law of any state where the
subsidiary savings association or associations share their home offices; (v)
furnishing or performing management services for a savings association
subsidiary of such company; (vi) holding, managing or liquidating assets
owned or acquired from a savings subsidiary of such company; (vii) holding or
managing properties used or occupied by a savings association subsidiary of
such company properties used or occupied by a savings association subsidiary
of such company; (viii) acting as trustee under deeds of trust; (ix) any
other activity (A) that the Federal Reserve Board, by regulation, has
determined to be permissible for bank holding companies under Section 4(c) of
the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, unless the Director, by regulation,
prohibits or limits any such activity for savings and loan holding companies;
or (B) in which multiple savings and loan holding companies were authorized
(by regulation) to directly engage on March 5, 1987; and (x) purchasing,
holding, or disposing of stock acquired in connection with a qualified stock
issuance if the purchase of such stock by such savings and loan holding
company is approved by the Director. If a mutual holding company acquires or
merges with another holding company, the holding company acquired or the
holding company resulting from such merger or acquisition may only invest in
assets and engage in activities listed in (i) through (x) above, and has a
period of two years to cease any non-conforming activities and divest of any
non-conforming investments.
The HOLA prohibits a savings and loan holding company, including the
Mutual Holding Company, directly or indirectly, or through one or more
subsidiaries, from acquiring another savings institution or holding company
thereof, without prior written approval of the OTS. It also prohibits the
acquisition or retention of, with certain exceptions, more than 5% of a
non-subsidiary savings institution, a non-subsidiary holding company, or a
non-subsidiary company engaged in activities other than those permitted by
the HOLA; or acquiring or retaining control of an institution that is not
federally insured. In evaluating applications by holding companies to acquire
savings institutions, the OTS must consider the financial and managerial
resources, future prospects of the company and institution involved, the
effect of the acquisition on the risk to the insurance fund, the convenience
and needs of the community and competitive factors.
The OTS is prohibited from approving any acquisition that would result in
a multiple savings and loan holding company controlling savings institutions
in more than one state, subject to two exceptions: (i) the approval of
interstate supervisory acquisitions by savings and loan holding companies,
and (ii) the acquisition of a savings institution in another state if the
laws of the state of the target savings institution specifically permit such
acquisitions. The states vary in the extent to which they permit interstate
savings and loan holding company acquisitions.
In addition, OTS regulations require the Mutual Holding Company to notify
the OTS of any proposed waiver of its right to receive dividends. It is the
OTS' recent practice to review dividend waiver notices on a case-by-case
basis, and, in general, not object to any such waiver if: (i) the mutual
holding company's board of directors determines that such waiver is
consistent with such directors' fiduciary duties to the mutual holding
company's members; (ii) for as long as the savings association subsidiary is
controlled by the mutual holding company, the dollar amount of dividends
waived by the mutual holding company are considered as a restriction on the
retained earnings of the savings association, which restriction, if material,
is disclosed in the public financial statements of the savings association as
a note to the financial statements; (iii) the amount of any dividend waived
by the mutual holding company is available for declaration as a dividend
solely to the mutual holding company, and, in accordance with SFAS 5, where
the savings association determines that the payment of such dividend to the
mutual holding company is probable, an
71
<PAGE>
appropriate dollar amount is recorded as a liability; (iv) the amount of any
waived dividend is considered as having been paid by the savings association
in evaluating any proposed dividend under OTS capital distribution
regulations; and (v) in the event the mutual holding company converts to
stock form, the appraisal submitted to the OTS in connection with the
conversion application takes into account the aggregate amount of the
dividends waived by the mutual holding company.
FEDERAL SECURITIES LAWS
The Company has filed with the SEC a registration statement under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended ("Securities Act"), for the registration
of the Common Stock to be issued pursuant to the Conversion. Upon completion
of the Conversion, the Company's Common Stock will be registered with the SEC
under the Exchange Act. The Company will then be subject to the information,
proxy solicitation, insider trading restrictions and other requirements under
the Exchange Act.
The registration under the Securities Act of shares of the Common Stock
to be issued in the Conversion does not cover the resale of such shares.
Shares of the Common Stock purchased by persons who are not affiliates of the
Company may be resold without registration. Shares purchased by an affiliate
of the Company will be subject to the resale restrictions of Rule 144 under
the Securities Act. If the Company meets the current public information
requirements of Rule 144 under the Securities Act, each affiliate of the
Company who complies with the other conditions of Rule 144 (including those
that require the affiliate's sale to be aggregated with those of certain
other persons) would be able to sell in the public market, without
registration, a number of shares not to exceed, in any three-month period,
the greater of (i) 1% of the outstanding shares of the Company or (ii) the
average weekly volume of trading in such shares during the preceding four
calendar weeks. Provision may be made in the future by the Company to permit
affiliates to have their shares registered for sale under the Securities Act
under certain circumstances.
TAXATION
FEDERAL TAXATION
TAX BAD DEBT RESERVES. The Bank is subject to the rules of federal
income taxation generally applicable to corporations under the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"). Most corporations are not
permitted to make deductible additions to bad debt reserves under the Code.
However, savings and loan associations and savings associations such as the
Bank, which meet certain tests prescribed by the Code may benefit from
favorable provisions regarding deductions from taxable income for annual
additions to their bad debt reserve. For purposes of the bad debt reserve
deduction, loans are separated into "qualifying real property loans," which
generally are loans collateralized by interests in real property, and
non-qualifying loans, which are all other loans. The bad debt reserve
deduction with respect to non-qualifying loans must be based on actual loss
experience. The amount of the bad debt reserve deduction with respect to
qualifying real property loans may be based upon actual loss experience (the
"experience method") or a percentage of taxable income determined without
regard to such deduction (the "percentage of taxable income method").
The Bank has elected to use the method that results in the greatest
deduction for federal income tax purposes. The amount of the bad debt
deduction that a thrift institution may claim with respect to additions to
its reserve for bad debts is subject to certain limitations. First, the full
deduction is available only if at least 60% of the institution's assets fall
within certain designated categories. Second, under the percentage of taxable
income method the bad debt deduction attributable to "qualifying real
property loans" cannot exceed the greater of (i) the amount deductible under
the experience method or (ii) the amount which, when added to the bad debt
deduction for non-qualifying loans, equals the amount by which 12% of the sum
of the total deposits and the advance payments by borrowers for taxes and
insurance at the end of the taxable years exceeds the sum of the surplus,
undivided profits, and reserves at the beginning of the taxable year. Third,
the amount of the bad debt deduction attributable to qualifying real property
loans computed using the percentage of taxable income method is permitted
only to the extent that the institution's
72
<PAGE>
reserve for losses on qualifying real property loans at the close of the
taxable year does not exceed 6% of such loans outstanding at such time.
Under recently enacted legislation, the percentage of taxable income
method has been repealed for years beginning after December 31, 1995. Large
associations, i.e., those for which the quarterly average of the
association's total assets or the consolidated group of which it is a member,
exceeds $500 million for the year, may no longer be entitled to use the
experience method of computing additions to their bad debt reserve. A "large"
association must use the direct write-off method for deducting bad debts,
under which charge-offs are deducted and recoveries are taken into taxable
income as incurred. If the Bank is not a "large" association, the Bank will
continue to be permitted to use the experience method. The Bank will be
required to recapture (i.e., take into income) over a six year period its
applicable excess reserves, i.e. the balances of its reserves for losses on
qualifying loans and nonqualifying loans, as of the close of the last tax
year beginning before January 1, 1996, over the greater of (a) the balance of
such reserves as of December 31, 1987 (pre-1988 reserves) or (b) in the case
of a bank which is not a "large" association, an amount that would have been
the balance of such reserves as of the close of the last tax year beginning
before January 1, 1996, had the bank always computed the additions to its
reserves using the experience method. Postponement of the recapture is
possible for a two-year period if an association meets a minimum level of
mortgage lending for 1996 and 1997. As of September 30, 1997, the Bank's bad
debt reserve subject to recapture over a six-year period totaled
approximately $1,178,000. The Bank has established, as a component of its net
deferred tax asset, a deferred tax liability of approximately $477,000 for
this recapture.
If an association ceases to qualify as a a bank (as defined in Code
Section 581) or converts to a credit union, the pre-1988 reserves and the
supplemental reserve are restored to income ratably over a six-year period,
beginning in the tax year the association no longer qualifies as a bank. The
balance of the pre-1988 reserves are also subject to recapture in the case of
certain excess distributions to (including distributions on liquidation and
dissolution), or redemptions of, shareholders.
DISTRIBUTIONS. To the extent that (i) the Bank's tax bad debt reserve
for losses on qualifying real property loans exceeds the amount that would
have been allowed under an experience method and (ii) the Bank makes
"non-dividend distributions" to stockholders that are considered to result in
distributions from the excess tax bad debt reserve or the reserve for losses
on loans ("Excess Distributions"), then an amount based on the amount
distributed will be included in the Bank's taxable income. Non-dividend
distributions include distributions in excess of the Bank's current and
accumulated earnings and profits, distributions in redemption of stock and
distributions in partial or complete liquidation. However, dividends paid out
of the Bank's current or accumulated earnings and profits, as calculated for
federal income tax purposes, will not be considered to result in a
distribution from the Bank's tax bad debt reserves. Thus, any dividends to
the Company that would reduce amounts appropriated to the Bank's tax bad debt
reserves and deducted for federal income tax purposes would create a tax
liability for the Bank. The amount of additional taxable income created from
an Excess Distribution is an amount that when reduced by the tax attributable
to the income is equal to the amount of the distribution. Thus, if certain
portions of the Bank's accumulated tax bad debt reserve are used for any
purpose other than to absorb qualified tax bad debt losses, such as for the
payment of dividends or other distributions with respect to the Bank's
capital stock (including distributions upon redemption or liquidation),
approximately one and one-half times the amount so used would be includable
in gross income for federal income tax purposes, assuming a 34% corporate
income tax rate (exclusive of state taxes). See "Regulation--Federal
Regulations--Limitations on Capital Distributions" for limits on the payment
of dividends of the Bank. The Bank does not intend to pay dividends that
would result in a recapture of any portion of its tax bad debt reserves.
CORPORATE ALTERNATIVE MINIMUM TAX. The Bank is subject to the corporate
alternative minimum tax which is imposed to the extent it exceeds the Bank's
regular income tax for the year. The alternative minimum tax will be imposed
at the rate of 20% of a specially computed tax base. Included in this base
will be a number of preference items, including the following: (i) 100% of
the excess of a thrift institution's bad debt deduction over the amount that
would have been allowable on the basis of actual experience; (ii) interest on
certain tax-exempt bonds issued after August 7, 1986; and (iii) for years
beginning in 1988 and 1989 an amount equal to one-half of the amount by which
a institution's "book income" (as specially defined) exceeds its taxable
income with certain adjustments, including the
73
<PAGE>
addition of preference items (for taxable years commencing after 1989 this
adjustment item is replaced with a new preference item relating to "adjusted
current earnings" as specially computed). In addition, for purposes of the
new alternative minimum tax, the amount of alternative minimum taxable income
that may be offset by net operating losses is limited to 90% of alternative
minimum taxable income.
The Mutual Holding Company and the Bank file separate federal tax return.
The Bank has not had its income tax returns examined by the IRS or the State
of Arkansas within the last three years. The Bank has not been audited by the
IRS or the Arkansas State Revenue Department in recent years.
ARKANSAS TAXATION
The State of Arkansas generally imposes income tax on thrift institutions
computed at a rate of 6.5% of net earnings. For the purpose of the 6.5%
income tax, net earnings are defined as the net income of the thrift
institution computed in the manner prescribed for computing the net taxable
income for federal corporate income tax purposes, less (i) interest income
from obligations of the United States, of any county, municipal or public
corporation authority, special district or political subdivision of Arkansas,
plus (ii) any deduction for state income taxes.
The Company will be required to file an Arkansas income tax return
because it will be doing business in Arkansas. For Arkansas tax purposes,
regular corporations are presently taxed at a rate equal to 6.5% of taxable
income. For this purpose, "taxable income" generally means Federal taxable
income subject to certain adjustments (including addition of interest income
on state and municipal obligation).
DELAWARE TAXATION
As a Delaware holding company not earning income in Delaware, the Company
is exempt from Delaware corporate income tax but is required to file an
annual report with and pay an annual franchise tax to the State of Delaware.
MANAGEMENT OF THE COMPANY
The Board of Directors of the Company consists of those persons who
currently serve as Directors of the Bank. The Board of Directors is divided
into three classes, each of which contains approximately one-third of the
Board. The directors shall be elected by the stockholders of the Company for
staggered three year terms, or until their successors are elected and
qualified. One class of directors, consisting of directors Martin, Ervin and
Campbell have terms of office expiring in 1998; a second class, consisting of
directors Rainwater and Edington have terms of office expiring in 1999; and a
third class, consisting of directors Baltz and Van Camp have terms of office
expiring in 2000. Their names and biographical information are set forth
under "Management of the Bank--Directors."
The following individuals hold positions as executive officers of the
Company as is set forth below opposite their names.
NAME POSITION WITH THE COMPANY
- --------------------------------------- ----------------------------------
Skip Martin Director, President and Chief
Executive Officer
James A. Edington Executive Vice President and
Director
Dwayne Powell Chief Financial Officer
74
<PAGE>
The executive officers of the Company are elected annually and hold
office until their respective successors have been elected and qualified or
until death, resignation or removal by the Board of Directors.
Since the formation of the Company, none of the executive officers,
directors or other personnel has received remuneration from the Company.
Information concerning the principal occupations, employment and compensation
of the directors and officers of the Company during the past five years is
set forth under "Management of the Bank."
MANAGEMENT OF THE BANK
DIRECTORS
The Bank's Board of Directors is composed of seven members. Directors of
the Bank are generally elected to serve for a three year period or until
their respective successors shall have been elected and shall qualify. The
following table sets forth certain information regarding the composition of
the Bank's Board of Directors as of September 30, 1997, including the terms
of office of Board members.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
SHARES OF
COMMON STOCK
POSITIONS BENEFICIALLY
HELD IN THE SERVED CURRENT TERM OWNED ON PERCENT
NAME (1) AGE BANK SINCE (2) TO EXPIRE RECORD DATE (3) OF CLASS
- ---------------- --- ------------------------- --------- ------------ --------------- --------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Ralph P. Baltz 49 Chairman 1986 2000 26,183 1.6%
Skip Martin 48 President, Chief 1988 1998 32,537 2.0%
Executive Officer and
Director
Robert Rainwater 62 Director 1981 1999 6,158 *
N. Ray Campell 47 Director 1992 1998 7,039 *
Charles R. Ervin 60 Director 1988 1998 11,265 *
James A. Edington 47 Executive Vice 1994 1999 21,494 1.3%
President and
Director
Marcus Van Camp 49 Director 1990 2000 5,283 *
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
* Less than 1%
(1) The mailing address for each person listed is 203 West Broadway,
Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455. Each of the persons listed is also a director
of Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company, Inc., which owns the
majority of the Bank's issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock.
(2) Reflects initial appointment to the Board of Directors of the Bank's
mutual predecessor.
(3) See definition of "beneficial ownership" in the table "Beneficial
Ownership of Common Stock."
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS WHO ARE NOT DIRECTORS
The following table sets forth information regarding the executive
officer of the Bank who is not also a director.
75
<PAGE>
POSITION
HELD IN THE
NAME AGE BANK
- ---------------------------- --- -----------------------
Dwayne Powell 33 Chief Financial Officer
SKIP MARTIN has been the President and Chief Executive Officer of the
Bank since 1990, and a member of the Board of Directors of the Bank since
1988. Prior to his appointment as President and Chief Executive Officer, Mr.
Martin served as Vice President of the Bank. Mr. Martin has been employed by
the Bank since 1972 and has been an officer of the Bank since 1978.
RALPH P. BALTZ has been Chairman of the Board since January 1997. Mr.
Baltz is a general contractor and residential developer and is the President
and owner/operator of Tri-County Sand and Gravel, Inc.
MARCUS VAN CAMP is the Superintendent of Schools at Pocahontas Public
Schools, and has been employed by such schools for 25 years.
JAMES A. EDINGTON has been Executive Vice President of the Bank since
1991. In this position, Mr. Edington serves as the Bank's compliance officer,
security officer, secretary and treasurer. Mr. Edington serves a similar role
with the Mutual Holding Company. Mr. Edington has been employed in executive
roles with the Bank since 1983.
CHARLES R. ERVIN is retired. Prior to his retirement, Mr. Ervin was
President and owner of C.E.C., Inc., a construction company, since March
1992. Prior to that, Mr. Ervin was President and part-owner of M.T.C., Inc.,
a general contractor specializing in tenant construction in shopping centers
nationally.
N. RAY CAMPBELL is the Plant Manager at Waterloo Industries Incorporated,
an industrial firm located in Pocahontas, Arkansas.
ROBERT RAINWATER is semi-retired. Prior to his retirement, Mr. Rainwater
was the owner of Sexton Pharmacy in Walnut Ridge, Arkansas.
DWAYNE POWELL, CPA, has served as Chief Financial Officer of the Bank
since October 1996. Prior to that Mr. Powell was an Audit Manager for
Deloitte & Touche LLP, primarily serving financial institution clients.
MEETINGS AND COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
The business of the Bank's Board of Directors is conducted through
meetings and activities of the Board and its committees. During the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1997, the Board of Directors held 12 regular and two
special meetings. During the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, no
director attended fewer than 75 percent of the total meetings of the Board of
Directors of the Bank and committees on which such director served.
The Asset/Liability Management Committee consists of the entire Board of
Directors and meets at least quarterly to oversee interest rate risk and
asset classification. The Asset/Liability Management Committee met five times
during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
The Audit Committee of the Bank consists of all the outside Board of
Directors. The Audit Committee met three times during the fiscal year ended
September 30, 1997. The Audit Committee normally meets on a quarterly basis
and serves as a liaison between the Board, the Bank's independent auditors,
federal regulators and management.
The Loan Committee of the Bank consists of all the Board of Directors,
Chief Financial Officer Dwayne Powell, Vice President Robert Sorg and Senior
Vice President Bill Stacy, and meets as necessary to approve loans
76
<PAGE>
over a pre-established dollar limit. The Loan Committee must have at least
two outside board members to have a quorum. The Loan Committee met nineteen
times during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
The Finance/Budget Committee consists of directors Ralph P. Baltz, N. Ray
Campbell, Robert Rainwater, James A. Edington, Skip Martin and Chief
Financial Officer Dwayne Powell. The Finance Committee reviews management's
implementation of the Bank's investment policy. The Finance Committee met one
time during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
The Nominating Committee consists of directors Robert Rainwater, Marc Van
Camp and James A. Edington, and meets annually to present officer and
director candidates to the Bank. The Nominating Committee met once during the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
The Proxy Committee consists of all the Board of Directors and meets as
needed at the request of the Chairman of the Board. The Proxy Committee met
once during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
The Executive Compensation Committee consists of directors Ralph P.
Baltz, N. Ray Campbell, Marc Van Camp and Robert Rainwater, and meets
annually to set the compensation levels of executive officers. The committee
met once for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
The Dividend Committee consists of the entire Board of Directors. The
Dividend Committee meets at least quarterly to recommend the amount and type
of dividend to be paid by the Bank. The Dividend Committee met seven times
during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
The following table sets forth for the fiscal years ended September 30,
1997, 1996, and 1995, certain information as to the total remuneration paid by
the Bank to the Chief Executive Officer of the Bank and all other executive
officers earning in excess of $100,000.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
ANNUAL COMPENSATION
-----------------------------------
NAME AND YEAR OTHER
PRINCIPAL ENDED SALARY ANNUAL
POSITION SEPTEMBER 30, (1) BONUS COMPENSATION
- ------------------------------------------------------------------- ----------------- --------- --------- -------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Skip Martin,....................................................... 1997 $ 166,100 $ 10,200 --
President and Chief Executive Officer 1996 141,100 9,900 --
1995 138,100 11,100 --
James A. Edington,................................................. 1997 $ 140,000 $ 9,700 --
Executive Vice President 1996 95,000 9,700 --
1995 89,883 10,900 --
Dwayne Powell,.....................................................
Chief Financial Office (4) 1997 $ 100,000 -- --
<CAPTION>
LONG-TERM COMPENSATION
-----------------------------------
AWARDS PAYOUTS
------------------------ --------- ALL
NAME AND RESTRICTED OPTIONS/ OTHER
PRINCIPAL STOCK SARS LTIP COMPENSATION
POSITION AWARDS(3) (#) PAYOUTS (2)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------- --------- -------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Skip Martin,....................................................... $ -- -- $ -- $ 18,957
President and Chief Executive Officer -- -- -- 20,551
-- -- -- 21,507
James A. Edington,................................................. $ -- -- $ -- $ 19,778
Executive Vice President -- -- -- 13,071
-- -- -- 13,845
Dwayne Powell,.....................................................
Chief Financial Office (4) $ 53,047 -- $ -- 88
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes Board of Director and committee fees.
(2) Consists of payments made pursuant to the Bank's Profit Sharing Plan. See
"Benefits--Profit Sharing Plan." Also includes the Bank's contributions or
allocations (but not earnings) pursuant to the Bank's Employee Stock
Ownership Plan. Does not include benefits pursuant to the Bank's Pension
Plan. See "Benefits." The Bank also provides its Chief Executive Officer
with use of a Bank-owned automobile, the value of which use did not exceed
the lesser of $50,000 or 10% of such officer's cash compensation.
77
<PAGE>
(3) Represents awards made pursuant to the Bank's Recognition and Retention Plan
for Employees, which awards vest in five equal annual installments
commencing on March 31, 1995. Dividends on such shares accrue and are paid
to the recipient when the shares vest. The value of such shares was
determined by multiplying the number of shares awarded by the price at which
the shares of common stock were sold in the Bank's initial public offering
on such date. At September 30, 1997, Mr. Martin held 2,990, Mr. Edington
held 1,994, and Mr. Powell held 1,564 shares, respectively, of common stock
that remained subject to restrictions under the Plan. The fair market value
of such restricted stock on September 30, 1997 (based on the price of the
last sale reported on NASDAQ on such date) was $98,670, $65,802 and $51,612,
respectively.
(4) Mr. Powell was not employed by the Bank in fiscal year 1996 or 1995.
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS. The Bank has entered into employment agreements with
Skip Martin, its President and Chief Executive Officer, James A. Edington, its
Executive Vice President and Dwayne Powell, its Chief Financial Officer. Each
employment agreement provides for a term of three years. Commencing on the first
anniversary date and continuing each anniversary date thereafter, the Board of
Directors may extend each agreement for an additional year such that the
remaining terms shall be up to three years unless written notice of nonrenewal
is given by the Board of Directors after conducting a performance evaluation.
The agreements provide that the base salary of the executive will be reviewed
annually. In addition to the base salary, the agreements provide that the
executive is to receive all benefits provided to permanent full time employees
of the Bank, including among other things, disability pay, participation in
stock benefit plans and other fringe benefits applicable to executive personnel.
Each agreement permits the Bank to terminate the executive's employment for
cause at any time. In the event the Bank chooses to terminate the executive's
employment for reasons other than for cause, or upon the termination of
executive's employment for reasons other than a change in control, as defined,
or in the event of the executive's resignation from the Bank upon (i) failure to
be reelected to his current office, (ii) a material change in his functions,
duties or responsibilities, (iii) relocation of his principal place of
employment, (iv) the liquidation or dissolution of the Bank or the Holding
Company, or (v) a breach of the agreement by the Bank, the executive, or in the
event of death, his beneficiaries, would be entitled to receive an amount equal
to the greater of the remaining payments, including base salary, bonuses and
other payments due under the remaining term of the agreement or three times the
average of the executive's base salary, including bonuses and other cash
compensation paid, and the amount of any benefits received pursuant to any
employee benefit plans maintained by the Bank.
If termination, voluntary or involuntary, follows a change in control of the
Bank, as defined in the agreement, the executive or, in the event of his death,
his beneficiaries, would be entitled to a payment equal to the greater of (i)
the payments due under the remaining term of the agreement or (ii) 2.99 times
his average annual compensation over the five years preceding termination. The
Bank would also continue the executive's life, health, and disability coverage
for the remaining unexpired term of the agreement to the extent allowed by the
plan or policies maintained by the Bank from time to time. The Bank would also
continue the executive's life, health, and disability coverage for the remaining
unexpired term of the agreement to the extent allowed by the plans or policies
maintained by the Bank from time to time.
Each employment agreement provides that for a period of one year following
termination, the executive agrees not to compete with the Bank in any city, town
or county in which the Bank maintains an office or has filed an application to
establish an office.
DIRECTORS' COMPENSATION
Members of the Board of Directors of the Bank each received fees of $1,250
per month during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997. In addition, the
Chairman of the Board received an additional $625 per month during the fiscal
year ended September 30, 1997. No additional compensation or fees are received
for serving as directors of the Bank.
1994 STOCK OPTION PLAN FOR OUTSIDE DIRECTORS. The Bank adopted the 1994
Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors of the Bank (the "1994 Directors' Plan")
in April 1994, and such plan was subsequently approved by the Bank's
stockholders. At that time, non-statutory stock options to purchase 20,643
shares were granted to the outside
78
<PAGE>
directors of the Bank. The 1994 Directors' Plan reserved 4,274 shares of Bank
Common Stock for future grant. Any person who becomes a non-employee director
subsequent to the effective date of the 1994 Directors' Plan is entitled to
receive options for 1,424 shares of Bank Common Stock to the extent options
are available. Options granted in 1994 vest ratably at 20% per year
commencing on the first September 30th after the effective date of the 1994
Directors' Plan. The exercise price of the options will be equal to the fair
market value of the shares of Bank Common Stock underlying such option at the
time the option is granted, or $10.00 per share of Bank Common Stock for
options granted in conjunction with the Bank's stock offering. All options
granted under the 1994 Directors' Plan may be exercised from time to time in
whole or in part, and expire upon the earlier of ten years following the date
of grant or three years following the date the optionee ceases to be a
director. No options were granted under the 1994 Directors' Plan during the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997. In fiscal 1997, Ralph P. Baltz, Charles
Ervin and W.W. Scott, a former director, exercised 3,559, 3,559 and 712
options respectively, under the 1994 Directors' Plan. To the extent not
exercised by the Effective Date, the options to purchase Bank Common Stock
will be converted into and become options to purchase Common Stock. The
number of shares of Common Stock to be received upon exercise of such options
will be determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio. The aggregate exercise
price, duration and vesting schedule of such options will not be affected.
1994 RECOGNITION AND RETENTION PLAN FOR OUTSIDE DIRECTORS. In April 1994,
the Bank adopted the 1994 Recognition and Retention Plan for Outside Directors
("1994 Directors' Recognition Plan"), which was subsequently approved by the
Bank's stockholders. Awards under the 1994 Directors' Recognition Plan have been
granted in the form of shares of Bank Common Stock that were restricted by the
terms of the 1994 Directors' Recognition Plan ("Restricted Stock"). During 1994,
each outside director of the Bank was awarded 1,238 shares of Bank Common Stock
under the 1994 Directors' Recognition Plan, which vest in five equal
installments commencing September 30, 1994. In September 1997, directors Baltz,
Rainwater, Campbell, Ervin, and Van Camp each vested in 248 shares of Bank
Common Stock, and will vest in the remaining awards in one final installment on
September 30, 1998. Awards also become fully vested upon a director's
disability, death, retirement or following termination of service in connection
with a change in control of the Bank or the Mutual Holding Company. Unvested
shares are forfeited by a director upon failure to seek reelection, failure to
be reelected, or resignation from the Board. Prior to vesting, recipients of
awards under the 1994 Directors' Recognition Plan will receive the cash and
stock dividends paid with respect to the restricted stock and may vote the
shares of restricted stock allocated to them. On the Effective Date, unvested
shares of Restricted Stock will be converted into shares of Common Stock
pursuant to the Exchange Ratio and will be restricted on the same terms as the
Restricted Stock.
DIRECTOR PLAN. The Bank maintains a non-tax qualified Director Plan that
provides directors who serve on the Board of Directors until the age of 60 or,
in some cases, 65, with an annual benefit equal to a predetermined amount
ranging between $29,316 and $35,640 following the directors' termination of
service due to retirement, death, or after a change in control. Benefits are
payable monthly to the director, or in the case of his death, to his
beneficiary, over a period of twenty years. The Director Plan provides for a
$15,000 "burial benefit," which is designated for the payment of burial and/or
funeral expenses. In the event of a director's disability, the director will be
entitled to a disability benefit equal to the annuitized present value of his
accrued benefit payable monthly for twenty years. In addition, upon the
director's death following disability, the director's beneficiary will receive a
lump sum benefit equal to up to $600,000, reduced by all prior contributions
made to the Director Plan on behalf of the director.
The Bank and the Director Plan participants have each established an
irrevocable trust in connection with the Director Plan. These trusts will be
funded with contributions from the Bank for the purpose of providing the
benefits promised under the terms of the Director Plan. The assets of the trusts
established by the participants will be beneficially owned by the Director Plan
participants, who will recognize income as contributions are made to the trust.
Earnings on the trusts' assets are taxable to the participants. The trustee of
the trusts may invest the trusts' assets in the Company Common Stock and may
purchase life insurance on the lives of the participants with assets of the
trusts.
DIRECTOR EMERITUS PLAN. The Bank currently has two former directors who
have been appointed "Director Emeritus". Upon reaching age 70 with 10 years of
79
<PAGE>
continuous service as a director, each current Director Emeritus was, upon
retirement from the Board of Directors, appointed a "Director Emeritus" in
exchange for performing consulting services for the Board of Directors. Under
the current plan, in consideration of his services, a Director Emeritus will
receive an annual fee of $18,000 for a ten year period (the "benefit period")
following the director's designation as a Director Emeritus. The Director
Emeritus Plan provides for survivor benefits payable to a designated beneficiary
in an amount equal to the annual fee for the remainder of the ten year period,
plus a $10,000 "burial benefit," which is designated for the payment of burial
and/or funeral expenses.
BENEFITS FOR EMPLOYEES AND OFFICERS
1994 INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION PLAN. The Bank adopted the 1994 Incentive Stock
Option Plan (the "Incentive Option Plan") for officers and employees of the Bank
and its affiliates in April 1994, and such plan was subsequently approved by the
Bank's stockholders. The Incentive Option Plan is administered by a committee of
outside directors. The Incentive Option Plan authorizes the grant of incentive
stock options within the meaning of Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986 (the "Code"), "non-statutory options," which do not qualify as incentive
stock options, and certain "limited rights" exercisable only upon a change in
control of the Bank or the Mutual Holding Company.
Incentive stock options (with limited rights) for 49,833 shares of Bank
Common Stock were granted to employees and officers contemporaneously with the
completion of the Bank's stock offering in April 1994 at an exercise price of
$10.00. No options were granted or exercised under the Incentive Option Plan
during the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997.
At September 30, 1997, the number of shares of Bank Common Stock underlying
unexercised options granted to all participants as a group was 48,052 and the
unrealized value of such stock options was $1.1 million (based on the difference
between the strike price for such options and the price for the Bank Common
Stock underlying such options on the last sale date reported on NASDAQ on
September 30, 1997). All such options granted are exercisable at $10.00 per
share. The following tables sets forth certain information regarding the shares
acquired and the value realized during fiscal year 1997 by certain executive
officers of the Bank at September 30, 1997. To the extent not exercised by the
Effective Date, the options to purchase Bank Common Stock will be converted into
and become options to purchase Common Stock. The number of shares of Common
Stock to be received upon exercise of such options will be determined pursuant
to the Exchange Ratio. The aggregate exercise price, duration and vesting
schedule of such options will not be affected.
AGGREGATED OPTION EXERCISES IN LAST FISCAL YEAR AND FISCAL
YEAR-END OPTION VALUES
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
VALUE OF UNEXERCISED
NUMBER OF UNEXERCISED IN-
SHARES OPTIONS AT THE-MONEY OPTIONS AT
ACQUIRED FISCAL YEAR-END FISCAL YEAR-END
UPON VALUE ----------------------- -----------------------
NAME EXERCISE REALIZED EXERCISABLE/UNEXERCISABLE EXERCISABLE/UNEXERCISABLE
- ------------------------------------------ ----------- ----------- ----------------------- -----------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Skip Martin............................... -- -- 14,950/9,966 $ 343,850/$229,218
James A. Edington......................... -- -- 7,475/4,983 $ 171,925/$114,609
</TABLE>
RECOGNITION AND RETENTION PLAN. In April 1994, the Bank established the
Recognition and Retention Plan for Employees (the "Employees' RRP") as a method
of providing officers, and key employees with a proprietary interest in the Bank
in a manner designed to encourage such persons to remain with the Bank. At
the time of implementation of this plan, 29,900 shares of Bank Common Stock
were awarded to officers and key employees of the Bank.
80
<PAGE>
A Committee of the Board of Directors of the Bank composed of all of the
outside directors of the Bank administers the Employees' RRP. Awards have been
granted in the form of shares of Bank Common Stock that were restricted by the
terms of the Employees' RRP ("Restricted Stock"). Restricted Stock is
nontransferable and nonassignable. Participants in the Employees' RRP become
vested in shares of Bank Common Stock covered by an award, and all restrictions
lapse, at a rate of 20% per year commencing on March 31, 1995. Awards to
officers and employees become fully vested (i.e., all restrictions lapse) upon
termination of employment due to normal retirement, death, or disability or
following a termination of employment in connection with a change in control of
the Bank or the Mutual Holding Company. Upon termination of employment for any
other reason, unvested shares of Restricted Stock are forfeited. The holders of
Restricted Stock will have the right to vote such shares during the restricted
period and will receive the cash and stock dividends with respect to restricted
stock when declared and paid. The holders may not sell, assign, transfer, pledge
or otherwise encumber any of the Restricted Stock during the restricted period.
On the Effective Date, unvested shares of Restricted Stock will be converted
into shares of Common Stock pursuant to the Exchange Ratio and will be
restricted on the same terms as the Restricted Stock.
401(K) SAVINGS AND EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN. The Bank merged its
Employee Stock Ownership Plan ("ESOP") and Profit Sharing Plan to form the
401(k) Savings and Employee Stock Ownership Plan (the "KSOP"), effective October
1, 1997, to enable participants to invest in Bank Common Stock with the pre-tax
deferral of their salary ("Elective Deferrals"). The KSOP is a tax-qualified
plan subject to the requirements of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act
of 1974 ("ERISA") and the Code. Employees with a year of service with the Bank
during which they worked at least 1,000 hours and who have attained age 21 are
eligible to participate in any ESOP, matching or discretionary contributions
under the plan. Any employee with one hour of service may participate in making
any Elective Deferrals.
The ESOP portion of the KSOP provides the plan with the ability to borrow
money for the purpose of purchasing Bank Common Stock. As part of the Offering,
the ESOP portion of the KSOP intends to borrow funds from the Company and use
those funds to purchase a number of shares equal to 8% of the Common Stock to be
issued in the Offering. Collateral for the loan will be the Common Stock
purchased by the KSOP. The loan will be repaid principally from the Bank's
contributions to the KSOP. Shares purchased with the ESOP loan will be held in a
suspense account for allocation among participants as the loan is repaid. As the
ESOP loan is repaid from contributions the Bank makes to the ESOP portion of the
KSOP, shares will be released from the suspense account in an amount
proportional to the repayment of the KSOP loan. The released shares will be
allocated among the ESOP accounts of participants who have a 1000 hours of
service for the current plan year and are employed on the last day of the plan
year, on the basis of compensation in the year of allocation, up to an annual
adjusted maximum level of compensation. On the Effective Date, the Bank Common
Stock held by the KSOP will be exchanged for shares of Common Stock, pursuant to
the Exchange Ratio.
Participants may elect to defer up to 15% of their salary into the KSOP
("Elective Deferrals") . The Bank may, in its discretion, make discretionary
("Discretionary Contributions") and/or matching contributions ("Matching
Contributions") to the KSOP. Benefits in the ESOP, Discretionary Contributions
and Matching Contributions generally will become 100% vested after five years of
credited service. Employees are 100% vested in the Elective Deferral accounts
and rollover accounts at all times under the plan. Participants will be credited
for years of service with the Bank prior to the effective date of the plan.
Forfeitures of Matching and Discretionary Contributions will be used to reduce
such contributions in succeeding plan years; forfeitures of ESOP Contributions
are reallocated among remaining participating employees in the same proportion
as contributions. Benefits may be payable upon death, retirement, early
retirement, disability, or separation from service in a lump sum or, at the
election of the participant, in installments not to exceed five years. The
Bank's contributions to the KSOP are discretionary, subject to the ESOP loan
terms and tax law limits, so benefits payable under the KSOP cannot be
estimated.
The KSOP provides for loans to employees not to exceed 50% of their
vested Discretionary Contribution, Elective Deferral, Matching Contribution
or Rollover Account balances, or $50,000. Withdrawals are permitted only to
the extent of hardship (e.g., medical expenses),
81
<PAGE>
to purchase a primary residence, for limited education expenses or any other
condition or event as determined by the Commissioner of the Internal Revenue
Service from the vested portion or the Discretionary Contribution, Elective
Deferral, Matching Contribution or Rollover Accounts.
A committee is appointed by the Board of Directors of the Bank to administer
the KSOP (the "KSOP Committee"). The KSOP Committee instructs the trustee
regarding investment of funds contributed to the KSOP. The KSOP trustee is
required to vote all allocated shares held in the KSOP in accordance with the
instructions of the participants; unallocated shares shall be voted in a manner
calculated to reflect most accurately the instructions the KSOP trustee has
received from participants regarding the allocated stock. If no shares have been
allocated, KSOP participants will be deemed to have one share of stock allocated
to his account for the sole purpose of providing the trustee with voting
instructions. Under ERISA, the Secretary of Labor is authorized to bring an
action against the KSOP trustee for the failure of the KSOP trustee to comply
with its fiduciary responsibilities. Such a suit could seek to enjoin the KSOP
trustee from violating its fiduciary responsibilities and could result in the
imposition of civil penalties or criminal penalties if the breach is found to be
willful.
SUPPLEMENTAL RETIREMENT PLAN. In November 1993, management of the Bank
approved a supplemental retirement plan (the "Retirement Plan") for the Bank's
former Chairman of the Board, Mr. Joe R. Martin, who retired in January 1996.
The plan provides for an annual payment of $75,000 per year for ten years. The
payment will be made to Mr. Martin's spouse in the event of his death during
such ten-year period. In fiscal 1997, the Board approved an additional $75,000
and a one year extension of the Retirement Plan.
SUPPLEMENTAL EXECUTIVE RETIREMENT PLAN. The Bank has implemented a
non-qualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan ("SERP") to provide a
select group of management and highly compensated employees with additional
benefits following termination of employment due to retirement, death, after a
change in control or involuntary termination. The contribution made to the SERP
is intended to provide an actuarially determined annual benefit of $182,143 for
Skip Martin, $147,143 for James A. Edington, and $214,286 for Dwayne Powell,
payable monthly for 20 years. In the event of the employee's disability, the
employee will be entitled to a disability benefit equal to the annuitized
present value of his accrued benefit payable monthly for twenty years. In
addition, upon the employee's death following disability, the director's
beneficiary will receive a lump sum death benefit equal to $3 million, $2.7
million and $2.6 million in the case of Messrs. Martin, Edington, and Powell,
respectively, reduced by all prior contributions made to the SERP on behalf of
the participant. The SERPs also provide for a $15,000 "burial benefit," which is
designated for the payment of burial and/or funeral expenses.
The Bank and the SERP participants have each established an irrevocable
trust in connection with each SERP. These trust will be funded with
contributions from the Bank for the purpose of providing the benefits promised
under the terms of the SERP. The assets of the trust will be beneficially owned
by the SERP participants, who will recognize income as contributions are made to
the trust. Earnings on the trust's assets are taxable to the participants. The
trustee of the trust may invest the trust's assets in the Company Common Stock
and may purchase life insurance on the life of the participant with assets of
the trust.
1998 STOCK OPTION PLAN. At a meeting of the Company's stockholders to be
held at least six months after the completion of the Offering, the Board of
Directors intends to submit for stockholder approval the 1998 Stock Option
Plan for directors and officers of the Bank and of the Company. If approved
by the stockholders, Common Stock in an aggregate amount equal to 10% of the
shares issued in the Offering would be reserved for issuance by the Company
upon the exercise of the stock options granted under the 1998 Stock Option
Plan. Ten percent of the shares issued in the Offering would amount to
212,500 shares, 250,000 shares, 287,500 shares or 330,625 shares at the
minimum, midpoint, maximum and adjusted maximum of the Offering Range,
respectively. No options would be granted under the 1998 Stock Option Plan
until the date on which stockholder approval is received.
The exercise price of the options granted under the 1998 Stock Option
Plan will be equal to the fair market value of the shares on the date of
grant of the stock options. If the 1998 Stock Option Plan is adopted within
one year following the Offering, options will become exercisable at a rate of
20% at the end of each twelve months of service with the Bank after the date
of grant, subject to early vesting in the event of death or disability.
Options granted under the 1998 Stock Option Plan would be adjusted for
capital changes such as stock splits and stock dividends. Notwithstanding the
foregoing, awards will be 100% vested upon termination of employment due to
death or
82
<PAGE>
disability, and if the 1998 Stock Option Plan is adopted more than 12 months
after the Offering, awards would be 100% vested upon normal retirement or a
change in control of the Bank or the Company. Under OTS rules, if the 1998
Stock Option Plan is adopted within the first 12 months after the Offering,
no individual officer can receive more than 25% of the awards under the plan,
no outside director can receive more than 5% of the awards under the plan,
and all outside directors as a group can receive no more than 30% of the
awards under the plan in the aggregate.
The 1998 Stock Option Plan would be administered by a Committee of
non-employee members of the Company's Board of Directors. Options granted under
the 1998 Stock Option Plan to employees could be "incentive" stock options
designed to result in a beneficial tax treatment to the employee but no tax
deduction to the Company. Non-qualified stock options could also be granted
under the 1998 Stock Option Plan, and will be granted to the non-employee
directors who receive grants of stock options. In the event an option recipient
terminated his employment or service as an employee or director, the options
would terminate during certain specified periods.
1998 RECOGNITION PLAN. At a meeting of the Company's stockholders to be
held at least six months after the completion of the Offering, the Board of
Directors also intends to submit a Recognition and Retention Plan (the "1998
Recognition Plan") for stockholder approval. The 1998 Recognition Plan will
provide the Bank's directors and officers an ownership interest in the Company
in a manner designed to encourage them to continue their service with the Bank.
The Bank will contribute funds to the1998 Recognition Plan from time to time to
enable it to acquire an aggregate amount of Common Stock equal to up to 4% of
the shares of Common Stock issued in the Offering, either directly from the
Company or in open market purchases. Four percent of the shares issued in the
Offering would amount to 85,000 shares, 100,000 shares, 115,000 or 132,250
shares at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and adjusted maximum of the Offering
Range, respectively. In the event that additional authorized but unissued shares
would be acquired by the 1998 Recognition Plan after the Offering, the interests
of existing shareholders would be diluted. The executive officers and directors
will be awarded Common Stock under the 1998 Recognition Plan without having to
pay cash for the shares. No awards under the 1998 Recognition Plan would be made
until the date the 1998 Recognition Plan is approved by the Company's
stockholders.
Awards under the 1998 Recognition Plan would be nontransferable and
nonassignable, and during the lifetime of the recipient could only be earned by
him. If the 1998 Recognition Plan is adopted within one year following the
Offering, the shares which are subject to an award would vest and be earned by
the recipient at a rate of 20% of the shares awarded at the end of each full 12
months of service with the Bank after the date of grant of the award. Awards
would be adjusted for capital changes such as stock dividends and stock splits.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, awards would be 100% vested upon termination of
employment or service due to death or disability, and if the 1998 Recognition
Plan is adopted more than 12 months after the Offering, awards would be 100%
vested upon normal retirement or a change in control of the Bank or the Company.
If employment or service were to terminate for other reasons, the award
recipient would forfeit any nonvested award. If employment or service is
terminated for cause (as would be defined in the 1998 Recognition Plan), shares
not already delivered under the 1998 Recognition Plan would be forfeited. Under
OTS rules, if the 1998 Recognition Plan is adopted within the first 12 months
after the Offering, no individual officer can receive more than 25% of the
awards under the plan, no outside director can receive more than 5% of the
awards under the plan, and all outside director as a group can receive no more
than 30% of the awards under the plan in the aggregate.
When shares become vested under the 1998 Recognition Plan, the participant
will recognize income equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock earned,
determined as of the date of vesting, unless the recipient makes an election
under Section 83(b) of the Code to be taxed earlier. The amount of income
recognized by the participant would be a deductible expense for tax purposes for
the Company. If the 1998 Recognition Plan is adopted within one year following
the Offering, dividends and other earnings will accrue and be payable to the
award recipient when the shares vest. If the 1998 Recognition Plan is adopted
within one year following the Offering, shares not yet vested under the 1998
Recognition Plan will be voted by the trustee of the 1998 Recognition Plan,
taking into account the best interests of the recipients of the 1998 Recognition
Plan awards. If the 1998 Recognition Plan is adopted more than one year
following the Offering, dividends declared on unvested shares will be
distributed to the participant when paid, and the participant will be entitled
to vote the unvested shares.
TRANSACTIONS WITH CERTAIN RELATED PERSONS
83
<PAGE>
The Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery and Enforcement Act of 1989
("FIRREA") requires that all loans or extensions of credit to executive officers
and directors must be made on substantially the same terms, including interest
rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable
transactions with the general public and must not involve more than the normal
risk of repayment or present other unfavorable features. In addition, loans made
to a director or executive officer in excess of the greater of $25,000 or 5% of
the Bank's capital and surplus (up to a maximum of $100,000 for executive
officers, not including loans on primary residences) must be approved in advance
by a majority of the disinterested members of the Board of Directors. Loans made
to officers, directors, and executive officers are made by the Bank in the
ordinary course of business on the same terms and conditions as the Bank would
make to any other customer in the ordinary course of business and do not involve
more than a normal risk of collectibility or present other unfavorable features.
The Bank intends that all transactions between the Bank and its executive
officers, directors, holders of 10% or more of the shares of any class of its
common stock and affiliates thereof, will contain terms no less favorable to the
Bank than could have been obtained by it in arm's-length negotiations with
unaffiliated persons and will be approved by a majority of independent outside
directors of the Bank not having any interest in the transaction. At September
30, 1997, the Bank had loans with an aggregate balance of $876,138 outstanding
to its executive officers and directors.
Set forth below is certain information as to loans made by the Bank to each
of its directors and executive officers whose aggregate indebtedness to the Bank
exceeded $60,000 at any time since October 1, 1996.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
HIGHEST
BALANCE INTEREST RATE
ORIGINAL OUTSTANDING BALANCE AS OF ON
NAME OF OFFICER OR DATE LOAN DURING SEPTEMBER 30, SEPTEMBER 30,
DIRECTOR LOAN TYPE ORIGINATED AMOUNT FISCAL 1997 1997 1997
- --------------------------------------------- ----------- ----------- --------- ----------- ------------- ---------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Ralph P. Baltz Mortgage 3/31/97 $ 76,000 $ 76,000 $ 75,728 7.75%
Mortgage 3/31/97 $ 61,600 $ 61,600 $ 61,380 7.75%
Charles R. Ervin Mortgage 3/10/94 $ 99,450 $ 78,481 $ 76,359 8.17%
N. Ray Campell Mortgage 9/12/94 $ 88,000 $ 82,972 $ 79,015 8.06%
Skip Martin Mortgage 6/14/96 $ 124,500 $ 130,744 $ 128,956 7.75%
James Edington Mortgage 1/5/96 $ 148,500 $ 147,788 $ 146,489 8.00%
Mortgage 10/27/95 $ 100,000 $ 97,098 $ 92,651 8.50%
Dwayne Powell Mortgage 10/4/96 $ 75,650 $ 75,650 $ 74,947 7.75%
</TABLE>
BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP OF COMMON STOCK
BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP OF BANK COMMON STOCK
The following table includes, as of December 15, 1997, certain information
as to the Bank Common Stock beneficially owned by (i) the only persons or
entities, including any "group" as that term issued in Section 13(d)(3) of the
Exchange Act, who or which was known to the Bank to be the beneficial owner of
more than 5% of the issued and outstanding Bank Common Stock, and (ii) all
directors and executive officer of the Bank as a group. For information
concerning proposed subscriptions by directors and executive officers and the
anticipated ownership of Common Stock by such persons upon consummation of the
Conversion, see "--Subscriptions by Executive Officers and Directors."
84
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
AMOUNT OF SHARES
OWNED AND NATURE PERCENT OF SHARES
NAME AND ADDRESS OF OF BENEFICIAL OF COMMON STOCK
BENEFICIAL OWNERS OWNERSHIP (1)(3) OUTSTANDING
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- ---------------- -------------------
<S> <C> <C>
Pocahontas Federal Mutual
Holding Company, Inc. (2) 862,500 52.8%
203 West Broadway
Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455
Harris Associates, LP 140,000 8.6%
2 North LaSalle Street
Suite 500
Chicago, Illinois 60602
All Directors and Executive Officers 112,877 6.8%
as a Group (8 persons)
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
* Less than 1%
(1) Based upon filings made pursuant to the Exchange Act and
information furnished by the respective individuals. In accordance with Rule
13d-3 under the Exchange Act, a person is deemed to be the beneficial owner
for purposes of this table, of any shares of common stock if he has shared
voting or investment power with respect to such security, or has a right to
acquire beneficial ownership at any time within 60 days from the date as to
which beneficial ownership is being determined. As used herein, "voting
power" is the power to vote or direct the voting of shares and "investment
power" is the power to dispose or direct the disposition of shares. Includes
all shares held directly as well as by spouses and minor children, in trust
and other indirect ownership, over which shares the named individuals
effectively exercise sole or shared voting and investment power.
(2) The executive officers and directors of the Bank are also executive
officers and directors of Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
(3) Under applicable regulations, a person is deemed to have beneficial
ownership of any shares of Bank Common Stock which may be acquired within
60 days of the date as of which beneficial ownership is being determined
pursuant to the exercise of outstanding stock options. Shares of Bank
Common Stock which are subject to stock options are deemed to be
outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage of outstanding
Bank Common Stock owned by such person or group but not deemed
outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage of Bank Common
Stock owned by any other person or group.
SUBSCRIPTIONS BY EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS
The following table sets forth, for each of the Company's directors and
executive officers and for all of the directors and executive officers as a
group, (i) the number of Exchange Shares to be held upon consummation of the
Conversion, based upon their beneficial ownership of the Bank Common Stock as
of October 31, 1997, (ii) the proposed purchases of Subscription Shares,
assuming sufficient shares are available to satisfy their subscriptions, and
(iii) the total amount of Common Stock to be held upon consummation of the
Conversion in each case assuming that Subscription Shares are sold at the
midpoint of the Offering Range.
85
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PROPOSED PURCHASES OF TOTAL COMMON STOCK
NUMBER OF CONVERSION STOCK (1) TO BE HELD
EXCHANGE SHARES ----------------------- ----------------------------
TO BE HELD NUMBER NUMBER PERCENTAGE
(2)(3) OF SHARES AMOUNT OF SHARES OF TOTAL
--------------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ---------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Ralph P. Baltz................................... 75,886 15,000 $ 150,000 90,886 1.9%
N. Ray Campbell.................................. 20,401 8,500 85,000 28,901 *
James A. Edington................................ 62,296 15,000 150,000 77,296 1.6
Charles R. Ervin................................. 32,649 5,000 50,000 37,649 *
Skip Martin...................................... 94,302 5,000 50,000 99,302 2.1
Dwayne Powell.................................... 8,457 10,000 100,000 18,457 *
Robert Rainwater................................. 17,848 1,000 10,000 18,848 *
Mark Van Camp.................................... 15,312 4,300 43,000 19,612 *
------- ------ ---------- -------
All Directors and Executive Officers as a Group
(8 persons).................................... 327,151 63,800 $ 638,000 390,951 8.3%
------- ------ ---------- -------
------- ------ ---------- -------
</TABLE>
- ------------------------
(1) Includes proposed subscriptions, if any, by associates. Does not include
subscription order by the KSOP. Intended purchases by the KSOP are expected
to be 8% of the shares issued in the Offering.
(2) Includes shares underlying options that may be exercised within 60 days of
the date as of which ownership is being determined, and vested shares of
restricted stock. See "--Beneficial Ownership of Bank Common Stock."
(3) Does not include stock options and awards that may be granted under the
Company's 1998 Stock Option Plan and 1998 Recognition Plan if such plans are
approved by stockholders at an annual meeting or special meeting of
shareholders at least six months following the Conversion. See "Management
of the Bank--New Benefits Plans."
*Less than 0.1%
THE CONVERSION
THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS OF THE MUTUAL HOLDING COMPANY, AND THE OTS, HAVE
APPROVED THE PLAN OF CONVERSION, SUBJECT TO APPROVAL BY THE MEMBERS OF THE
MUTUAL HOLDING COMPANY ENTITLED TO VOTE ON THE MATTER, THE STOCKHOLDERS OF
THE BANK ENTITLED TO VOTE ON THE MATTER AND THE SATISFACTION OF CERTAIN OTHER
CONDITIONS. SUCH OTS APPROVAL, HOWEVER, DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A RECOMMENDATION
OR ENDORSEMENT OF THE PLAN BY SUCH AGENCY.
GENERAL
On October 14, 1997, the Board of Directors of the Mutual Holding Company
adopted the Plan of Conversion, pursuant to which the Mutual Holding Company
will be converted from a federally chartered mutual holding company to a
Delaware stock corporation to be named "Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc." (the
Company). It is currently intended that all of the capital stock of the Bank
will be held by the Company after the Conversion. The Plan of Conversion was
approved by the OTS, subject to, among other things, approval of the Plan of
Conversion by the Mutual Holding Company's members and the stockholders of
the Bank. The Special Meeting of Members and the Special Meeting of
Stockholders have been called for this purpose.
As part of the Conversion, each of the Minority Shares shall
automatically, without further action by the holder thereof, be converted
into and become a right to receive a number of shares of Common Stock
determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio, which ensures that immediately
after the Conversion and Share Exchange, Minority Stockholders will own the
same aggregate percentage of the Company's Common Stock as they owned of the
Bank's common stock immediately prior to the Conversion. Pursuant to the Plan
of Conversion, the Conversion will be effected as follows or in any other
manner that is consistent with applicable federal law and regulations and the
intent
86
<PAGE>
of the Plan of Conversion. Except for step (i), each of the following steps
in the Conversion will be completed contemporaneously on the Effective Date.
(i) The Bank will organize the Company (which will become the stock
holding company of the Bank) as a direct subsidiary of the Bank;
(ii) The Company will organize an interim savings bank (the "Interim
Savings Bank") as a wholly owned federal stock savings bank
subsidiary of the Company;
(iii) The Mutual Holding Company will convert into an interim federal stock
savings association and simultaneously merge with and into the Bank in
the MHC Merger pursuant to the Agreement of Merger between the Mutual
Holding Company and the Bank, whereby each Eligible Account Holder
and Supplemental Eligible Account Holder will receive an interest in
the liquidation account established in the Bank pursuant to
regulations of the OTS in exchange for such member's ownership
interest in the Mutual Holding Company, and the Bank's common stock
held by the Mutual Holding Company will be canceled;
(iv) The Interim Savings Bank will merge with and into the Bank with the
Bank as the resulting institution in the Bank Merger pursuant to the
Agreement of Merger among the Bank, the Company and the Interim
Savings Bank, the Company's stock held by the Bank will be canceled,
the Interim Savings Bank stock held by the Company will become Bank
common stock by operation of law and Minority Stockholders will
receive Common Stock in the Share Exchange; and
(v) Contemporaneously with the Bank Merger, the Company will offer for
sale in the Offering Subscription Shares representing the pro forma
market value of the Company, immediately prior to the Conversion.
The Company expects to receive the approval of the OTS to become a
savings and loan holding company and to own all of the common stock of the
Bank. The Company intends to contribute at least 50% of the net proceeds of
the Offering to the Bank. The Conversion will be effected only upon
completion of the sale of all of the shares of Common Stock of the Company to
be issued pursuant to the Plan of Conversion.
The Plan of Conversion provides generally that (i) the Mutual Holding
Company will convert from a federal mutual holding company to a federal stock
savings association and simultaneously merge with and into the Bank and (ii)
the Company will offer shares of Common Stock for sale in the Subscription
Offering to Eligible Account Holders, the Bank's KSOP, Supplemental Eligible
Account Holders, Other Members and Minority Stockholders. Subject to the
prior rights of these holders of subscription rights, the Company will offer
Common Stock for sale in a concurrent Community Offering to certain members
of the general public, with a preference given to natural persons residing in
the Community. The Bank has the right to accept or reject, in whole or in
part, any orders to purchase shares of the Common Stock received in the
Community Offering. The Community Offering must be completed within 45 days
after the completion of the Subscription Offering unless otherwise extended
by the OTS. See "--Community Offering."
The number of shares of Common Stock to be issued in the Offering will be
determined based upon an independent appraisal of the estimated pro forma
market value of the Common Stock of the Company. All shares of Common Stock
to be issued and sold in the Offering will be sold at the same price. The
Independent Valuation will be updated and the final number of the shares to
be issued in the Offering will be determined at the completion of the
Offering. See "--Stock Pricing and Number of Shares to be Issued" for more
information as to the determination of the estimated pro forma market value
of the Common Stock.
THE FOLLOWING IS A BRIEF SUMMARY OF THE CONVERSION. The summary is
qualified in its entirety by reference to the provisions of the Plan of
Conversion. A copy of the Plan of Conversion is available for inspection at
each branch of the Bank and at the Midwest Regional and Washington, D.C.
offices of the OTS. The Plan of Conversion is also filed as an Exhibit to the
Application to Convert from Mutual to Stock Form of which this Prospectus is
a part, copies of which may be obtained from the OTS. See "Additional
Information."
87
<PAGE>
PURPOSES OF CONVERSION
The Board of Directors unanimously determined to conduct the Conversion
because it believed that the market for equity securities in financial
services companies was at an unprecedented level and that the Bank (together
with the Company, the "Converted Institution") could raise substantial funds
from such a transaction. The Board of Directors believed that maximizing such
proceeds is in the best interests of the Converted Institution because such
proceeds can be used to increase the net income of the Converted Institution
though investment and eventual leveraging of the proceeds, and support the
possible expansion of the Bank's existing franchise through internal growth
or the acquisition of branch offices or other financial institutions.
Management believed that acquisition opportunities would increase as a result
of the Conversion because the Converted Institution would have substantially
more capital following the Conversion. The Bank acquired three branch offices
in January 1998, and intends to actively explore additional acquisitions,
although neither the Company nor the Bank has any specific plans,
arrangements or understandings regarding any additional expansions or
acquisitions at this time, nor have criteria been established to identify
potential candidates for acquisition. In addition, the Board considered that
there was no assurance that the pricing for financial services stocks would
continue at such favorable levels, and that if the market were to become less
favorable, the amount of capital that could be raised in the Conversion might
be substantially reduced. See "Risk Factors--Potential Low Return on Equity"
and " Uncertainty as to Future Growth Opportunities."
After completion of the Conversion, the unissued common and preferred
stock authorized by the Company's Certificate of Incorporation will permit
the Company, subject to market conditions and regulatory approval of an
offering, to raise additional equity capital through further sales of
securities, and to issue securities in connection with possible acquisitions.
At the present time, the Company has no plans with respect to additional
offerings of securities, other than the issuance of additional shares upon
exercise of stock options. Following the Conversion, the Company will also be
able to use stock-related incentive programs to attract and retain executive
and other personnel for itself and its subsidiaries.
APPROVALS REQUIRED
The affirmative vote of a majority of the total eligible votes of the
members of the Mutual Holding Company at the Special Meeting of Members is
required to approve the Plan of Conversion. By their approval of the Plan of
Conversion the members of the Mutual Holding Company will also be deemed to
approve the MHC Merger and the Bank Merger. The affirmative vote of the
holders of (i) at least two-thirds of the outstanding common stock of the
Bank and (ii) a majority of the Minority Shares at the Special Meeting of
Stockholders is required to approve the Plan of Conversion. Consummation of
the Conversion is also subject to the approval of the OTS.
SHARE EXCHANGE RATIO
OTS regulations provide that in a conversion of a mutual holding company
to stock form, the minority stockholders will be entitled to exchange their
shares of subsidiary savings bank common stock for common stock of the
converted holding company, provided that the bank and the mutual holding
company demonstrate to the satisfaction of the OTS that the basis for the
exchange is fair and reasonable. The Boards of Directors of the Bank and the
Company have determined that each Minority Share will on the Effective Date
be automatically converted into and become the right to receive a number of
Exchange Shares determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio, which ensures that
after the Conversion and before giving effect to Minority Stockholders'
purchases in the Offering and receipt of cash in lieu of fractional shares,
Minority Stockholders will own the same aggregate percentage of the Company's
Common Stock as they owned of the Bank's common stock immediately prior to
the Conversion. As of October 31, 1997, there were 1,632,424 shares of the
Bank's common stock outstanding, 769,924, or 47.2%, of which were Minority
Shares. Based on the percentage of the Bank's common stock held by Minority
Stockholders and the Offering Range, the Exchange Ratio is expected to range
from approximately 2.4638 Exchange Shares for each Minority Share at the
minimum of the Offering Range to 3.8333 Exchange Shares for each Minority
Share at the adjusted maximum of the Offering Range. The Bank will pay cash
to Minority Stockholders for fractional shares.
88
<PAGE>
The following table sets forth, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum, and
adjusted maximum of the Offering Range, the following: (i) the total number
of Subscription Shares and Exchange Shares to be issued in the Conversion,
(ii) the percentage of Common Stock outstanding after the Conversion that
will be sold in the Offering and issued in the Share Exchange, and (iii) the
Exchange Ratio:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
TOTAL
SUBSCRIPTION SHARES EXCHANGE SHARES SHARES
TO BE ISSUED TO BE ISSUED OF COMMON
--------------------- --------------------- STOCK TO BE EXCHANGE
AMOUNT PERCENT AMOUNT PERCENT OUTSTANDING RATIO
---------- --------- ---------- --------- ----------- -----------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Minimum............................................. 2,125,000 52.836 1,896,914 47.164 4,021,914 2.4638
Midpoint............................................ 2,500,000 52.836 2,231,663 47.164 4,731,663 2.8983
Maximum............................................. 2,875,000 52.836 2,566,413 47.164 5,441,413 3.3333
Adjusted maximum.................................... 3,306,250 52.836 2,951,375 47.164 6,257,625 3.8333
</TABLE>
Options to purchase Minority Shares will also be converted into and
become options to purchase Common Stock. As of September 30, 1997, there were
outstanding options to purchase 48,052 Minority Shares. The number of shares
of Common Stock to be received upon exercise of such options will be
determined pursuant to the Exchange Ratio. The aggregate exercise price,
duration, and vesting schedule of such options will not be affected. As of
September 30, 1997, options to purchase 33,102 shares were vested. If all
such options to purchase Minority Shares are exercised prior to the Effective
Date, then there will be (i) an increase in the percentage of the Bank's
common stock held by Minority Stockholders to 48.2%, (ii) an increase in the
number of shares of Common Stock issued to Minority Stockholders in the Share
Exchange, (iii) a decrease in the Exchange Ratio to 2.3622, 2.7791, 3.1959,
and 3.6753 at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and adjusted maximum of the
Offering Range, and (iv) a decrease in the Offering Range. Executive officers
and directors of the Bank do not intend to exercise options prior to the
Effective Date. The Bank has no plans to grant additional stock options prior
to the Effective Date.
EFFECT OF THE CONVERSION ON MINORITY STOCKHOLDERS
EFFECT ON STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY PER SHARE OF THE SHARES EXCHANGED. The
Conversion will increase the stockholders' equity of Minority Stockholders.
At September 30, 1997, the stockholders' equity per share was $14.85 for each
share of the Bank's common stock outstanding, including shares held by the
Mutual Holding Company. Based on the pro forma information set forth in "Pro
Forma Data," assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock at the
midpoint of the Offering Range, the pro forma stockholders' equity per share
of Common Stock was $9.73, and the pro forma stockholders' equity for the
aggregate number of Exchange Shares to be received for each Minority Share
was $46.1 million. The pro forma stockholders' equity for the aggregate
number of Exchange Shares to be received for each Minority Share was $42.8
million, $49.3 million and $53.1 million at the minimum, maximum, and
adjusted maximum of the Offering Range.
EFFECT ON EARNINGS PER SHARE OF THE SHARES EXCHANGED. The Conversion
will also affect Minority Stockholders' pro forma earnings per share. For the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, the earnings per share was $1.46 for
each share of the Bank's common stock outstanding, including shares held by
the Mutual Holding Company. Based on the pro forma information set forth in
"Pro Forma Data," assuming the sale of 2,500,000 shares of Common Stock at
the midpoint of the Offering Range, the pro forma earnings per share of
Common Stock was $0.63 for such period, and the pro forma earnings for the
aggregate number of Exchange Shares to be received for each Minority Share
was $2.8 million. For the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, the pro forma
earnings for the aggregate number of Exchange Shares to be received for each
Minority Share was $2.8 million, $2.9 million and $3.0 million at the
minimum, maximum, and adjusted maximum of the Offering Range.
EFFECT ON DIVIDENDS PER SHARE. The Company's Board of Directors
anticipates declaring and paying quarterly cash dividends on the Common Stock
equal to $1.5 million, or $0.373, $0.317, $0.276 and $0.240 per share of
Common Stock on an annual basis, at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and
maximum, as adjusted, of the Offering Range, respectively. Dividends, when
and if paid, will be subject to determination and declaration by the Board of
Directors in its discretion, which will take into account the Company's
consolidated financial condition and results of operations, tax
considerations, industry standards, economic conditions, regulatory
restrictions on dividend
89
<PAGE>
payments by the Bank to the Company, general business practices and other
factors. See "Dividend Policy." Since the completion of the first full fiscal
quarter following the initial sale by the Bank of the Bank Common Stock in
April 1994, the Bank has paid average annual cash dividends on the Bank
Common Stock of $.725 per share, which amounts to a quarterly dividend of
$.181 per share. The Bank's current quarterly cash dividend is $0.225 per
share, and the Bank intends to continue to pay regular quarterly cash
dividends through the earlier of (i) the Effective Date (on a pro rated
basis), or (ii) the fiscal quarter ending March 31, 1998. See "The Bank's
Common Stock" and "Regulation and Supervision--Federal Regulation of Savings
Institutions--Limitation on Capital Distributions." The Mutual Holding
Company intends to waive the receipt of such dividend.
EFFECT ON THE MARKET AND APPRAISED VALUE OF THE SHARES EXCHANGED. The
aggregate Subscription Price of the shares of Common Stock received in
exchange for each Minority Share is $18,969,140, $22,316,630, $25,664,130,
and $29,513,750 at the minimum, midpoint, maximum and adjusted maximum of the
Offering Range. The last trade of the Bank's common stock on September 17,
1997, the day preceding the announcement of the Conversion, was $28.00 per
share, and the price at which the Bank's common stock last traded on ,
1998, was $ per share.
DISSENTERS' AND APPRAISAL RIGHTS. Under OTS regulations, Minority
Stockholders will not have dissenters' rights or appraisal rights in
connection with the exchange of Minority Shares for shares of Common Stock of
the Company.
EFFECTS OF CONVERSION ON DEPOSITORS, BORROWERS AND MEMBERS
GENERAL. Each depositor in the Bank has both a deposit account in the
Bank and a pro rata ownership interest in the net worth of the Mutual Holding
Company based upon the balance in his or her account, which interest may only
be realized in the event of a liquidation of the Mutual Holding Company and
the Bank. However, this ownership interest is tied to the depositor's account
and has no tangible market value separate from such deposit account. Any
depositor who opens a deposit account obtains a pro rata ownership interest
in the Mutual Holding Company which owns a majority of the common stock of
the Bank without any additional payment beyond the amount of the deposit. A
depositor who reduces or closes his account receives a portion or all of the
balance in the account but nothing for his ownership interest in the net
worth of the Mutual Holding Company, which is lost to the extent that the
balance in the account is reduced or closed.
Consequently, depositors in a stock subsidiary of a mutual holding
company normally have no way of realizing the value of their ownership
interest, which has realizable value only in the unlikely event that the
Mutual Holding Company and the Bank are liquidated. In such event, the
depositors of record at that time, as owners, would share pro rata in any
residual surplus and reserves of the Mutual Holding Company after other
claims, including claims of depositors to the amounts of their deposits, are
paid.
When a mutual holding company converts to stock form, permanent
nonwithdrawable capital stock is created in the stock holding company to
represent the ownership of the subsidiary institution's net worth. The Common
Stock is separate and apart from deposit accounts and cannot be and is not
insured by the FDIC or any other governmental agency. Certificates are issued
to evidence ownership of the capital stock. The stock certificates are
transferable, and therefore the stock may be sold or traded if a purchaser is
available with no effect on any account the seller may hold in the Bank.
CONTINUITY. While the Conversion is being accomplished, the normal
business of the Bank of accepting deposits and making loans will continue
without interruption. The Bank will continue to be subject to regulation by
the OTS and the FDIC. After the Conversion, the Bank will continue to provide
services for depositors and borrowers under current policies by its present
management and staff. The Directors serving the Bank at the time of the
Conversion will serve as Directors of the Bank after the Conversion. The
Directors of the Company will consist of individuals currently serving on the
Board of Directors of the Bank.
EFFECT ON DEPOSIT ACCOUNTS. Under the Plan of Conversion, each depositor
in the Bank at the time of the Conversion will automatically continue as a
depositor after the Conversion, and each such deposit account will remain the
same with respect to deposit balance, interest rate and other terms. Each
such account will be insured by the
90
<PAGE>
FDIC to the same extent as before the Conversion. Depositors will continue to
hold their existing certificates, passbooks and other evidences of their
accounts.
EFFECT ON LOANS. No loan outstanding from the Bank will be affected by
the Conversion, and the amount, interest rate, maturity and security for each
loan will remain as they were contractually fixed prior to the Conversion.
EFFECT ON VOTING RIGHTS OF MEMBERS. At present, all depositors and
certain borrowers of the Bank are members of, and have voting rights in, the
Mutual Holding Company as to all matters requiring membership action. Upon
completion of the Conversion, depositors and borrowers will cease to be
members of the Mutual Holding Company and will no longer be entitled to vote
at meetings of the Mutual Holding Company. Upon completion of the Conversion,
all voting rights in the Bank will be vested in the Company as the sole
shareholder of the Bank. Exclusive voting rights with respect to the Company
will be vested in the holders of Common Stock. Depositors and borrowers of
the Bank will not have voting rights after the Conversion except to the
extent that they become stockholders of the Company through the purchase of
Common Stock.
TAX EFFECTS. The Bank will receive an opinion of counsel with regard to
federal and state income taxation to the effect that the adoption and
implementation of the Plan of Conversion will not be taxable for federal or
state income tax purposes to the Bank, the Mutual Holding Company, the
Minority Stockholders, the Interim Savings Bank, members of the Mutual
Holding Company, eligible account holders or the Company. See "--Tax Aspects."
EFFECT ON LIQUIDATION RIGHTS. Were the Bank to liquidate prior to the
Conversion, all claims of creditors of the Bank, including those of
depositors to the extent of their deposit balances, would be paid first.
Thereafter, if there were any assets of the Bank remaining, such assets would
be distributed to the Mutual Holding Company, to the extent of its stock
ownership interest in the Bank. Were the Mutual Holding Company to liquidate,
all claims of creditors would be paid first. Thereafter, if there were any
assets of the Mutual Holding Company remaining, members of the Mutual Holding
Company would receive such remaining assets, pro rata, based upon the deposit
balances in their deposit account in the Bank immediately prior to
liquidation. In the unlikely event that the Bank were to liquidate after the
Conversion, all claims of creditors (including those of depositors, to the
extent of their deposit balances) would also be paid first, followed by
distribution of the "liquidation account" to certain depositors (see
"Liquidation Rights"), with any assets remaining thereafter distributed to
the Company as the holder of the Bank's capital stock. Pursuant to the rules
and regulations of the OTS, a post-conversion merger, consolidation, sale of
bulk assets or similar combination or transaction with another insured
savings institution would not be considered a liquidation and, in such a
transaction, the liquidation account would be assumed by the surviving
institution.
STOCK PRICING AND NUMBER OF SHARES TO BE ISSUED
The Plan of Conversion and federal regulations require that the aggregate
purchase price of the Common Stock in the Offering must be based on the
appraised pro forma market value of the Common Stock, as determined by the
Independent Valuation. The Bank and the Company have retained RP Financial to
make such valuation. For its services in making such appraisal, RP Financial
will receive a fee of $30,000 (which amount does not include a fee of $7,500
to be paid to RP Financial for assistance in preparation of a business plan).
The Bank and the Company have agreed to indemnify RP Financial and its
employees and affiliates against certain losses (including any losses in
connection with claims under the federal securities laws) arising out of its
services as appraiser, except where RP Financial's liability results from its
negligence or bad faith.
The Independent Valuation was prepared by RP Financial in reliance upon
the information contained in the Prospectus, including the Consolidated
Financial Statements. RP Financial also considered the following factors,
among others: the present and projected operating results and financial
condition of the Company and the Bank and the economic and demographic
conditions in the Bank's existing marketing area; certain historical,
financial and other information relating to the Bank; a comparative
evaluation of the operating and financial statistics of the Bank with those
of other publicly traded savings institutions located in the Bank's region
and on a national basis; the aggregate size of the Offering of the Common
Stock; the impact of the Conversion on the Bank's stockholders' equity and
earnings potential; the proposed dividend policy of the Company and the Bank;
and the trading market for securities of comparable institutions and general
conditions in the market for such securities.
91
<PAGE>
The Independent Valuation was prepared based on the assumption that the
aggregate amount of Common Stock sold in the Offering would be equal to the
estimated pro forma market value of the Company multiplied by the Minority
Ownership Percentage. The Independent Valuation states that as of December
12, 1997, the estimated pro forma market value of the Company ranged from a
minimum of $40,219,142 to a maximum of $54,414,133 with a midpoint of
$47,316,638 (the "Valuation Range"). The Board of Directors determined to
offer the Subscription Shares for $10.00 per share (the "Subscription
Price"). The aggregate offering price of the Subscription Shares offered in
the Offering will be equal to the Valuation Range multiplied by the Minority
Ownership Percentage. The number of Subscription Shares offered in the
Offering will be equal to the aggregate offering price of the Subscription
Shares divided by the Subscription Price. The number of Subscription Shares
offered in the Offering and/or the aggregate of the offering price of the
Subscription Shares are referred to herein as the "Offering Range." Based on
the Valuation Range, the Minority Ownership Percentage and the Subscription
Price, the minimum of the Offering Range will be 2,125,000 Subscription
Shares, the midpoint of the Offering Range will be 2,500,000 Subscription
Shares, and the maximum of the Offering Range will be 2,875,000 Subscription
Shares.
The Board of Directors reviewed the Independent Valuation and, in
particular, considered (i) the Bank's financial condition and results of
operations for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, (ii) financial
comparisons of the Bank in relation to financial institutions of similar size
and asset quality, (iii) stock market conditions generally and in particular
for financial institutions, and (iv) the historical trading price of the
Minority Shares, all of which are set forth in the Independent Valuation. The
Board also reviewed the methodology and the assumptions used by RP Financial
in preparing the Independent Valuation. The Offering Range may be amended
with the approval of the OTS (if required), if necessitated by subsequent
developments in the financial condition of the Company or the Bank or market
conditions generally. In the event the Independent Valuation is updated to
amend the pro forma market value of the Company to less than $40.2 million or
more than $62.6 million, such appraisal will be filed with the Securities and
Exchange Commission by post-effective amendment.
The Independent Valuation, however, is not intended, and must not be
construed, as a recommendation of any kind as to the advisability of
purchasing such shares. RP Financial did not independently verify the
Consolidated Financial Statements and other information provided by the Bank,
nor did RP Financial value independently the assets or liabilities of the
Bank. The Independent Valuation considers the Bank as a going concern and
should not be considered as an indication of the liquidation value of the
Bank. Moreover, because such valuation is necessarily based upon estimates
and projections of a number of matters, all of which are subject to change
from time to time, no assurance can be given that persons purchasing such
shares in the Offering will thereafter be able to sell such shares at prices
at or above the Subscription Price.
Following commencement of the Subscription Offering, the maximum of the
Valuation Range may be increased by up to 15% to up to $62,576,253, which
will result in a corresponding increase of up to 15% in the maximum of the
Offering Range to 3,306,250 shares, to reflect changes in the market and
financial conditions, without the resolicitation of subscribers. The minimum
of the Valuation Range and of the Offering Range may not be decreased without
a resolicitation of subscribers. The Subscription Price of $10.00 per share
will remain fixed. See "--Limitations on Common Stock Purchases" as to the
method of distribution and allocation of additional shares that may be issued
in the event of an increase in the Offering Range to fill unfilled orders in
the Subscription and Community Offerings.
If the update to the Independent Valuation at the conclusion of the
Offering results in an increase in the maximum of the Valuation Range to more
than $62,576,253 and a corresponding increase in the Offering Range to more
than 3,306,250 shares, or a decrease in the minimum of the Valuation Range to
less than $40,219,142 and a corresponding decrease in the Offering Range to
fewer than 2,125,000 shares, then the Company, after consulting with the OTS,
may terminate the Plan of Conversion and return all funds promptly with
interest at the Bank's passbook rate of interest on payments made by check,
certified or teller's check, bank draft or money order, extend or hold a new
Subscription Offering, Community Offering, or both, establish a new Offering
Range, commence a resolicitation of subscribers or take such other actions as
permitted by the OTS in order to complete the Conversion. In the event that a
resolicitation is commenced, unless an affirmative response is received
within a reasonable period of time, all funds will be promptly returned to
investors as described above. A resolicitation, if any, following the
conclusion of the Subscription and Community Offerings would not exceed 45
days unless further extended by the OTS for periods of up to 90 days not to
extend beyond .
92
<PAGE>
An increase in the number of shares to be issued in the Offering would
decrease both a subscriber's ownership interest and the Company's pro forma
earnings and stockholders' equity on a per share basis while increasing pro
forma earnings and stockholders' equity on an aggregate basis. A decrease in
the number of shares to be issued in the Offering would increase both a
subscriber's ownership interest and the Company's pro forma earnings and
stockholders' equity on a per share basis while decreasing pro forma net
income and stockholders' equity on an aggregate basis. For a presentation of
the effects of such changes, see "Pro Forma Data."
Copies of the appraisal report of RP Financial and the detailed
memorandum of the appraiser setting forth the method and assumptions for such
appraisal are available for inspection at the main office of the Bank and the
other locations specified under "Additional Information."
EXCHANGE OF STOCK CERTIFICATES
Until the Effective Date, Minority Shares will continue to be available
for trading on the Nasdaq "SmallCap" Market. The conversion of the Bank
Common Stock into Company Common Stock will occur automatically on the
Effective Date. After the Effective Date, former holders of the Bank Common
Stock will have no further equity interest in the Bank (other than as
stockholders of the Company) and there will be no further transfers of the
Bank Common Stock on the stock transfer records of the Bank.
As soon as practicable after the Effective Date, the Company, or a bank
or trust company designated by the Company, in the capacity of exchange agent
(the "Exchange Agent"), will send a transmittal form to each Minority
Stockholder. The transmittal forms are expected to be mailed within five
business days after the Effective Date and will contain instructions with
respect to the surrender of certificates representing the Bank Common Stock
to be exchanged into the Company's Common Stock. It is expected that
certificates for shares of the Company's Common Stock will be distributed
within five business days after the receipt of properly executed transmittal
forms and other required documents.
THE BANK'S STOCKHOLDERS SHOULD NOT FORWARD POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND
LOAN ASSOCIATION STOCK CERTIFICATES TO THE BANK OR THE EXCHANGE AGENT UNTIL
THEY HAVE RECEIVED TRANSMITTAL FORMS.
Until the certificates representing the Bank Common Stock are surrendered
for exchange after consummation of the Conversion, upon compliance with the
terms of the transmittal form, holders of such certificates will not receive
the shares of the Company's Common Stock and will not be paid dividends on
the Company Common Stock into which such shares have been converted. When
such certificates are surrendered, any unpaid dividends will be paid without
interest. For all other purposes, however, each certificate which represents
shares of the Bank Common Stock outstanding at the Effective Date will be
deemed to evidence ownership of the shares of the Company's Common Stock into
which those shares have been converted by virtue of the Conversion.
All shares of the Company Common Stock issued upon conversion of shares
of the Bank Common Stock shall be deemed to have been issued in full
satisfaction of all rights pertaining to such shares of the Bank Common
Stock, subject, however, to the Company's obligation to pay any dividends or
make any other distributions with a record date prior to the Effective Date
which may have been declared or made by the Bank on such shares of the Bank
Common Stock on or prior to the Effective Date and which remain unpaid at the
Effective Date. The Bank intends to continue to pay a quarterly cash dividend
of $0.225 per share through the earlier of (i) the Effective Date (on a pro
rated basis), or (ii) the fiscal quarter ending March 31, 1998. The Mutual
Holding Company intends to waive the receipt of such dividend.
No fractional shares of the Company's Common Stock will be issued to any
Minority Stockholder upon consummation of the Conversion. For each fractional
share that would otherwise be issued, the Company will pay by check an amount
equal to the product obtained by multiplying the fractional share interest to
which such holder would otherwise be entitled by the Subscription Price.
Payment for fractional shares will be made as soon as practicable after the
receipt by the Exchange Agent of surrendered Pocahontas Federal Savings and
Loan Association stock certificates.
93
<PAGE>
If a certificate for the Bank Common Stock has been lost, stolen or
destroyed, the Exchange Agent will issue the consideration properly payable
upon receipt of appropriate evidence as to such loss, theft or destruction,
appropriate evidence as to the ownership of such certificate by the claimant,
and appropriate and customary indemnification.
SUBSCRIPTION OFFERING AND SUBSCRIPTION RIGHTS
In accordance with the Plan of Conversion, rights to subscribe for the
purchase of Common Stock in the Subscription Offering have been granted under
the Plan of Conversion in the following order of descending priority. All
subscriptions received will be subject to the availability of Common Stock
after satisfaction of all subscriptions of all persons having prior rights in
the Subscription Offering and to the maximum, minimum, and overall purchase
limitations set forth in the Plan of Conversion and as described below under
"--Limitations on Common Stock Purchases."
PRIORITY 1: ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT HOLDERS. Each depositor with aggregate
deposit account balances (including demand deposit accounts) of $50 or more
(a "Qualifying Deposit") as of September 30, 1996 (the "Eligibility Record
Date," and such account holders, "Eligible Account Holders") will receive,
without payment therefor, nontransferable subscription rights to subscribe in
the Subscription Offering for the greater of 30,000 subscription shares
(i.e., approximately 1.2% of the shares offered at the midpoint of the
Offering Range), .10% of the total offering of shares, or fifteen times the
product (rounded down to the next whole number) obtained by multiplying the
aggregate number of Exchange Shares and Subscription Shares issued in the
Conversion by a fraction of which the numerator is the amount of the Eligible
Account Holder's Qualifying Deposit and the denominator is the total amount
of Qualifying Deposits of all Eligible Account Holders, in each case on the
Eligibility Record Date, subject to the overall purchase limitations and
exclusive of shares purchased by the KSOP from any increase in the shares
offered pursuant to an increase in the maximum of the Offering Range. See
"--Limitations on Common Stock Purchases." If there are not sufficient shares
available to satisfy all subscriptions, shares first will be allocated so as
to permit each subscribing Eligible Account Holder to purchase a number of
shares sufficient to make his total allocation equal to the lesser of 100
shares or the number of shares for which he subscribed. Thereafter,
unallocated shares (except for additional shares issued to the KSOP upon an
increase in the maximum of the Offering Range) will be allocated to each
subscribing Eligible Account Holder whose subscription remains unfilled in
the proportion that the amount of his aggregate Qualifying Deposit bears to
the total amount of Qualifying Deposits of all subscribing Eligible Account
Holders whose subscriptions remain unfilled. If an amount so allocated
exceeds the amount subscribed for by any one or more Eligible Account
Holders, the excess shall be reallocated among those Eligible Account Holders
whose subscriptions are not fully satisfied until all available shares have
been allocated.
To ensure proper allocation of stock, each Eligible Account Holder must
list on his subscription order form and certification form all deposit
accounts in which he has an ownership interest on the Eligibility Record
Date. Failure to list an account could result in fewer shares being allocated
than if all accounts had been disclosed. The subscription rights of Eligible
Account Holders who are also directors or officers of the Bank or their
associates will be subordinated to the subscription rights of other Eligible
Account Holders to the extent attributable to increased deposits in the
twelve months preceding the Eligibility Record Date.
PRIORITY 2: KSOP. To the extent that there are sufficient shares
remaining after satisfaction of subscriptions by Eligible Account Holders,
the KSOP of the Company and the Bank will receive, without payment therefor,
nontransferable subscription rights to purchase in the aggregate up to 8% of
the Common Stock offered in the Subscription Offering, including any shares
to be issued in the Subscription Offering as a result of an increase in the
Estimated Price Range after commencement of the Subscription Offering and
prior to completion of the Conversion.
PRIORITY 3: SUPPLEMENTAL ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT HOLDERS. To the extent that
there are sufficient shares remaining after satisfaction of subscriptions by
Eligible Account Holders and the KSOP, each depositor with a Qualifying
Deposit as of December 31, 1997 (the "Supplemental Eligibility Record Date")
who is not an Eligible Account Holder ("Supplemental Eligible Account
Holder") will receive, without payment therefor, nontransferable subscription
rights to subscribe in the Subscription Offering for the greater of 30,000
shares (i.e., approximately 1.2% of the shares offered at the midpoint of the
Offering Range), .10% of the total offering of shares, or fifteen times the
product (rounded down to the next whole number) obtained by multiplying the
aggregate number of Exchange Shares and
94
<PAGE>
Subscription Shares issued in the Conversion by a fraction of which the
numerator is the amount of the Supplemental Eligible Account Holder's
Qualifying Deposit and the denominator is the total amount of Qualifying
Deposits of all Supplemental Eligible Account Holders, in each case on the
Supplemental Eligibility Record Date, subject to the overall purchase
limitations. See "--Limitations on Common Stock Purchases." If there are not
sufficient shares available to satisfy all subscriptions, shares will be
allocated so as to permit each subscribing Supplemental Eligible Account
Holder to purchase a number of shares sufficient to make his total allocation
equal to the lesser of 100 shares or the number of shares for which he
subscribed. Thereafter, unallocated shares will be allocated to each
subscribing Supplemental Eligible Account Holder whose subscription remains
unfilled in the proportion that the amount of his Qualifying Deposit bears to
the total amount of Qualifying Deposits of all subscribing Supplemental
Eligible Account Holders whose subscriptions remain unfilled.
To ensure proper allocation of stock, each Supplemental Eligible Account
Holder must list on his subscription order form and certification form all
deposit accounts in which he has an ownership interest at December 31, 1997.
Failure to list an account could result in less shares being allocated than
if all accounts had been disclosed.
PRIORITY 4: OTHER MEMBERS. To the extent that there are shares remaining
after satisfaction of subscriptions by Eligible Account Holders, the KSOP,
and Supplemental Eligible Account Holders, each member of the Mutual Holding
Company on the Voting Record Date who is not an Eligible Account Holder or
Supplemental Eligible Account Holder ("Other Members") will receive, without
payment therefor, nontransferable subscription rights to subscribe in the
Subscription Offering for the greater of 30,000 shares (i.e., approximately
1.2% of the shares offered at the midpoint of the Offering Range), or .10% of
the total offering of shares, subject to the overall purchase limitations.
See "--Limitations on Stock Purchases." If there are not sufficient shares
available to satisfy all subscriptions, available shares will be allocated
first to Other Members who reside in the Community on the Voting Record Date
and thereafter to nonresident Other Members on a pro rata basis based on the
size of the order of each Other Member.
PRIORITY 5: MINORITY STOCKHOLDERS. To the extent that there are shares
remaining after satisfaction of subscriptions by Eligible Account Holders,
the KSOP, Supplemental Eligible Account Holders and Other Members, each
Minority Stockholder will receive, without payment therefor, nontransferable
subscription rights to subscribe in the Subscription Offering for the greater
of 30,000 (i.e., approximately 1.2% of the shares offered at the midpoint of
the Offering Range), or .10% of the total offering of shares, subject to the
overall purchase limitations. In the event the Minority Stockholders
subscribe for a number of shares which, when added to the shares subscribed
for by Eligible Account Holders, the KSOP, Supplemental Eligible Account
Holders and Other Members, is in excess of the total number of shares offered
in the Offering, available shares will be allocated on a pro rata basis based
on the size of the order of each Minority Stockholder.
EXPIRATION DATE FOR THE SUBSCRIPTION OFFERING. The Subscription Offering
will expire on March 18, 1998 (the "Expiration Date"), unless extended
for up to 45 days or such additional periods by the Bank with the approval of
the OTS, if necessary. The Bank and the Company may determine to extend the
Subscription Offering and/or the Community Offering for any reason, whether
or not subscriptions have been received for shares at the minimum, midpoint,
or maximum of the Offering Range, and are not required to give subscribers
notice of any such extension. Subscription rights which have not been
exercised prior to the Expiration Date will become void.
The Company will not execute orders until all shares of Common Stock have
been subscribed for or otherwise sold. If 2,125,000 shares have not been
subscribed for or sold within 45 days after the Expiration Date, unless such
period is extended with the consent of the OTS, all funds delivered to the
Bank pursuant to the Subscription Offering will be returned promptly to the
subscribers with interest and all withdrawal authorizations will be
cancelled. If an extension beyond the 45 day period following the Expiration
Date is granted, the Bank will notify subscribers of the extension of time
and of any rights of subscribers to modify or rescind their subscriptions.
Such extensions may not go beyond .
PERSONS IN NONQUALIFIED STATES OR FOREIGN COUNTRIES. The Company will
make reasonable efforts to comply with the securities laws of all states in
the United States in which persons entitled to subscribe for stock pursuant
to the Plan of Conversion reside. However, the Company is not required to
offer stock in the Offering to any person who resides in a foreign country or
resides in a state of the United States with respect to which (i) a small
number
95
<PAGE>
of persons otherwise eligible to subscribe for shares of Common Stock reside
in such state; or (ii) the Company determines that compliance with the
securities laws of such state would be impracticable for reasons of cost or
otherwise, including but not limited to a request that the Company or its
officers or directors, under the securities laws of such state, register as a
broker, dealer, salesman or selling agent or to register or otherwise qualify
the subscription rights or Common Stock for sale or subject any filing with
respect thereto in such state. Where the number of persons eligible to
subscribe for shares in one state is small, the Company will base its
decision as to whether or not to offer the Common Stock in such state on a
number of factors, including the size of accounts being held by account
holders in the state, the cost of registering or qualifying the shares or the
need to register the Company, its officers, directors or employees as
brokers, dealers or salesmen.
COMMUNITY OFFERING
To the extent that shares remain available for purchase after
satisfaction of all subscriptions of the Eligible Account Holders, the KSOP,
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders, Other Members and Minority
Stockholders, the Company has determined to offer shares pursuant to the Plan
of Conversion to certain members of the general public in a direct community
offering (the "Community Offering"), with preference given first to natural
persons residing in the Community (such natural person referred to as
"Preferred Subscribers"). Such persons, together with associates of and
persons acting in concert with such persons, may subscribe for up to 30,000
Subscription Shares (i.e., approximately 1.2% of the shares offered at the
midpoint of the Offering Range), subject to the overall purchase limitations.
See "--Limitations on Common Stock Purchases." Depending upon market or
financial conditions this amount may be increased to up to a maximum of 5%.
The minimum purchase is 25 shares. The opportunity to subscribe for shares of
Common Stock in the Community Offering category is subject to the right of
the Company, in its sole discretion, to accept or reject any such orders in
whole or in part either at the time of receipt of an order or as soon as
practicable following the Expiration Date. If the Bank with the approval of
the OTS increases the maximum purchase limitation, the Company is only
required to resolicit persons who subscribed for the maximum purchase amount
and may, in the sole discretion of the Company, resolicit certain other large
subscribers. In the event that the maximum purchase limitation is increased
to 5%, such limitation may be further increased to 9.99% provided that orders
for Common Stock exceeding 5% of the Subscription Shares issued in the
Offering shall not exceed in the aggregate 10% of the total Subscription
Shares issued in the Offering. Requests to purchase additional shares of the
Common Stock in the event that the purchase limitation is so increased will
be determined by the Board of Directors of the Company in its sole discretion.
Subject to the foregoing, if the amount of stock remaining is
insufficient to fill the orders of Preferred Subscribers, such stock will be
allocated among the Preferred Subscribers in the manner that permits each
such person, to the extent possible, to purchase the number of shares
necessary to make his total allocation of Common Stock equal to the lesser of
100 shares offered or the number of shares subscribed for by each such
Preferred Subscriber; provided that if there are insufficient shares
available for such allocation, then shares will be allocated among Preferred
Subscribers whose orders remain unsatisfied in the proportion that the
unfilled subscription of each bears to the total unfilled subscriptions of
all Preferred Subscribers whose subscription remain unsatisfied. If all
orders of Preferred Subscribers are filled, any shares remaining will be
allocated to other persons who purchase in the Community Offering applying
the same allocation described above for Preferred Subscribers.
The term "resided" or "residing" as used herein shall mean any person who
occupies a dwelling within the Community, has a present intent to remain
within the Community for a period of time, and manifests the genuineness of
that intent by establishing an ongoing physical presence within the Community
together with an indication that such presence within the Community is
something other than merely transitory in nature. To the extent the person is
a corporation or other business entity, the principal place of business or
headquarters shall be in the Community. To the extent a person is a personal
benefit plan, the circumstances of the beneficiary shall apply with respect
to this definition. In the case of all other benefit plans, circumstances of
the trustee shall be examined for purposes of this definition. The Bank may
utilize deposit or loan records or such other evidence provided to it to make
a determination as to whether a person is a resident. In all cases, however,
such a determination shall be in the sole discretion of the Bank.
The Community Offering will terminate no more than 45 days following the
Expiration Date, unless extended by the Bank and the Company with the
approval of the OTS if necessary. The Bank and the Company may determine
96
<PAGE>
to extend the Subscription Offering and/or the Community Offering for any
reason, whether or not subscriptions have been received for shares at the
minimum, midpoint, or maximum of the Offering Range, and are not required to
give subscribers notice of any such extension. The Company will not execute
orders until all shares of Common Stock have been subscribed for or otherwise
sold. If 2,125,000 shares have not been subscribed for or sold within 45 days
after the Expiration Date, unless such period is extended with the consent of
the OTS, all funds delivered to the Bank pursuant to the Subscription
Offering will be returned promptly to the subscribers with interest and all
withdrawal authorizations will be cancelled. If an extension beyond the 45
day period following the Expiration Date is granted, the Bank will notify
subscribers of the extension of time and of any rights of subscribers to
modify or rescind their subscriptions. Such extensions may not go beyond .
The Board of Directors has the right to reject any order submitted in the
Offering by a person whose representations the Board of Directors believes to
be false or who it otherwise believes, either alone or acting in concert with
others, is violating, evading, circumventing, or intends to violate, evade or
circumvent the terms and conditions of the Plan of Conversion.
SYNDICATED COMMUNITY OFFERING
If feasible, the Board of Directors may determine to offer all
Subscription Shares not subscribed for in the Subscription and Community
Offerings in a Syndicated Community Offering, subject to such terms,
conditions and procedures as may be determined by the Company, in a manner
that will achieve the widest distribution of the Common Stock subject to the
right of the Bank to accept or reject in whole or in part any subscriptions
in the Syndicated Community Offering. In the Syndicated Community Offering,
any person together with any associate or group of persons acting in concert
may purchase a number of Subscription Shares that when combined with Exchange
shares received by such person, together with any associate or group of
persons acting in concert is equal to 30,000 shares, subject to the overall
purchase limitations; provided, however, that the shares purchased by any
person together with an associate or group of persons acting in concert in
the Community Offering shall be counted toward meeting the overall purchase
limitations. Provided that the Subscription Offering has commenced, the
Company may commence the Syndicated Community Offering at any time after the
mailing to the members of the Proxy Statement to be used in connection with
the Special Meeting of Members of the Mutual Holding Company, provided that
the completion of the offer and sale of the Subscription Shares shall be
conditioned upon the approval of the Plan of Conversion by the members. If
the Syndicated Community Offering is not sooner commenced pursuant to the
provisions of the preceding sentence, the Syndicated Community Offering will
be commenced as soon as practicable following the date upon which the
Subscription and Community Offerings terminate.
Alternatively, if a Syndicated Community Offering is not held, the Bank
shall have the right to sell any Subscription Shares remaining following the
Subscription and Community Offerings in an underwritten firm commitment
public offering. The overall purchase limitations shall not be applicable to
sales to underwriters for purposes of such an offering but shall be
applicable to the sales by the underwriters to the public. The price to be
paid by the underwriters in such an offering shall be equal to the
Subscription Price less an underwriting discount to be negotiated among such
underwriters and the Bank, which will in no event exceed an amount deemed to
be acceptable by the OTS.
If for any reason a Syndicated Community Offering or an underwritten firm
commitment public offering of shares of Subscription Shares not sold in the
Subscription and Community Offerings cannot be effected, or in the event that
any insignificant residue of shares of Subscription Shares is not sold in the
Subscription and Community Offerings or in the Syndicated Community or
underwritten firm commitment public offering, other arrangements will be made
for the disposition of unsubscribed shares by the Bank, if possible. Such
other purchase arrangements will be subject to the approval of the OTS.
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION AND SELLING COMMISSIONS
Offering materials for the Offering initially have been distributed to
certain persons by mail, with additional copies made available at the Bank's
office and by Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc. All prospective
purchasers are to send payment along with a completed Order Form and
certification form directly to the Bank, where such funds will be held in a
segregated special escrow account and not released until the Offering is
completed or terminated.
97
<PAGE>
To assist in the marketing of the Common Stock, the Bank has retained
FBR, which is a broker-dealer registered with the National Association of
Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD"). FBR will assist the Bank in the
Offering as follows: (i) in training and educating the Bank's employees
regarding the mechanics and regulatory requirements of the Conversion; (ii)
in conducting any informational meetings for employees, customers and the
general public; (iii) in coordinating the selling efforts in the Bank's local
communities; and (iv) keeping records of all orders for Common Stock. For
these services, FBR will receive (i) an advisory and management fee of
$50,000; and (ii) a marketing fee of 1.0% of the total dollar amount of the
Common Stock sold in the Subscription and Community Offerings, reduced by the
advisory and management fee. No fee shall be payable by the Bank in
connection with the sale of Common Stock to the KSOP or to the Bank's or the
Company's directors, officers, employees, and such persons' immediate family
members.
The Bank also will reimburse FBR for its reasonable out-of-pocket
expenses associated with its marketing effort, up to a maximum of $39,500,
including legal fees and expenses. The Bank has made an advance payment to
FBR in the amount of $25,000. The Bank will indemnify FBR against liabilities
and expenses (including legal fees) incurred in connection with certain
claims or litigation arising out of or based upon untrue statements or
omissions contained in the offering material for the Common Stock, including
liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933.
Certain directors and executive officers of the Company and Bank may
participate in the solicitation of offers to purchase Common Stock. Such
persons will be reimbursed by the Mutual Holding Company and/or the Bank for
their reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, including, but not limited to, de
minimis telephone and postage expenses, incurred in connection with such
solicitation. Other regular, full-time employees of the Bank may participate
in the Offering but only in ministerial capacities, providing clerical work
in effecting a sales transaction or answering questions of a potential
purchaser provided that the content of the employee's responses is limited to
information contained in the Prospectus or other offering documents, and no
offers or sales may be made by tellers or at the teller counter. All sales
activity will be conducted in a segregated or separately identifiable area of
the Bank's offices apart from the area accessible to the general public for
the purpose of making deposits or withdrawals. Other questions of prospective
purchasers will be directed to executive officers or registered
representatives. Such other employees have been instructed not to solicit
offers to purchase Common Stock or provide advice regarding the purchase of
Common Stock. The Company will rely on Rule 3a4-1 under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act"), and sales of Common Stock will be
conducted within the requirements of Rule 3a4-1, so as to permit officers,
directors and employees to participate in the sale of Common Stock. No
officer, director or employee of the Company or the Bank will be compensated
in connection with his participation by the payment of commissions or other
remuneration based either directly or indirectly on the transactions in the
Common Stock.
PROCEDURE FOR PURCHASING SHARES
EXPIRATION DATE. The Offering will terminate at noon, Central time, on
March 18, 1998, unless extended by the Company, with prior approval of the
OTS, if required, for up to an additional 45 days (as so extended, the
"Expiration Date). Such extension may be granted by the Company, in its sole
discretion, without further approval or additional notice to purchasers in
the Offering. Any extension of the Offering beyond the Expiration Date would
be subject to OTS approval and potential purchasers would be given the right
to increase, decrease, or rescind their orders for Common Stock. If the
minimum number of shares offered in the Offering is not sold by the
Expiration Date the Company may terminate the Offering and promptly refund
all orders for Common Stock. A reduction in the number of shares below the
minimum of the Offering Range will not require the approval of the Mutual
Holding Company's members or the Bank's stockholders, or an amendment to the
Independent Valuation. If the number of shares is reduced below the minimum
of the Offering Range, purchasers will be given an opportunity to increase,
decrease, or rescind their orders.
To ensure that each purchaser receives a Prospectus at least 48 hours
before the Expiration Date in accordance with Rule 15c2-8 of the Exchange
Act, no Prospectus will be mailed any later than five days prior to such date
or hand delivered any later than two days prior to such date. Execution of an
Order Form will confirm receipt or delivery in accordance with Rule 15c2-8.
Order Forms will be distributed only with a Prospectus.
98
<PAGE>
The Company reserves the right in its sole discretion to terminate the
Offering at any time and for any reason, in which case the Company will
return all purchase orders, plus interest at its current passbook rate from
the date of receipt.
USE OF ORDER AND CERTIFICATION FORMS. In order to purchase the Common
Stock, each purchaser must complete an Order Form and a certification form.
Incomplete Order Forms, or Order Forms that are not accompanied by a
certification form, will not be accepted. The Bank will not be required to
accept orders submitted on photocopied or facsimilied stock order forms. Any
person receiving an Order Form who desires to purchase Common Stock must do
so prior to noon, Central time, on March 18, 1998 by delivering (by mail or
in person) to the Company a properly executed and completed Order Form and a
certification form, together with full payment for the shares purchased. Once
tendered, an Order Form cannot be modified or revoked without the consent of
the Company. The Company reserves the absolute right, in its sole discretion,
to reject orders received in the Community Offering, in whole or in part, at
the time of receipt or at any time prior to completion of the Offering. Each
person ordering shares is required to represent that he is purchasing such
shares for his own account and that he has no agreement or understanding with
any person for the sale or transfer of such shares. The interpretation by the
Company of the terms and conditions of the Plan of Conversion and of the
acceptability of the Order Forms and certification forms will be final.
PAYMENT FOR SHARES. Payment for all shares will be required to accompany
all completed Order Forms for the purchase to be valid. Payment for shares
may be made by (i) cash (if delivered in person), (ii) check, money order,
certified or teller's check or bank draft made payable to Pocahontas Bancorp,
Inc., or (iii) authorization of withdrawal from savings accounts (including
certificates of deposit) maintained with the Bank. Appropriate means by which
such withdrawals may be authorized are provided in the Order Forms. Once such
a withdrawal amount has been authorized, a hold will be placed on such funds,
making them unavailable to the depositor until the Offering has been
completed or terminated. In the case of payments authorized to be made
through withdrawal from deposit accounts, all funds authorized for withdrawal
will continue to earn interest at the contract rate until the Offering is
completed or terminated. Interest penalties for early withdrawal applicable
to certificate accounts will not apply to withdrawals authorized for the
purchase of shares; however, if a withdrawal results in a certificate account
with a balance less than the applicable minimum balance requirement, the
certificate shall be cancelled at the time of withdrawal without penalty, and
the remaining balance will earn interest at the passbook rate subsequent to
the withdrawal. In the case of payments made by cash, check or money order,
such funds will be placed in a segregated savings account and interest will
be paid by the Bank at the current passbook rate per annum from the date
payment is received until the Offering is completed or terminated. An
executed Order Form, once received by the Bank, may not be modified, amended
or rescinded without the consent of the Bank, unless the Offering is not
completed by the Expiration Date, in which event purchasers may be given the
opportunity to increase, decrease, or rescind their orders for a specified
period of time.
A depositor interested in using his or her IRA funds to purchase Common
Stock must do so through a self-directed IRA. Since the Bank does not offer
such accounts, it will allow a depositor to make a trustee-to-trustee
transfer of the IRA funds to a trustee offering a self-directed IRA program
with the agreement that such funds will be used to purchase the Company's
Common Stock in the Offering. There will be no early withdrawal or IRS
interest penalties for such transfers. The new trustee would hold the Common
Stock in a self-directed account in the same manner as the Bank now holds the
depositor's IRA funds. An annual administrative fee may be payable to the new
trustee. Depositors interested in using funds in a Bank IRA to purchase
Common Stock should contact the Stock Center at the Bank as soon as possible
so that the necessary forms may be forwarded for execution and returned prior
to the Expiration Date.
The KSOP will not be required to pay for shares purchased until
consummation of the Offering, provided that there is in force from the time
the order is received a loan commitment from an unrelated financial
institution or the Company to lend to the KSOP the necessary amount to fund
the purchase.
DELIVERY OF STOCK CERTIFICATES. Certificates representing Common Stock
issued in the Offering and Bank checks representing interest paid on
subscriptions made by cash, check, or money order will be mailed by the Bank
to the persons entitled thereto at the address noted on the Order Form, as
soon as practicable following consummation of the Offering and receipt of all
necessary regulatory approvals. Any certificates returned as undeliverable
will be
99
<PAGE>
held by the Bank until claimed by persons legally entitled thereto or
otherwise disposed of in accordance with applicable law. Until certificates
for the Common Stock are available and delivered to purchasers, purchasers
may not be able to sell the shares of stock which they ordered. Regulations
prohibit the Bank from lending funds or extending credit to any persons to
purchase Common Stock in the Offering.
OTHER RESTRICTIONS. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan of
Conversion, no person is entitled to purchase any Common Stock to the extent
such purchase would be illegal under any federal or state law or regulation
(including state "blue-sky" registrations), or would violate regulations or
policies of the NASD, particularly those regarding free riding and
withholding. The Bank and/or its agents may ask for an acceptable legal
opinion from any purchaser as to the legality of such purchase and may refuse
to honor any such purchase order if such opinion is not timely furnished.
RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER OF SUBSCRIPTION RIGHTS AND SHARES
Prior to the completion of the Conversion, the OTS conversion regulations
prohibit any person with subscription rights, including the Eligible Account
Holders, Supplemental Eligible Account Holders, Other Members and Minority
Stockholders of the Bank, from transferring or entering into any agreement or
understanding to transfer the legal or beneficial ownership of the
subscription rights issued under the Plan of Conversion or the shares of
Common Stock to be issued upon their exercise. Such rights may be exercised
only by the person to whom they are granted and only for his account. Each
person exercising such subscription rights will be required to certify that
he is purchasing shares solely for his own account and that he has no
agreement or understanding regarding the sale or transfer of such shares. The
regulations also prohibit any person from offering or making an announcement
of an offer or intent to make an offer to purchase such subscription rights
or shares of Common Stock prior to the completion of the Conversion.
The Bank and the Company will pursue any and all legal and equitable
remedies in the event they become aware of the transfer of subscription
rights and will not honor orders known by them to involve the transfer of
such rights.
LIMITATIONS ON COMMON STOCK PURCHASES
The Plan of Conversion includes the following limitations on the number
of shares of Common Stock which may be purchased during the Conversion:
(1) No person may purchase less than 25 shares of Common Stock.
(2) The KSOP may purchase in the aggregate up to 8% of the Subscription
Shares issued in the Offering, including shares issued in the event of an
increase in the Offering Range of 15%.
(3) No person (or persons through a single account), together with
associates of and groups of persons acting in concert with such person, may
purchase in the Offering a number of Subscription Shares that when combined
with Exchange Shares received by any such person, together with associates of
and persons acting in concert with such person exceeds 100,000 shares, except
for the KSOP which may subscribe for up to 8% of the Common Stock offered in
the Subscription Offering (including shares issued in the event of an
increase in the Estimated Price Range of 15%); provided, however, that
notwithstanding this limitation, no Minority Stockholder who receives more
than 100,000 shares issued in the Conversion shall be required to direct any
such shares and provided further that in the event the maximum purchase
limitation is increased, orders for Subscription Shares in the Community
Offering and in the Syndicated Offering (or, alternatively, an underwritten
firm commitment public offering), if any, shall as determined by the Bank,
first be filled to a maximum of 30,000 shares and thereafter remaining shares
shall be allocated, on an equal number of shares basis per order until all
orders have been filled.
(4) The maximum number of shares of Common Stock which may be purchased
in all categories of the Offering by officers and directors of the Bank and
their associates in the aggregate, shall not exceed 27% of the Subscription
Shares offered in the Offering.
100
<PAGE>
Depending upon market or financial conditions, the Board of Directors of
the Company, with the approval of the OTS and without further approval of
members of the Mutual Holding Company, may decrease or further increase the
purchase limitations. Subject to any required regulatory approval and the
requirements of applicable laws and regulations, but without further approval
of the members of the Company, both the individual amount permitted to be
subscribed for and the overall purchase limitation may be increased to up to
a maximum of 5% at the sole discretion of the Company and the Bank. If such
amount is increased, subscribers for the maximum amount will be, and certain
other large subscribers who through their subscriptions evidence a desire to
purchase the maximum allowable number of shares in the sole discretion of the
Bank may be, given the opportunity to increase their subscriptions up to the
then applicable limit. The effect of such a resolicitation will be an
increase in the number of shares owned by subscribers who choose to increase
their subscriptions. In addition, the Boards of Directors of the Company and
the Bank may, in their sole discretion, increase the maximum purchase
limitation referred to above up to 9.99%, provided that orders for shares
exceeding 5% of the shares being offered shall not exceed, in the aggregate,
10% of the total offering. Requests to purchase additional shares under this
provision will be determined by the respective Boards of Directors in their
sole discretion.
In the event of an increase in the total number of shares offered in the
Offering due to an increase in the Offering Range of up to 15%, the maximum
number of shares that may be purchased as restricted by the purchase
limitations shall not be increased proportionately (except for the KSOP), and
the additional shares sold will be allocated in the following order of
priority in accordance with the Plan of Conversion: (i) to fill the KSOP's
subscription for 8% of the total number of shares sold; (ii) in the event
that there is an oversubscription at the Eligible Account Holder,
Supplemental Eligible Account Holder, Other Member, or Minority Stockholder
levels, to fill unfulfilled subscriptions of such subscribers according to
such respective priorities; and (iii) to fill unfulfilled subscriptions in
the Community Offering with preference given to natural persons residing in
the Community.
The term "associate" of a person is defined to mean: (i) any corporation or
organization (other than the Bank or a majority-owned subsidiary of the Bank) of
which such person is an officer, partner or 10% stockholder; (ii) any trust or
other estate in which such person has a substantial beneficial interest or
serves as a director or in a similar fiduciary capacity; provided, however, such
term shall not include any employee stock benefit plan in which such person has
a substantial beneficial interest or serves as director or in a similar
fiduciary capacity; and (iii) any relative or spouse of such persons, or any
relative of such spouse, who either has the same home as such person or who is a
director or officer of the Bank. Directors are not treated as associates solely
because of their Board membership. For a further discussion of limitations on
purchases of a converting institution's stock at the time of Conversion and
subsequent to Conversion, see "Management of the Bank--Subscriptions by
Management and Directors," and "The Conversion -- Certain Restrictions on
Purchase or Transfer of Shares After Conversion" and "Restrictions on
Acquisition of the Company and the Bank."
LIQUIDATION RIGHTS
In the unlikely event of a complete liquidation of the Bank prior to the
Conversion, all claims of creditors of the Bank, including those of depositors
to the extent of their deposit balances, would be paid first. Thereafter, if
there were any assets of the Bank remaining, such assets would be distributed to
stockholders, including the Mutual Holding Company. Were the Mutual Holding
Company and the Bank to liquidate prior to the Conversion, all claims of
creditors would be paid first. Thereafter, if there were any assets of the
Mutual Holding Company remaining, members of the Mutual Holding Company would
receive such remaining assets, pro rata, based upon the deposit balances in
their deposit account in the Bank immediately prior to liquidation. In the
unlikely event that the Bank were to liquidate after Conversion, all claims of
creditors (including those of depositors, to the extent of their deposit
balances) would also be paid first, followed by distribution of the "liquidation
account" to certain depositors, with any assets remaining thereafter distributed
to the Company as the holder of the Bank's capital stock. Pursuant to the rules
and regulations of the OTS, a post-conversion merger, consolidation, sale of
bulk assets or similar combination or transaction with another insured savings
institution would not be considered a liquidation and, in such a transaction,
the liquidation account would be assumed by the surviving institution.
The Plan of Conversion provides for the establishment, upon the completion
of the Conversion, of a special "liquidation account" for the benefit of
Eligible Account Holders and Supplemental Eligible Account Holders in an
101
<PAGE>
amount equal to the greater of: (a) the sum of (i) the Mutual Holding
Company's ownership interest in the surplus and reserves of the Bank as of
the date of its latest balance sheet contained in the final Prospectus used
in connection with the Conversion, and (ii) the restricted retained income
account that reflects certain dividends waived by the Mutual Holding Company;
or (b) the retained earnings of the Bank at the time that the Bank
reorganized into the Mutual Holding Company on December 31, 1991. The purpose
of the liquidation account is to provide Eligible Account Holders and
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders who maintain their deposit accounts
with the Bank after the conversion with a distribution upon complete
liquidation of the Bank after the Conversion. Each Eligible Account Holder
and Supplemental Eligible Account Holder, if he were to continue to maintain
his deposit account at the Bank, would be entitled, on a complete liquidation
of the Bank after the Conversion to an interest in the liquidation account
prior to any payment to the stockholders of the Bank. Each Eligible Account
Holder and the Supplemental Eligible Account Holder would have an initial
interest in such liquidation account for each deposit account, including
regular accounts, transaction accounts such as NOW accounts, money market
deposit accounts, and certificates of deposit, with a balance of $50 or more
held in the Bank on the Eligibility Record Date, or the Supplemental
Eligibility Record Date, respectively ("Deposit Accounts"). Each Eligible
Account Holder and Supplemental Eligible Account Holder will have a pro rata
interest in the total liquidation account for each of his Deposit Accounts
based on the proportion that the balance of each such Deposit Account on the
Eligibility Record Date, or the Supplemental Eligibility Record Date,
respectively, bore to the balance of all Deposit Accounts in the Bank on such
dates.
If, however, on any September 30 annual closing date of the Bank, commencing
after September 30, 1998, the amount in any Deposit Account is less than the
amount in such Deposit Account on the Eligibility Record Date, or the
Supplemental Eligibility Record Date, respectively, or any other annual closing
date, then the interest in the liquidation account relating to such Deposit
Account would be reduced from time to time by the proportion of any such
reduction, and such interest will cease to exist if such Deposit Account is
closed. In addition, no interest in the liquidation account would ever be
increased despite any subsequent increase in the related Deposit Account.
Payment pursuant to liquidation rights of Eligible Account Holders and
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders would be separate and apart from any
insured deposit accounts to such depositor. Any assets remaining after the above
liquidation rights of Eligible Account Holders and Supplemental Eligible Account
Holders are satisfied would be distributed to the Company as the sole
shareholder of the Bank.
TAX ASPECTS
The Conversion will be effected as (i) an exchange of the Mutual Holding
Company's charter for an interim stock savings association charter and
simultaneous merger into the Bank in a tax-free reorganization under Section
368(a)(1)(A) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code") and
(ii) a merger of the Interim Savings Bank into the Bank with the Bank's
stockholders exchanging their Bank Common Stock for Common Stock of the Company
in a tax-free reorganization under Code Section 368(a)(1)(A) by reason of Code
Section 368(a)(2)(E). Consummation of the Conversion is expressly conditioned
upon the prior receipt of an opinion of counsel with respect to federal and
state income taxation that indicates that the Conversion will not be a taxable
transaction to the Mutual Holding Company, the Bank, the Company, the Interim
Savings Bank, Eligible Account Holders, Supplemental Eligible Account Holders,
or members of the Mutual Holding Company.
Pursuant to Revenue Procedure 97-3, the IRS has stated that it will not rule
on whether a transaction qualifies as a tax-free reorganization under Code
Section 368(a)(1)(A), including a transaction that qualifies under Code Section
368(a)(1)(A) by reason of Code Section 368(a)(2)(E), or whether the taxpayer is
subject to the consequences of qualification under that section (such as
nonrecognition and basis issues) but that it would rule on significant
sub-issues that must be resolved to determine whether the transaction qualifies
under the above sections. In several instances over the last two years, the IRS
ruled favorably on certain significant sub-issues associated with downstream
mergers of mutual holding companies into their less than 80 percent owned
subsidiary savings associations. In such cases, the IRS has ruled that (i) the
exchange of the member's equity interests in the mutual holding company for
interests in a liquidation account established at the savings association will
satisfy the continuity of interest requirement with respect to the merger of
mutual holding company into the savings association; (ii) pursuant to the merger
of an interim savings association into the savings association, the stock
holding company will acquire control of the savings association (as defined in
Code Section 368(c)) as the interests in the liquidation account and the shares
of savings association stock previously held by the mutual holding company will
be disregarded; and (iii) the continuity of interest
102
<PAGE>
requirement will not be violated by the exchange of stock holding company
stock for savings association stock in the merger of an interim savings
association into the savings association.
In December 1994, the IRS issued Revenue Procedure 94-76 which states
that the IRS will not issue private letter rulings with respect to downstream
mergers of a corporation into a "less than 80 percent distributee", i.e., a
corporation, such as the Bank, in which the merging corporation (i.e., the
Mutual Holding Company) possesses less than 80 percent of the total voting
power of the stock of such corporation and less than 80 percent of the total
value of the stock of such corporation. The IRS has assumed this "no-rule"
position to study whether such downstream mergers circumvent the purpose
behind the repeal of General Utilities & Operating Co. v. Helvering, 296 U.S.
200 (1935). Counsel to the Company is of a view that the downstream merger to
effect the Conversion of the Mutual Holding Company to stock form, where
after consummation of the Conversion, the Company holds 100% of the shares of
the Bank and the untaxed appreciation of the Bank remains in corporate
solution, is not the type of downstream merger which can be considered as
circumventing the repeal of General Utilities. If, however, the IRS were to
conclude that such mergers circumvent the repeal of General Utilities, the
IRS could issue correcting regulations which could have the effect of taxing
to the merging corporation, as of the effective time of the merger, the fair
market value of the assets of such corporation over its basis in such assets.
If such regulations are issued, it is expected that they would apply on a
prospective basis and would have no effect on transactions consummated before
their issuance. The Company will receive an opinion of counsel that, in the
absence of a change in the regulations, and based on current law and
regulations, the merger of the Mutual Holding Company into the Bank will
qualify as a tax-free merger under Code Section 368(a)(1)(A), as more fully
discussed below.
On the Effective Date, the Mutual Holding Company and the Bank will
receive an opinion of counsel, Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, A
Professional Corporation, which will indicate that the federal income tax
consequences of the Conversion will be as follows: (i) the conversion of the
Mutual Holding Company from mutual to stock form (which company in its mutual
and stock form is referred to herein as the "Mutual Holding Company") will
constitute a mere change in identity, form or place of reorganization within
the meaning of Section 368(a)(1)(F) of the Code; (ii) the merger of the
Mutual Holding Company with and into the Bank will qualify as a
reorganization within the meaning of Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the Code; (iii)
the exchange of the members' equity interests in the Mutual Holding Company
for interests in a liquidation account established at the Bank will satisfy
the continuity of interest requirement with respect to the merger of the
Mutual Holding Company into the Bank; (iv) the Mutual Holding Company will
not recognize any gain or loss on the transfer of its assets to the Bank in
exchange for a liquidation account in Bank; (v) no gain or loss will be
recognized by the Bank upon the receipt of the assets of the Mutual Holding
Company in exchange for a liquidation account in Bank; (vi) the basis of the
assets of Mutual Holding Company to be received by Bank will be the same as
the basis of such assets in the hands of the Mutual Holding Company
immediately prior to the transfer; (vii) the holding period of the assets of
the Mutual Holding Company to be received by the Bank will include the
holding period of those assets in the hands of the Mutual Holding Company
immediately prior to the transfer; (viii) Mutual Holding Company members will
recognize no gain or loss upon the receipt of an interest in the liquidation
account in the Bank in exchange for their membership interest in the Mutual
Holding Company; (ix) the merger of the Interim Savings Bank into the Bank
with the Bank as the surviving institution qualifies as a reorganization
within the meaning of Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the Code, pursuant to Section
368(a)(2)(E) of the Code; (x) the Interim Savings Bank will not recognize any
gain or loss on the transfer of its assets to the Bank in exchange for Bank
stock and the assumption by the Bank of the liabilities, if any, of the
Interim Savings Bank; (xi) the Bank will not recognize any gain or loss on
the receipt of the assets of the Interim Savings Bank in exchange for Bank
stock; (xii) the Bank's basis in the assets received from the Interim Savings
Bank in the proposed transaction will, in each case, be the same as the basis
of such assets in the hands of the Interim Savings Bank immediately prior to
the transaction; (xiii) the Company will not recognize any gain or loss upon
its receipt of Bank stock solely in exchange for stock; (xiv) the Bank's
holding period for the assets received from the Interim Savings Bank in the
proposed transaction will, in each instance, include the period during which
such assets were held by the Interim Savings Bank; (xv) Bank stockholders
will not recognize any gain or loss upon their exchange of Bank stock solely
for shares of Company Common Stock; (xvi) Cash received in the Bank Merger by
a Bank shareholder in lieu of a fractional share interest of Company Common
Stock will be treated as having been received as a distribution in full
payment in exchange for a fractional share interest of Bank Common Stock
which such shareholders would otherwise be entitled to receive, and will
qualify as capital gain or loss (assuming the Bank Common Stock surrendered
in exchange therefore was held as capital asset by such shareholder); (xvii)
each Bank shareholder's basis in his or her Company Common Stock received in
the exchange will be the same as the basis of the Bank stock surrendered in
exchange therefor; (xviii) each Bank shareholder's holding period in his or
her Company Common Stock received in the exchange will include the period
during which the Bank stock surrendered was held, provided that the Bank
stock surrendered is a capital asset in the hands of the Bank shareholder on
the date of the exchange; and (xix) No gain or loss will be recognized by the
Company on the receipt of money in exchange for Company Common Stock in the
Offering. The form of such opinion has been filed with the SEC as an exhibit
to the Company's registration statement.
103
<PAGE>
In the opinion of RP Financial, which opinion is not binding on the IRS, the
subscription rights do not have any value, based on the fact that such rights
are acquired by the recipients without cost, are nontransferable and of short
duration, and afford the recipients the right only to purchase the Common Stock
at a price equal to its estimated fair market value, which will be the same
price as the Purchase Price for the unsubscribed shares of Common Stock. If the
subscription rights granted to Eligible Account Holders and Supplemental
Eligible Account Holders are deemed to have an ascertainable value, receipt of
such rights could result in taxable gain to those Eligible Account Holders and
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders who exercise the subscription rights in an
amount equal to such value and the Bank could recognize gain on such
distribution. Eligible Account Holders and Supplemental Eligible Account Holders
are encouraged to consult with their own tax advisor as to the tax consequences
in the event that such subscription rights are deemed to have an ascertainable
value.
Unlike private rulings, an opinion of counsel is not binding on the IRS and
the IRS could disagree with the conclusions reached therein. Depending on the
conclusion or conclusions with which the IRS disagrees, the IRS may take the
position that the transaction is taxable to any one or more of the Mutual
Holding Company and/or the members of the Mutual Holding Company, the Bank, the
Minority Stockholders of the Bank and/or the Eligible Account Holders and
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders who exercise their subscription rights. In
the event of such disagreement, there can be no assurance that the IRS would not
prevail in a judicial or administrative proceeding.
CERTAIN RESTRICTIONS ON PURCHASE OR TRANSFER OF SHARES AFTER CONVERSION
All Subscription Shares purchased in the Offering by a director or an
executive officer of the Bank will be subject to a restriction that the shares
not be sold for a period of one year following the Conversion, except in the
event of the death of such director or executive officer. Each certificate for
restricted shares will bear a legend giving notice of this restriction on
transfer, and instructions will be issued to the effect that any transfer within
such time period of any certificate or record ownership of such shares other
than as provided above is a violation of the restriction. Any shares of Common
Stock issued at a later date as a stock dividend, stock split, or otherwise,
with respect to such restricted stock will be subject to the same restrictions.
The directors and executive officers of the Bank will also be subject to the
insider trading rules promulgated pursuant to the Exchange Act.
Purchases of outstanding shares of Common Stock of the Company by directors,
executive officers (or any person who was an executive officer or director of
the Bank after adoption of the Plan of Conversion) and their associates during
the three-year period following the Conversion may be made only through a
broker or dealer registered with the SEC, except with the prior written approval
of the OTS. This restriction does not apply, however, to negotiated transactions
involving more than 1% of the Company's outstanding Common Stock or to the
purchase of stock pursuant to a stock option plan or any tax qualified employee
stock benefit plan of or non-tax qualified employee stock benefit plan of the
Bank or the Company (including any employee plan, recognition plans or
restricted stock plans).
OTS regulations applicable to the Company as a result of the Conversion
prohibit the Company from repurchasing shares of its Common Stock for three
years, except for: (i) an offer to all stockholders on a pro rata basis; or (ii)
for the repurchase of qualifying shares of a director. Notwithstanding the
foregoing and except as provided below, beginning one year following completion
of the Conversion, the Company may repurchase its
104
<PAGE>
Common Stock so long as (i) the repurchases within the following two years
are part of an open-market program not involving greater than 5% of its
outstanding capital stock during a twelve-month period; (ii) the repurchases
do not cause the Bank to become "undercapitalized" within the meaning of the
OTS prompt corrective action regulation; and (iii) the Company provides to
the Regional Director of the OTS no later than ten days prior to the
commencement of a repurchase program written notice containing a full
description of the program to be undertaken and such program is not
disapproved by the Regional Director. See "Regulation and Supervision--Prompt
Corrective Regulatory Action." In addition, under current OTS policies,
repurchases may be allowed in the first year following the Conversion and in
amounts greater than 5% in the second and third years following the
Conversion provided there are valid and compelling business reasons for such
repurchases and the OTS does not object to such repurchases.
RESTRICTIONS ON THE ACQUISITION OF THE COMPANY AND THE BANK
GENERAL
The Plan of Conversion provides for the Conversion of the Mutual Holding
Company from the mutual to the stock form of organization and in connection
therewith, the Company, as a new Delaware stock corporation has been
organized which will become the sole stockholder of the Bank following the
Conversion. Provisions in the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and
Bylaws together with provisions of Delaware corporate law, may have
anti-takeover effects. In addition, certain provisions of the Company's and
Bank's compensation plans contain provisions which may discourage or make
more difficult for persons or companies to acquire control of either the
Company or the Bank. Also, the Bank's Stock Charter and Bylaws and
compensation plans entered into in connection with the Conversion may have
anti-takeover effects as described below. In addition, regulatory
restrictions may make it difficult for persons or companies to acquire
control of either the Company or the Bank.
RESTRICTIONS IN THE COMPANY'S CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION AND BYLAWS
A number of provisions of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and
Bylaws deal with matters of corporate governance and certain rights of
stockholders. The following discussion is a general summary of certain
provisions of the Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws and certain
other statutory and regulatory provisions relating to stock ownership and
transfers, and business combinations, which might be deemed to have a potential
"anti-takeover" effect. These provisions may have the effect of discouraging a
future takeover attempt or change of control which is not approved by the Board
of Directors but which a majority of individual Company stockholders may deem to
be in their best interests or in which stockholders may receive a substantial
premium for their shares over then current market prices. As a result,
stockholders who desire to participate in such a transaction may not have an
opportunity to do so. Such provisions will also render the removal of the
current Board of Directors or management of the Company more difficult. The
following description of certain of the provisions of the Certificate of
Incorporation and Bylaws of the Company is necessarily general and reference
should be made in each case to such Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws.
LIMITATION ON VOTING RIGHTS. The Certificate of Incorporation of the
Company provides that in no event shall any record owner of any outstanding
Common Stock which is beneficially owned, directly or indirectly, by a person
who beneficially owns in excess of 10% of the then outstanding shares of Common
Stock (the "Limit") be entitled or permitted to any vote in respect of the
shares held in excess of the Limit. Beneficial ownership is determined pursuant
to Rule 13d-3 of the General Rules and Regulations promulgated pursuant to the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and includes shares beneficially owned by such
person or any of his affiliates (as defined in the Certificate of
Incorporation), shares which such person or his affiliates have the right to
acquire upon the exercise of conversion rights or options and shares as to which
such person and his affiliates have or share investment or voting power, but
shall not include shares beneficially owned by the KSOP or directors, officers
and employees of the Bank or the Company or shares that are subject to a
revocable proxy and that are not otherwise beneficially owned, or deemed by the
Company to be beneficially owned, by such person and his affiliates. The
Certificate of Incorporation of the Company further provides that the provision
limiting voting rights may only be amended upon the vote of 80% of the
outstanding shares of voting stock.
BOARD OF DIRECTORS. The Board of Directors of the Company is divided into
three classes, each of which shall contain approximately one-third of the whole
number of the members of the Board. Each class shall serve a staggered
105
<PAGE>
term, with approximately one-third of the total number of directors being
elected each year. The Company's Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws
provide that the size of the Board shall be determined by a majority of the
directors. The Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws provide that any
vacancy occurring in the Board, including a vacancy created by an increase in
the number of directors or resulting from death, resignation, retirement,
disqualification, removal from office or other cause, shall be filled for the
remainder of the unexpired term exclusively by a majority vote of the
directors then in office. The classified Board is intended to provide for
continuity of the Board of Directors and to make it more difficult and time
consuming for a shareholder group to fully use its voting power to gain
control of the Board of Directors without the consent of the incumbent Board
of Directors of the Company. The Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
provides that a director may be removed from the Board of Directors prior to
the expiration of his term only for cause, upon the vote of 80% of the
outstanding shares of voting stock.
The Company will have a Nominating Committee which will be responsible for
nominations of directors. Stockholders who wish to nominate persons for election
to the Board of Directors may do so if the stockholder makes timely written
notice to the Company's Secretary. Generally, to be timely, such notice, which
must include all information required to be disclosed pursuant to Regulation 14A
under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, must be received at the Company's
principal executive offices no later than ninety (90) days prior to the date of
the meeting.
In the absence of these provisions, the vote of the holders of a majority of
the shares could remove the entire Board, with or without cause, and replace it
with persons of such holders' choice.
CUMULATIVE VOTING, SPECIAL MEETINGS AND ACTION BY WRITTEN CONSENT. The
Certificate of Incorporation does not provide for cumulative voting for any
purpose. Moreover, special meetings of shareholders of the Company may be called
only by the Board of Directors of the Company. The Certificate of Incorporation
also provides that any action required or permitted to be taken by the
shareholders of the Company may be taken only at an annual or special meeting
and prohibits shareholder action by written consent in lieu of a meeting.
AUTHORIZED SHARES. The Certificate of Incorporation authorizes the
issuance of 7.0 million shares of Common Stock and 500,000 shares of
Preferred Stock. The shares of Common Stock and Preferred Stock were
authorized in an amount greater than that to be issued in the Conversion to
provide the Company's Board of Directors with as much flexibility as possible
to effect, among other transactions, financings, acquisitions, stock
dividends, stock splits and employee stock options. However, these additional
authorized shares may also be used by the Board of Directors consistent with
its fiduciary duty to deter future attempts to gain control of the Company.
The Board of Directors also has sole authority to determine the terms of any
one or more series of Preferred Stock, including voting rights, conversion
rating and liquidation preferences. As a result of the ability to fix voting
rights for a series of Preferred Stock, the Board has the power, to the
extent consistent with its fiduciary duty, to issue a series of Preferred
Stock to persons friendly to management in order to attempt to block a
post-tender offer merger or other transaction by which a third party seeks
control, and thereby assist management to retain its position. The Company's
Board currently has no plans for the issuance of additional shares, other
than the issuance of additional shares upon exercise of stock options and to
permit the 1998 Recognition Plan to obtain the equivalent of 4% of the shares
sold in the Offering.
SHAREHOLDER VOTE REQUIRED TO APPROVE BUSINESS COMBINATIONS WITH PRINCIPAL
STOCKHOLDERS. The Certificate of Incorporation requires the approval of the
holders of at least 80% of the Company's outstanding shares of voting stock to
approve certain "Business Combinations," as defined therein, and related
transactions. Under Delaware law, absent this provision, Business Combinations,
including mergers, consolidations and sales of all or substantially all of the
assets of a corporation must, subject to exceptions, be approved by the vote of
the holders of only a majority of the outstanding shares of Common Stock of the
Company and any other affected class of stock. Under the Certificate of
Incorporation, at least 80% approval of stockholders is required in connection
with any Business Combination involving an Interested Stockholder (as defined
below) except (i) in cases where the proposed transaction has been approved in
advance by a majority of those members of the Company's Board of Directors who
are unaffiliated with the Interested Stockholder and were directors prior to the
time when the shareholder became an Interested Stockholder or (ii) if the
proposed transaction met certain conditions set forth therein which are designed
to afford the shareholders a fair price in consideration for their shares, in
which cases approval of only a majority of the outstanding shares of voting
stock is required. The term "Interested Stockholder" is defined to include any
106
<PAGE>
individual, corporation, partnership or other entity (other than the Company or
its subsidiary) which owns beneficially or controls, directly or indirectly, 10%
or more of the outstanding shares of voting stock of the Company. This provision
of the Certificate of Incorporation applies to any "Business Combination," which
is defined to include (i) any merger or consolidation of the Company or any of
its subsidiaries with or into any Interested Stockholder or Affiliate (as
defined in the Certificate of Incorporation) of an Interested Stockholder; (ii)
any sale, lease, exchange, mortgage, transfer, pledge or other disposition to or
with any Interested Stockholder or Affiliate of an Interested Stockholder of 25%
or more of the assets of the Company or combined assets of the Company and its
subsidiary; (iii) the issuance or transfer to any Interested Stockholder or its
Affiliate by the Company (or any subsidiary) of any securities of the Company in
exchange for any assets, cash or securities the value of which equals or exceeds
25% of the fair market value of the Common Stock of the Company; (iv) the
adoption of any plan for the liquidation or dissolution of the Company proposed
by or on behalf of any Interested Stockholder or Affiliate thereof; and (v) any
reclassification of securities, recapitalization, merger or consolidation of the
Company which has the effect of increasing the proportionate share of Common
Stock or any class of equity or convertible securities of the Company owned
directly or indirectly, by an Interested shareholder or Affiliate thereof.
EVALUATION OF OFFERS. The Certificate of Incorporation of the Company
further provides that the Board of Directors of the Company, when evaluating
any offer of another "Person" (as defined therein), to (i) make a tender or
exchange offer for any equity security of the Company, (ii) merge or
consolidate the Company with another corporation or entity or (iii) purchase
or otherwise acquire all or substantially all of the properties and assets of
the Company, may, in connection with the exercise of its judgment in
determining what is in the best interest of the Company, the Bank and the
stockholders of the Company, give due consideration to all relevant factors,
including, without limitation, the social and economic effects of acceptance
of such offer on the Company's customers and the Bank's present and future
account holders, borrowers and employees; on the communities in which the
Company and the Bank operate or are located; and on the ability of the
Company to fulfill its corporate objectives as a savings and loan holding
company and on the ability of the Bank to fulfill the objectives of a
federally chartered stock savings association under applicable statutes and
regulations. By having these standards in the Certificate of Incorporation of
the Company, the Board of Directors may be in a stronger position to oppose
such a transaction if the Board concludes that the transaction would not be
in the best interest of the Company, even if the price offered is
significantly greater than the then market price of any equity security of
the Company.
AMENDMENT OF CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION AND BYLAWS. Amendments to the
Company's Certificate of Incorporation must be approved by a majority vote of
its Board of Directors and also by a majority of the outstanding shares of its
voting stock, provided, however, that an affirmative vote of at least 80% of the
outstanding voting stock entitled to vote (after giving effect to the provision
limiting voting rights) is required to amend or repeal certain provisions of the
Certificate of Incorporation, including the provision limiting voting rights,
the provisions relating to approval of certain business combinations, calling
special meetings, the number and classification of directors, director and
officer indemnification by the Company and amendment of the Company's Bylaws and
Certificate of Incorporation. The Company's Bylaws may be amended by its Board
of Directors, or by a vote of 80% of the total votes eligible to be voted at a
duly constituted meeting of stockholders.
CERTAIN BYLAW PROVISIONS. The Bylaws of the Company also require a
shareholder who intends to nominate a candidate for election to the Board of
Directors, or to raise new business at a shareholder meeting to have at least 90
days advance notice to the Secretary of the Company. The notice provision
requires a shareholder who desires to raise new business to provide certain
information to the Company concerning the nature of the new business, the
shareholder and the stockholder's interest in the business matter. Similarly, a
shareholder wishing to nominate any person for election as a director must
provide the Company with certain information concerning the nominee and the
proposing stockholder.
The provisions described above are intended to reduce the Company's
vulnerability to takeover attempts and certain other transactions which have not
been negotiated with and approved by members of its Board of Directors. The
provisions of the Bank's current and proposed employment agreements and stock
benefit plans may also discourage takeover attempts by increasing the costs to
be incurred by the Bank and Company in the event of a takeover. See "Management
of the Bank--Benefits."
107
<PAGE>
The foregoing provisions and limitations may make it more difficult for
companies or persons to acquire control of the Bank. Additionally, the
provisions could deter offers to the shareholders which might be viewed by such
shareholders to be in their best interests.
The Company's Board of Directors believes that the provisions of the
Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws and compensation plans are in the best
interests of the Company and its stockholders. An unsolicited non-negotiated
proposal can seriously disrupt the business and management of a corporation and
cause it great expense. Accordingly, the Board of Directors believes it is in
the best interests of the Company and its stockholders to encourage potential
acquirors to negotiate directly with management and that these provisions will
encourage such negotiations and discourage non-negotiated takeover attempts. It
is also the Board of Directors' view that these provisions should not discourage
persons from proposing a merger or other transaction at a price that reflects
the true value of the Company and that otherwise is in the best interest of all
stockholders.
DELAWARE CORPORATE LAW
In 1988, Delaware enacted a statute designed to provide Delaware
corporations with additional protection against hostile takeovers. The takeover
statute, which is codified in Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporate Law
("Section 203"), is intended to discourage certain takeover practices by
impeding the ability of a hostile acquiror to engage in transactions with the
target company.
In general, Section 203 provides that a "Person" (as defined therein) who
owns 15% or more of the outstanding voting stock of a Delaware corporation
(an "Interested Stockholder") may not consummate a merger or other business
combination transaction with such corporation at any time during the
three-year period following the date such "Person" became an Interested
Stockholder. The term "business combination" is defined broadly to cover a
wide range of corporate transactions including mergers, sales of assets,
issuances of stock, transactions with subsidiaries and the receipt of
disproportionate financial benefits.
The statute exempts the following transactions from the requirements of
Section 203: (i) any business combination if, prior to the date a person became
an Interested Stockholder, the Board of Directors approved either the business
combination or the transaction which resulted in the shareholder becoming an
Interested Stockholder; (ii) any business combination involving a person who
acquired at least 85% of the outstanding voting stock in the transaction in
which he became an Interested Stockholder, calculated without regard to those
shares owned by the corporation's directors who are also officers or certain
employee stock plans; (iii) any business combination with an Interested
Stockholder that is approved by the Board of Directors and by a two-thirds vote
of the outstanding voting stock not owned by the Interested Stockholder; and
(iv) certain business combinations that are proposed after the corporation had
received other acquisition proposals and which are approved or not opposed by a
majority of certain continuing members of the Board of Directors. A corporation
may exempt itself from the requirements of the statute by adopting an amendment
to its Certificate of Incorporation or Bylaws electing not to be governed by
Section 203. At the present time, the Board of Directors of the Company does not
intend to propose any such amendment.
RESTRICTIONS IN THE BANK'S FEDERAL STOCK CHARTER AND BYLAWS
The Bank's Charter contains a provision whereby the acquisition of or offer
to acquire beneficial ownership of more than 10% of the issued and outstanding
shares of any class of equity securities of the Bank by any person (i.e., any
individual, corporation, group acting in concert, trust, partnership, joint
stock company or similar organization), either directly or through an affiliate
thereof, will be prohibited until [April 1999]. Any stock beneficially owned in
excess of 10% of the stock outstanding will be deemed to be acquired in
violation of the Charter provision and will not be counted as outstanding for
voting purposes. This limitation shall not apply to any transaction in which the
Bank forms a stock holding company without a change in the respective beneficial
ownership interests of its stockholders, other than pursuant to the exercise of
any dissenter or appraisal rights, the purchase of shares by underwriters in
connection with a public offering, or the purchase of shares by a tax qualified
employee stock benefit plan. In the event that holders of revocable proxies for
more than 10% of the shares of the Common Stock of the Company seek, among other
things, to elect one-third or more of the Company's Board of Directors, to cause
the Company's stockholders to approve the acquisition or corporate
reorganization of the Company, or to exert a continuing influence on a material
aspect of the business operations of the Company, which actions could indirectly
108
<PAGE>
result in a change in control of the Bank, the Board of Directors of the Bank
will be able to assert this provision of the Bank's Charter against such
holders. Although the Board of Directors of the Bank is not currently able to
determine when and if it would assert this provision of the Bank's Charter, the
Board of Directors, in exercising its fiduciary duty, may assert this provision
if it were deemed to be in the best interests of the Bank, the Company and its
stockholders. It is unclear, however whether this provision, if asserted, would
be successful against such persons in a proxy contest which could result in a
change in control of the Bank indirectly through a change in control of the
Company. For a period of five years from [April 1999], shareholders will not be
permitted to call a special meeting of shareholders relating to a change of
control of the Bank or a Charter amendment or to cumulate their votes in the
election of directors. The staggered terms of the Board of Directors could have
an anti-takeover effect by making it more difficult for a majority of shares to
force an immediate change in the Board of Directors since only one-third of the
Board is elected each year. The purpose of the provisions is to assure stability
and continuity of management of the Bank.
Although the Bank has no arrangements, understandings or plans at the
present time for the issuance or use of the shares of undesignated preferred
stock proposed to be authorized, the Board of Directors believes that the
availability of such shares will provide the Bank with increased flexibility
in structuring possible future financing and acquisitions and in meeting
other corporate needs which may arise. In the event of a proposed merger,
tender offer or other attempt to gain control of the Bank of which management
does not approve, it might be possible for the Board of Directors to
authorize the issuance of one or more series of preferred stock with rights
and preferences which could impede the completion of such a transaction. An
effect of the possible issuance of such preferred stock, therefore, may be to
deter or render more difficult a future takeover attempt. The Board of
Directors of the Bank does not intend to issue any preferred stock except on
terms which the Board deems to be in the best interests of the Bank and its
then existing stockholders.
REGULATORY RESTRICTIONS
The Plan of Conversion prohibits any person, prior to the completion of the
Conversion, from transferring, or from entering into any agreement or
understanding to transfer, to the account of another, legal or beneficial
ownership of the subscription rights issued under the Plan of Conversion or the
Common Stock to be issued upon their exercise. The Plan of Conversion also
prohibits any person, prior to the completion of the Conversion, from offering,
or making an announcement of an offer or intent to make an offer, to purchase
such subscription rights or Common Stock.
For three years following the Conversion, OTS regulations prohibit any
person from acquiring, either directly or indirectly, or making an offer to
acquire more than 10% of the stock of any converted savings institution, without
the prior written approval of the OTS, except for (i) offers that if
consummated, would not result in the acquisition by such person during the
preceding 12-month period of more than 1% of such stock, (ii) offers in the
aggregate for up to 24.99% by the KSOP of the Company or the Bank, and (iii)
offers which are not offered by recently converted savings associations and
which receive prior OTS approval. Such prohibition is also applicable to the
acquisition of the Common Stock of the Company. In the event that any person,
directly or indirectly, violates this regulation, the securities beneficially
owned by such person in excess of 10% shall not be counted as shares entitled to
vote and shall not be voted by any person or counted as voting shares in
connection with any matters submitted to a vote of shareholders. The definition
of beneficial ownership for this regulation extends to persons holding revocable
or irrevocable proxies for the Company's stock under circumstances that give
rise to a conclusive or rebuttable determination of control under the OTS
regulations.
In addition, any proposal to acquire 10% of any class of equity security of
the Company generally would be subject to approval by the OTS under the Savings
and Loan Holding Company Act (the "SLHCA"). The OTS requires all persons seeking
control of a savings institution, and, therefore, indirectly its holding
company, to obtain regulatory approval prior to offering to obtain control. Such
change in control restrictions on the acquisition of holding company stock are
not limited to three years after conversion but will apply for as long as the
regulations are in effect. Persons holding revocable or irrevocable proxies may
be deemed to be beneficial owners of such securities under OTS regulations and
therefore prohibited from voting all or the portion of such proxies in excess of
the 10% aggregate beneficial ownership limit. Such regulatory restrictions may
prevent or inhibit proxy contests for control of the Company or the Bank which
have not received prior regulatory approval.
109
<PAGE>
ADDITIONAL ANTITAKEOVER EFFECTS
Assuming executive officers and directors (i) purchase 63,800
Subscription Shares in the Offering, (ii) receive Exchange Shares in the
Share Exchange as described above, (iii) receive a number of shares of Common
Stock equal to 4% and 10% of the number of Subscription Shares sold in the
Offering pursuant to the 1998 Recognition Plan and 1998 Stock Option Plan,
respectively (assuming such plans are approved by stockholders, that all
awards are vested and all options exercised, and the 1998 Recognition Plan
shares are purchased in the open market); and (iv) receive all stock benefits
that were not vested as of September 30, 1997, and exercised all such stock
options; then executive officers and directors will own between ___% and ___%
of the Company's Common Stock at the minimum and adjusted maximum of the
Offering Range, respectively. Such amount does not include the ___% of the
Company's Common Stock that will be owned by the KSOP at the conclusion of
the Conversion, assuming the KSOP purchases 8% of the Subscription Shares
sold in the Offering, and assuming that all participants vote the shares
allocated to their KSOP account in accordance with management's
recommendations. Under the terms of the KSOP, the unallocated shares will be
voted by the independent KSOP trustee in the same proportion as the allocated
shares. Accordingly, directors and officers will have effective voting
control over a substantial amount of Common Stock issued and outstanding at
the completion of the Conversion. The potential voting control by directors
and officers could, together with additional stockholder support or upon
exercise of their options, defeat stockholder proposals requiring an 80%
supermajority vote. As a result, these provisions may preclude takeover
attempts that certain stockholders deem to be in their best interest and may
tend to perpetuate existing management.
DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK OF THE COMPANY
GENERAL
At the Effective Date, the Company will be authorized to issue 7.0 million
shares of Common Stock having a par value of $.01 per share and 500,000 shares
of preferred stock (the "Preferred Stock"). The Company currently expects to
issue up to 2,875,000 (subject to adjustment) shares of Common Stock in the
Offering, and up to 2,566,413 shares (subject to adjustment) in exchange for
Minority Shares in the Conversion. The Company does not intend to issue shares
of Preferred Stock in the Conversion. Each share of the Company's Common Stock
will have the same relative rights as, and will be identical in all respects
with, each other share of Common Stock. Upon payment of the Purchase Price for
the Common Stock, in accordance with the Plan of Conversion, all such stock will
be duly authorized, fully paid and nonassessable.
The Common Stock of the Company will represent nonwithdrawable capital, will
not be an account of an insurable type, and will not be insured by the FDIC or
any other government agency.
COMMON STOCK
DIVIDENDS. The Company can pay dividends out of statutory surplus or from
certain net profits if, as and when declared by its Board of Directors. The
payment of dividends by the Company is subject to limitations which are
imposed by law and applicable regulation. See "Dividend Policy." The holders
of Common Stock of the Company will be entitled to receive and share equally
in such dividends as may be declared by the Board of Directors of the Company
out of funds legally available therefor. If the Company issues Preferred
Stock, the holders thereof may have a priority over the holders of the Common
Stock with respect to dividends.
VOTING RIGHTS. Upon Conversion, the holders of Common Stock of the Company
will possess exclusive voting rights in the Company. They will elect the
Company's Board of Directors and act on such other matters as are required to be
presented to them under Delaware law or as are otherwise presented to them by
the Board of Directors. Except as discussed in "Restrictions on Acquisition of
the Company and the Bank," each holder of Common Stock will be entitled to one
vote per share and (for a period of five years from the consummation of the
Conversion) will not have any right to cumulate votes in the election of
directors. If the Company issues Preferred Stock, holders of the Preferred Stock
may also possess voting rights. Certain matters require an 80% shareholder vote.
See "Restrictions on Acquisition of the Company and the Bank."
110
<PAGE>
As a federal stock savings association, corporate powers and control of
the Bank are vested in its Board of Directors, who elect the officers of the
Bank and who fill any vacancies on the Board of Directors as it exists upon
the Conversion. Voting rights of the Bank are vested exclusively in the
owners of the shares of capital stock of the Bank, which will be the Company,
and voted at the direction of the Company's Board of Directors. Consequently,
the holders of the Common Stock will not have direct control of the Bank.
LIQUIDATION. In the event of any liquidation, dissolution or winding up of
the Bank, the Company, as holder of the Bank's capital stock would be entitled
to receive, after payment or provision for payment of all debts and liabilities
of the Bank (including all deposit accounts and accrued interest thereon) and
after distribution of the balance in the special liquidation account to Eligible
Account Holders and Supplemental Eligible Account Holders (see "The
Conversion--Liquidation Rights"), all assets of the Bank available for
distribution. In the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the
Company, the holders of its Common Stock would be entitled to receive, after
payment or provision for payment of all its debts and liabilities, all of the
assets of the Company available for distribution. If Preferred Stock is issued,
the holders thereof may have a priority over the holders of the Common Stock in
the event of liquidation or dissolution.
PREEMPTIVE RIGHTS. Holders of the Common Stock of the Company will not be
entitled to preemptive rights with respect to any shares which may be issued.
The Common Stock is not subject to redemption.
PREFERRED STOCK
None of the shares of the Company's authorized Preferred Stock will be
issued in the Conversion. Such stock may be issued with such preferences and
designations as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine. The
Board of Directors can, without shareholder approval, issue Preferred Stock with
voting, dividend, liquidation and conversion rights which could dilute the
voting strength of the holders of the Common Stock and may assist management in
impeding an unfriendly takeover or attempted change in control.
DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK OF THE BANK
GENERAL. The Charter of the Bank authorizes the issuance of capital stock
consisting of 20,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $.01 per share, and
10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, which preferred stock may be issued in
series and classes having such rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions
as the Board of Directors may determine. Each share of common stock of the Bank
has the same relative rights as, and is identical in all respects with, each
other share of common stock. The Board of Directors of the Bank is authorized to
approve the issuance of common stock up to the amount authorized by the Charter
without the approval of the Bank's stockholders. All of the issued and
outstanding Common Stock of the Bank will be held by the Company as the Bank's
sole stockholder.
DIVIDENDS. The holders of the Bank's common stock are entitled to receive
and to share equally in such dividends as may be declared by the Board of
Directors of the Bank out of funds legally available therefore. See "Dividend
Policy" for certain restrictions on the payment of dividends.
VOTING RIGHTS. The holders of the Bank's common stock possess exclusive
voting rights in the Bank. Each holder of shares of common stock is entitled to
one vote for each share held, subject to any right of shareholders to cumulate
their votes for the election of directors. During the period ending in [April
1999], the holders of the Bank's common stock shall not be permitted to cumulate
their votes for the election of directors. See "Restrictions on Acquisition of
the Company and the Bank--Antitakeover Effects of the Company's Certificate of
Incorporation, Bylaws and Compensation Plans Adopted in the Conversion."
LIQUIDATION. In the event of any liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of
the Bank, the holders of the Bank's common stock will be entitled to receive,
after payment of all debts and liabilities of the Bank (including all deposit
accounts and accrued interest thereon), and distribution of the balance in the
special liquidation account to Eligible Account Holders, all assets of the Bank
available for distribution in cash or in kind. If additional preferred stock is
issued subsequent to the Conversion, the holders thereof may also have priority
over the holders of common stock in the event of liquidation or dissolution.
111
<PAGE>
PREEMPTIVE RIGHTS; REDEMPTION. Holders of the common stock of the Bank will
not be entitled to preemptive rights with respect to any shares of the Bank
which may be issued. The common stock will not be subject to redemption. Upon
receipt by the Bank of the full specified purchase price thereon, the common
stock will be fully paid and nonassessable.
TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR
The transfer agent and registrar for the Common Stock is the Registrar and
Transfer Company.
EXPERTS
The consolidated financial statements included in this Prospectus have been
audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP, independent auditors, as stated in their
report appearing herein and are included in reliance upon the report of such
firm given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.
RP Financial has consented to the publication herein of the summary of its
report to the Bank and the Company setting forth its opinion as to the estimated
pro forma market value of the Common Stock upon Conversion and its opinion with
respect to subscription rights.
LEGAL OPINIONS
The legality of the Common Stock and the federal income tax consequences of
the Conversion will be passed upon for the Bank and the Company by Luse Lehman
Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, A Professional Corporation, Washington, D.C., special
counsel to the Bank and the Company. Certain legal matters will be passed upon
for FBR by Peabody & Brown, Washington, D.C.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
The Company has filed with the SEC a registration statement under the
Securities Act with respect to the Common Stock offered hereby. As permitted by
the rules and regulations of the SEC, this Prospectus does not contain all the
information set forth in the registration statement. Such information, including
the Conversion Valuation Appraisal Report which is an exhibit to the
Registration Statement, can be examined without charge at the public reference
facilities of the SEC located at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549,
and copies of such material can be obtained from the SEC at prescribed rates.
The statements contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract
or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement are, of
necessity, brief descriptions thereof and are not necessarily complete.
The Bank has filed an application for conversion with the OTS with respect
to the Conversion. Pursuant to the rules and regulations of the OTS, this
Prospectus omits certain information contained in that application. The
application may be examined at the principal office of the OTS, 1700 G Street,
N.W., Washington, D.C. 20552 and at the Office of the Regional Director of the
OTS located at 122 West John Carpenter Freeway, Irving, Texas 75039.
In connection with the Conversion, the Company will register its Common
Stock with the SEC under Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act, and, upon such
registration, the Company and the holders of its stock will become subject to
the proxy solicitation rules, reporting requirements and restrictions on
stock purchases and sales by directors, officers and greater than 10%
stockholders, the annual and periodic reporting and certain other
requirements of the Exchange Act. Under the Plan of Conversion, the Company
has undertaken that it will not terminate such registration for a period of
at least three years following the Conversion. In the event that the Bank
amends the Plan of Conversion to eliminate the concurrent formation of the
Company as part of the Conversion, the Bank will register its stock with the
OTS under Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act and, upon such registration, the
Bank and the holders of the Conversion Stock will become subject to the same
obligations and restrictions.
A copy of the Certificate of Incorporation and the Bylaws of the Company and
the Federal Stock Charter and Bylaws of the Bank are available without charge
from the Bank.
112
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PAGE
---------
<S> <C>
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT.................................... F-2
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
(As of September 30, 1997 and 1996)............................. F-3
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(For the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995).. F-4
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
(For the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995).. F-6
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(For the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995).. F-7
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(For the fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995).. F-10
</TABLE>
All schedules are omitted as the required information is not applicable or
the information is presented in the consolidated financial statements.
Financial statements of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (the "Company") are not
presented herein because the Company has not yet issued any stock, has no assets
and no liabilities, and has not conducted any business other than of an
organizational nature.
Financial statements of Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company (the
"Mutual Holding Company") are not presented herein because the Mutual Holding
Company's only assets are $461,000 cash and its stock investment in Pocahontas
Federal Savings and Loan Association and it has no liabilities and does not
conduct any business.
F-1
<PAGE>
AUDIT OPINION
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
The Board of Directors of
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association:
We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial
condition of Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association (the
"Association") and subsidiaries as of September 30, 1997 and 1996 and the
related consolidated statements of income, stockholders' equity, and cash
flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 1997.
These financial statements are the responsibility of the Association's
management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated
financial statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence
supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis
for our opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above
presently fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the
Association and subsidiaries as of September 30, 1997 and 1996 and the results
of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the
period ended September 30, 1997 in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles.
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP
Little Rock, Arkansas
October 30, 1997
F-2
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
SEPTEMBER 30, 1997 AND 1996
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
------------ -----------
S> <C> <C>
ASSETS
Cash and due from banks......................... $2,805,273 $2,046,135
Cash surrender value of life insurance.......... 5,639,161 5,438,860
Securities held-to-maturity, at amortized
cost (fair value of $202,897,745 and
$218,969,300 in 1997 and 1996, respectively).. 200,552,569 219,689,835
Loans receivable, net........................... 159,690,201 136,871,613
Accrued interest receivable..................... 2,229,531 2,277,584
Premises and equipment, net..................... 1,804,832 1,923,247
Federal Home Loan Bank stock.................... 10,052,700 11,607,700
Other assets.................................... 642,947 1,706,712
------------ -----------
TOTAL........................................... $383,417,214 $381,561,686
------------ -----------
------------ -----------
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
LIABILITIES:
Deposits....................................... $143,354,096 $116,282,608
Federal Home Loan Bank advances.................. 190,601,038 227,220,906
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase... 20,685,000 10,100,000
Deferred compensation............................ 947,186 860,000
Special SAIF premium assessment payable.......... -- 937,000
Accrued expenses and other liabilities........... 3,583,625 3,471,971
------------ -----------
Total liabilities.............................. 359,170,945 358,872,485
------------ -----------
------------ -----------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
Common stock, $.10 par value, 20,000,000
shares authorized; 1,632,424 and 1,624,594
shares issued and outstanding in 1997
and 1996, respectively......................... 163,242 162,459
Additional paid-in capital....................... 14,913,491 14,770,569
Reduction for ESOP debt guaranty................. (103,644) (209,300)
Cumulative waived dividends...................... 1,630,125 1,254,937
Retained earnings (substantially restricted)..... 7,643,055 6,710,536
------------ -----------
Total stockholders' equity..................... 24,246,269 22,689,201
------------ -----------
TOTAL.............................................. $383,417,214 $381,561,686
------------ -----------
------------ -----------
</TABLE>
See notes to consolidated financial statements.
F-3
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, 1996, AND 1995
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996 1995
------------- ------------- ------------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
INTEREST INCOME:
Loans receivable.................. $ 12,006,825 $ 10,517,365 $ 9,107,904
Securities held-to-maturity....... 14,086,352 14,899,664 14,191,812
------------- ------------- ------------
Total interest income........... 26,093,177 25,417,029 23,299,716
INTEREST EXPENSE:
Deposits.......................... 5,939,098 5,380,077 5,588,738
Borrowed funds.................... 12,759,704 13,248,265 11,651,886
------------- ------------- ------------
Total interest expense.......... 18,698,802 18,628,342 17,240,624
------------- ------------- ------------
NET INTEREST INCOME BEFORE
PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES......... 7,394,375 6,788,687 6,059,092
PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES........... 60,000 411,200 --
------------- ------------- ------------
NET INTEREST INCOME AFTER
PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES......... 7,334,375 6,377,487 6,059,092
OTHER INCOME:
Dividends......................... 626,422 828,505 270,971
Fees and service charges.......... 398,234 314,437 430,108
Other............................. 326,526 383,263 209,519
------------- ------------- ------------
Total other income.............. 1,351,182 1,526,205 910,598
OTHER EXPENSES:
Compensation and benefits......... 2,954,912 2,704,002 2,623,833
Occupancy and equipment........... 566,229 438,872 376,792
Deposit insurance premium and
assessment...................... 108,136 1,197,722 278,830
Professional fees................. 276,149 209,275 143,648
Data processing................... 237,995 205,369 170,737
Advertising....................... 184,456 171,044 104,741
OTS assessment.................... 92,034 87,546 74,559
Other............................. 545,639 536,939 253,076
------------- ------------- ------------
Total other expenses............ 4,965,550 5,550,769 4,026,216
------------- ------------- ------------
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES.......... 3,720,007 2,352,923 2,943,474
INCOME TAX PROVISION................ 1,344,490 386,382 1,000,781
------------- ------------- ------------
NET INCOME.......................... $ 2,375,517 $ 1,966,541 $ 1,942,693
------------- ------------- ------------
------------- ------------- ------------
Earnings per share.................. $ 1.46 $ 1.22 $ 1.21
------------- ------------- ------------
------------- ------------- ------------
Weighted average shares outstanding. 1,629,011 1,617,690 1,610,000
------------- ------------- ------------
------------- ------------- ------------
</TABLE>
See notes to consolidated financial statements.
F-4
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, 1996, AND 1995
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
COMMON STOCK ADDITIONAL CUMULATIVE TOTAL
------------------------ PAID-IN ESOP WAIVED RETAINED STOCKHOLDERS'
SHARES AMOUNT CAPITAL GUARANTY DIVIDENDS EARNINGS EQUITY
----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ -------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
BALANCE, OCTOBER 1,
1994.................. 1,610,000 $ 161,000 $ 14,462,887 $ (418,600) $ 215,625 $ 4,999,189 $ 19,420,101
Net income.............. 1,942,693 1,942,693
Repayment of ESOP loan
and related increase
in share value........ 115,454 104,650 220,104
Dividends paid or to be
paid.................. (574,713) (574,713)
Dividends waived........ 375,187 (375,187)
----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ -------------
BALANCE, SEPTEMBER 30,
1995.................. 1,610,000 161,000 14,578,341 (313,950) 590,812 5,991,982 21,008,185
Net income.............. 1,966,541 1,966,541
Repayment of ESOP loan
and related increase
in share value........ 47,747 104,650 152,397
Options exercised....... 14,594 1,459 144,481 145,940
Dividends paid or to be
paid.................. 583,862 (583,862)
Dividends waived........ 664,125 (664,125)
----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ -------------
BALANCE, SEPTEMBER 30,
1996.................. 1,624,594 162,459 14,770,569 (209,300) 1,254,937 6,710,536 22,689,201
Net income.............. 2,375,517 2,375,517
Repayment of ESOP loan
and related increase
in share value........ 65,405 105,656 171,061
Options exercised....... 7,830 783 77,517 78,300
Dividends paid or to be
paid.................. (1,067,810) (1,067,810)
Dividends waived........ 375,188 (375,188)
----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ -------------
BALANCE, SEPTEMBER 30,
1997.................. 1,632,424 $ 163,242 $ 14,913,491 $ (103,644) $ 1,630,125 $ 7,643,055 $ 24,246,269
----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ -------------
----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ -------------
</TABLE>
See notes to consolidated financial statements.
F-5
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, 1996, AND 1995
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996 1995
------------- ------------- -------------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
Net income........................................................... $ 2,375,517 $ 1,966,541 $ 1,942,693
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating
activities:
Depreciation of premises and equipment............................. 199,576 180,025 179,686
Deferred income tax provision (benefit)............................ 414,295 (146,428) (215,677)
Amortization of deferred loan fees................................. (183,648) (183,649) (122,536)
Amortization of premiums and discounts, net........................ (116,045) (180,379) (327,984)
Adjustment of ESOP shares and release of shares under recognition
and retention plan............................................... 65,405 47,747 115,454
Provision for loan losses.......................................... 60,000 411,200 --
Net gains (losses) on sales of assets.............................. (47,600) 79,811 7,289
Increase in cash surrender value of life
insurance policies............................................... (200,301) (118,860) --
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
Accrued interest receivable...................................... 48,053 237,936 (198,424)
Other assets..................................................... 253,596 (581,240) 100,159
Deferred compensation............................................ 87,186 267,146 217,800
Special SAIF assessment payable.................................. (937,000) 937,000 --
Accrued expenses and other liabilities........................... 217,310 24,400 1,138,836
------------- ------------- -------------
Net cash provided by operating activities...................... 2,236,344 2,941,250 2,837,296
INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
Purchases of investment securities held-to-maturity.................. (8,460,626) (57,973,899) (66,492,165)
Proceeds from sale of securities available-for-sale.................. -- 15,788,567 --
Proceeds from maturities and principal repayments
of investment securities held-to-maturity.......................... 29,268,937 35,962,923 42,009,170
Increase in loans, net............................................... (24,817,073) (22,163,548) (13,238,991)
Proceeds from sale of loans.......................................... 2,155,506 1,320,713 751,990
Proceeds from sale of foreclosed real estate......................... 410,101 163,059 177,145
Purchase of life insurance policies.................................. -- (5,320,000) --
Purchases of premises and equipment.................................. (81,161) (297,335) (226,841)
------------- ------------- -------------
Net cash used by investing activities.......................... (1,524,316) (32,519,520) (37,019,692)
</TABLE>
(Continued)
F-6
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, 1996, AND 1995
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996 1995
---------------- ---------------- --------------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
Net increase (decrease) in deposits.......................... $ 27,071,488 $ 3,824,696 $ (948,777)
Federal Home Loan Bank advances.............................. 2,037,150,900 1,479,348,400 239,850,000
Repayment of Federal Home Loan Bank advances................. (2,073,770,768) (1,463,114,691) (78,084,610)
Net increase (decrease) in repurchase agreements............. 10,585,000 10,100,000 (119,430,000)
Decrease in amounts due for investments not settled.......... -- -- (7,204,556)
Exercise of stock options.................................... 78,300 145,940 --
Dividends paid............................................... (1,067,810) (539,685) (458,850)
---------------- ---------------- --------------
Net cash provided by financing activities.............. 47,110 29,764,660 33,723,207
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH
AND DUE FROM BANKS.......................................... 759,138 186,390 (459,189)
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS, BEGINNING OF YEAR................... 2,046,135 1,859,745 2,318,934
---------------- ---------------- --------------
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS, END OF YEAR......................... $ 2,805,273 $ 2,046,135 $ 1,859,745
---------------- ---------------- --------------
---------------- ---------------- --------------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
Cash paid during the period for:
Interest..................................................... $ 18,426,591 $ 18,528,748 $ 16,371,063
---------------- ---------------- --------------
---------------- ---------------- --------------
Income taxes................................................. $ 825,000 $ 870,000 $ 825,219
---------------- ---------------- --------------
---------------- ---------------- --------------
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF NONCASH INVESTMENT ACTIVITIES:
Transfers from loans to real estate acquired, or deemed
acquired, through foreclosure.............................. $ 294,241 $ 233,293 $ 87,659
---------------- ---------------- --------------
---------------- ---------------- --------------
Loans originated to finance the sale of real estate acquired
through foreclosure........................................ $ 349,446 $ 145,393 $ 205,239
---------------- ---------------- --------------
---------------- ---------------- --------------
</TABLE>
(Concluded)
See notes to consolidated financial statements.
F-7
<PAGE>
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATION AND
SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
YEARS ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 1997, 1996 AND 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Principles of Consolidation--The accompanying consolidated financial
statements include the accounts of Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan
Association (the "Association") and its wholly-owned subsidiaries, P.F.
Service, Inc. and Sun Realty, Inc. which provide real estate services.
All significant intercompany transactions have been eliminated in
consolidation. The Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company (the
"Company"), whose activity is not included in the accompanying financial
statements, owns 52.84% of the outstanding common stock of the
Association.
Use of Estimates--The preparation of financial statements in conformity
with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to
make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of
assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and
liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported
amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual
results could differ from those estimates.
Cash Equivalents--For the purpose of presentation in the consolidated
statements of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand
and in demand accounts at other depository institutions and short-term
liquid investments having a maturity at the time acquired of three
months or less.
Securities Held-to-Maturity--Bonds, notes and debentures for which the
Association has the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are
reported at cost, adjusted for the amortization of premiums and the
accretion of discounts, which are recognized in income using the
level-yield method over the assets' remaining lives, adjusted for
anticipated prepayments. Should other than a temporary decline in the
fair value of a security occur, the carrying value of such security
would be written down to market value by a charge to operations.
Loans Receivable--Loans receivable that management has the intent and
ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off
are reported at their outstanding principal adjusted for any charge-off,
the allowance for loan losses, and any deferred fees or costs on
originated loans and unamortized premiums or discounts on purchased
loans.
Discounts and premiums on purchased residential real estate loans are
amortized to income using the interest method over the remaining period
to contractual maturity, adjusted for anticipated prepayments. Discounts
and premiums on purchased consumer loans are recognized over the
expected lives of the loans using methods that approximate the interest
method.
Loan origination fees and certain direct origination costs are capitalized
and recognized as an adjustment of the yield of the related loan over
its contractual life.
The accrual of interest on impaired loans is discontinued when, in
management's opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet contractual
principal or interest obligations or where interest or principal is 90
days or more past due. When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status,
accrual of interest ceases and, in general, uncollected past due
interest (including interest applicable to prior reporting periods, if
any) is reversed and charged against current income. Therefore, interest
income is not recognized unless the financial condition
F-8
<PAGE>
and payment record of the borrower warrant the recognition of interest
income. Interest on loans that have been restructured is generally
accrued according to the renegotiated terms.
Allowance for Loan Losses--The allowance for loan losses is increased by
charges to income and decreased by charge-offs (net of recoveries). Loan
principal is charged against the allowance for loan losses when
management believes that the loss of the principal is probable. If, as a
result of loans charged off or increases in the size or risk
characteristics of the loan portfolio, the allowance is below the level
considered by management to be adequate to absorb future loan losses on
existing loans, the provision for loan losses is increased to the level
considered necessary to provide an adequate allowance. The allowance is
an amount that management believes will be adequate to absorb estimated
losses on existing loans that may become uncollectible, based on
evaluations of the collectibility of the loans. The evaluations take
into consideration such factors as changes in the nature and volume of
the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality, review of specific
problem loans and current economic conditions that may affect the
borrowers' ability to pay. Economic conditions may result in the
necessity to change the allowance quickly in order to react to
deteriorating financial conditions of the Association's borrowers. As a
result, additional provisions on existing loans may be required in the
future if borrowers' financial conditions deteriorate or if real estate
values decline.
Estimates of anticipated loan losses involve judgment. While in particular
periods the Association may sustain losses which are substantial relative
to the allowance for loan losses, it is the judgment of management that
the allowances for loan losses reflected in the consolidated statements of
financial condition are adequate to absorb estimated losses which may
exist in the current loan portfolio.
Foreclosed Real Estate--Real estate properties acquired through, or in
lieu of, loan foreclosure are initially recorded at fair value at the
date of foreclosure establishing a new cost basis. After foreclosure,
valuations are periodically performed by management and the real estate
is carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less cost to
sell. Revenue and expenses from operations and changes in the valuation
allowance are included in loss on foreclosed real estate.
Premises and Equipment--Land is carried at cost. Buildings and
improvements and furniture, fixtures, and equipment are carried at cost,
less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation for financial statement
purposes is computed using the straight-line method over the estimated
useful lives of the assets ranging from 3 to 40 years.
Income Taxes--Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recorded for
temporary differences between the book and tax bases of assets and
liabilities. Such amounts are reflected at currently enacted income tax
rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets or
liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax
laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are
adjusted through the provision for income taxes.
Interest Rate Risk--The Association's asset base is exposed to risk
including the risk resulting from changes in interest rates, market
values of collateral for borrowings and changes in the timing of cash
flows. The Association analyzes the effect of such risks by considering
the mismatch of the maturities of its assets and liabilities in the
current interest rate environment and the sensitivity of assets and
liabilities to changes in interest rates. The Association's management
has considered the effect of significant increases and decreases in
interest rates and believes such changes, if they occurred, would be
manageable and would not affect the ability of the Association to hold
its assets to maturity. However, the Association is exposed to
significant market risk in the event of significant and prolonged
interest rate changes, because fixed rate assets and certain variable rate
assets that are capped are funded with short-term liabilities.
F-9
<PAGE>
Financial Instruments--The Association is party to purchased interest
rate caps contracts in the management of its interest rate exposure.
Interest rate caps are matched with specific liabilities. Premiums paid
to acquire interest rate caps are carried at cost and amortized into
interest expense over the life of the cap. Income received is recorded
on a settlement basis. Payments received are recorded as a reduction of
interest expense on a settlement basis. All derivative financial
instruments held or issued by the Association are held or issued for
purposes other than trading. In the ordinary course of business, the
Association has entered into off-balance-sheet financial instruments
consisting of commitments to extend credit, commercial letters of
credit, and standby letters of credit. Such financial instruments are
recorded in the financial statements when they are funded or related
fees are incurred or received.
Earnings per Share--Earnings per share have been computed using the
weighted average number of shares of common stock outstanding. Common
stock equivalents have less than 3% dilutive effect. See Note 20.
Reclassifications--Certain 1996 and 1995 amounts have been reclassified to
conform to the 1997 presentation.
F-10
<PAGE>
2. FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The estimated fair value amounts of financial instruments have been
determined by the Association using available market information and
appropriate valuation methodologies. However, considerable judgment is
required to interpret market data to develop the estimates of fair
value. Accordingly, the estimates presented herein are not necessarily
indicative of the amounts the Association could realize in a current
market exchange. The use of different market assumptions and/or
estimation methodologies may have a material effect on the estimated
fair value amounts. The carrying amounts and estimated fair values of
financial instruments at September 30, 1997 and 1996, were as follows
(items which are not financial instruments are not included):
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
CARRYING ESTIMATED CARRYING ESTIMATED
AMOUNTS FAIR VALUE AMOUNTS FAIR VALUE
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Financial assets and liabilities:
Cash and due from banks....................... $ 2,805,273 $ 2,805,273 $ 2,046,135 $ 2,046,135
Cash surrender value of
life insurance............................... 5,639,161 5,639,161 5,438,860 5,438,860
Securities held-to-maturity................... 200,552,569 202,897,745 219,689,835 218,969,300
Loans receivable.............................. 161,849,001 167,482,954 139,087,284 139,920,668
Accrued interest receivable................... 2,229,531 2,229,531 2,277,584 2,277,584
Federal Home Loan Bank stock.................. 10,052,700 10,052,700 11,607,700 11,607,700
Interest rate caps............................ 441,936 148,194 836,563 668,806
Demand and savings deposits................... 35,073,337 35,073,337 34,425,102 34,425,102
Time deposits................................. 108,280,759 108,379,913 81,857,506 82,734,409
Federal Home Loan Bank advances............... 190,601,038 190,304,592 227,220,906 223,950,599
Securities sold under agreements to
repurchase................................... 20,685,000 20,685,000 10,100,000 10,100,000
Special SAIF premium assessment payable....... -- -- 937,000 937,000
Off-balance sheet assets
(liabilities) -
Interest rate swaps.......................... -- -- -- (31,498)
</TABLE>
For purposes of the above disclosures of estimated fair value, the
following assumptions were used. The estimated fair value for cash and
due from banks, cash surrender value of life insurance, accrued interest
receivable, and Federal Home Loan Bank stock is considered to
approximate cost due to the short-term nature of such instruments. The
estimated fair values for securities and interest rate swaps and caps
are based on quoted market values for the individual securities or for
equivalent securities. The fair value for loans is estimated by
discounting the future cash flows using the current rates the
Association would charge for similar such loans at the applicable date.
The estimated fair values for demand and savings deposits, and the
special SAIF premium assessment payable are based on the amount for
which they could be settled on demand. The estimated fair values for
time deposits and borrowed funds are based on estimates of the rate the
Association would pay on such deposits and borrowed funds at the
applicable date, applied for the time period until maturity. The
estimated fair values for other financial instruments and off-balance
sheet loan commitments approximate cost and are not considered
significant to this presentation.
F-11
<PAGE>
3. INVESTMENT SECURITIES
The amortized cost and estimated fair values of securities held-to-maturity
at September 30 are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997
GROSS GROSS ESTIMATED
AMORTIZED UNREALIZED UNREALIZED FAIR
COST GAINS LOSSES VALUE
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
U.S. Government agencies..................... $ 26,857,998 $ 229,148 $ (10,679) $ 27,076,467
State and municipal securities............... 4,859,006 89,216 -- 4,948,222
Mortgage backed securities................... 168,835,565 2,794,249 (756,758) 170,873,056
-------------- ------------ -------------- -------------
Total..................................... $ 200,552,569 $ 3,112,613 $ (767,437) $202,897,745
-------------- ------------ -------------- -------------
-------------- ------------ -------------- -------------
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1996
GROSS GROSS ESTIMATED
AMORTIZED UNREALIZED UNREALIZED FAIR
COST GAINS LOSSES VALUE
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
U.S. Government agencies...................... $ 39,871,262 $ 118,718 $ (234,173) $ 39,755,807
State and municipal securities................ 459,277 14,876 -- 474,153
Mortgage backed securities.................... 179,359,296 1,666,877 (2,286,833) 178,739,340
-------------- ------------ ------------- --------------
Total...................................... $ 219,689,835 $ 1,800,471 $ (2,521,006) $ 218,969,300
-------------- ------------ ------------- --------------
-------------- ------------ ------------- --------------
</TABLE>
All mortgage backed securities included in the Association's investment
portfolio were issued by government sponsored agencies. The amortized cost
and estimated fair value of debt securities at September 30, 1997, by
contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ
from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call
or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
ESTIMATED
AMORTIZED FAIR
COST VALUE
<S> <C> <C>
Due in one year or less.................................................... $ 506,247 $ 515,744
Due from one year to five years............................................ 19,283,642 19,393,949
Due from five years to ten years........................................... 7,148,186 7,249,524
Due after ten years........................................................ 4,778,929 4,865,472
-------------- --------------
Mortgage backed securities................................................. 168,835,565 170,873,056
$ 200,552,569 $ 202,897,745
-------------- --------------
-------------- --------------
</TABLE>
Securities with a carrying value of approximately $3,670,456 and $7,443,767
and a fair value of approximately $3,788,296 and $7,417,969 at September 30,
1997 and 1996, were pledged to collateralize public deposits.
F-12
<PAGE>
4. LOANS RECEIVABLE
Loans receivable at September 30 are summarized as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
<S> <C> <C>
Residential mortgage loans................................................. $ 135,724,070 $ 119,802,079
Consumer loans............................................................. 3,731,435 2,794,842
Commercial loans, including agriculture.................................... 22,393,496 16,490,363
Less:
Deferred loan fees, net................................................... (467,793) (481,691)
Allowance for loan losses................................................. (1,691,007) (1,733,980)
-------------- --------------
Loans receivable, net...................................................... $ 159,690,201 $ 136,871,613
-------------- --------------
-------------- --------------
</TABLE>
Residential mortgage loans are substantially all 1-4 family loans.
The Association originates adjustable rate mortgage loans to hold for
investment. The Association also originates 15 year and 30 year fixed
rate mortgage loans and sells substantially all new originations of such
loans to outside investors. Loans held for sale at September 30, 1997
and 1996, are considered by management to be immaterial. Such loans have
approximate market rates of interest.
The Association is not committed to lend additional funds to debtors whose
loans have been modified.
The Association grants real estate loans, primarily single-family
residential loans, and consumer and agricultural real estate loans,
primarily in the northeastern portion of Arkansas. Substantially all
loans are collateralized by real estate or consumer assets. Loans
collateralized by residential real estate mortgages comprise
approximately 85% of the net loan portfolio as of September 30, 1997.
The Association currently supplements the local mortgage loan demand by
investing in investment securities.
5. ACCRUED INTEREST RECEIVABLE
Accrued interest receivable at September 30 is summarized as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
<S> <C> <C>
Securities held-to-maturity.................................................. $ 938,070 $ 1,128,396
Loans receivable............................................................. 1,291,461 1,149,188
------------ ------------
TOTAL........................................................................ $ 2,229,531 $ 2,277,584
------------ ------------
------------ ------------
</TABLE>
F-13
<PAGE>
6. ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND FORECLOSED REAL ESTATE LOSSES
Activity in the allowance for losses on loans and foreclosed real estate for
the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995, is as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
FORECLOSED
LOANS REAL ESTATE
<S> <C> <C>
BALANCE, OCTOBER 1, 1994.................................... $ 1,330,498 $ 131,072
Charge-offs, net of recoveries............................. 26,211 (85,877)
------------ ----------
BALANCE, SEPTEMBER 30, 1995................................. 1,356,709 45,195
Provision for losses....................................... 411,200 --
Charge-offs, net of recoveries............................. (33,929) 3,332
------------ ----------
BALANCE, SEPTEMBER 30, 1996................................. 1,733,980 48,527
Provision for losses....................................... 60,000 --
Charge-offs, net of recoveries............................. (102,973) (5,240)
------------ ----------
BALANCE, SEPTEMBER 30, 1997................................. $ 1,691,007 $ 43,287
------------ ----------
------------ ----------
</TABLE>
Gross charge-offs and recoveries, are not material.
7. PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
Premises and equipment at September 30 are summarized as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
<S> <C> <C>
Cost:
Land............................................................... $ 332,476 $ 342,476
Buildings and improvements......................................... 1,937,912 1,852,502
Furniture, fixtures, and equipment................................. 1,373,813 1,396,884
----------- -----------
3,644,201 3,591,862
Less accumulated depreciation....................................... (1,839,369) (1,668,615)
----------- -----------
$ 1,804,832 $ 1,923,247
----------- -----------
----------- -----------
</TABLE>
8. DEPOSITS
Deposits at September 30 are summarized as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
<S> <C> <C>
Checking accounts, including noninterest-bearing deposits
of $2,697,858 and $1,975,823 in 1997 and 1996, respectively.............. $ 26,417,875 $ 26,381,406
Passbook savings........................................................... 8,655,462 8,043,696
Certificates of deposit.................................................... 108,280,759 81,857,506
-------------- --------------
TOTAL...................................................................... $ 143,354,096 $ 116,282,608
-------------- --------------
-------------- --------------
</TABLE>
F-14
<PAGE>
The aggregate amount of short-term jumbo certificates of deposit with a
minimum denomination of $100,000 was approximately $20,411,446 and
$11,325,243 at September 30, 1997 and 1996. Deposits in excess of $100,000
are not covered by federal deposit insurance.
At September 30, 1997, scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit are
as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
YEARS ENDING SEPTEMBER 30: TOTAL
<S> <C>
1998 .............................................................. $ 89,359,861
1999 .............................................................. 15,983,268
2000 .............................................................. 2,083,391
2001 .............................................................. 180,723
2002 .............................................................. 673,516
--------------
TOTAL ............................................................. $ 108,280,759
--------------
--------------
</TABLE>
Interest expense on deposits for the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996,
and 1995, is summarized as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996 1995
<S> <C> <C> <C>
Checking.......................................................... $ 611,594 $ 569,817 $ 596,197
Passbook savings.................................................. 247,173 229,227 231,764
Certificates of deposit........................................... 5,080,331 4,581,033 4,687,386
------------ ------------ ------------
TOTAL............................................................. $ 5,939,098 $ 5,380,077 $ 5,515,347
------------ ------------ ------------
------------ ------------ ------------
</TABLE>
9. FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK ADVANCES
THE ASSOCIATION IS REQUIRED TO PURCHASE STOCK IN THE FHLB. Such stock
may be redeemed at par but is not readily marketable. At September 30,
1997 and 1996, the Association had stock of $10,052,700 and $11,607,700,
respectively. Pursuant to collateral agreements with the FHLB, advances
are collateralized by all of the Association's stock in the FHLB and by
65% of qualifying single family first mortgage loans with a carrying
value at September 30, 1997 and 1996, of approximately $130,000,000 and
$112,000,000, respectively, and investment securities having a carrying
value of $117,370,552 and $182,569,810 at September 30, 1997 and 1996,
respectively. Advances at September 30, 1997 and 1996, have maturity
dates as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997
---------------------------
WEIGHTED
AVERAGE
RATE AMOUNT
<S> <C> <C>
September 30:
1998 .................................................... 5.62% $ 157,601,038
1999 .................................................... 5.66 33,000,000
2000 .................................................... -- --
2001 .................................................... -- --
2002 .................................................... -- --
--------------
TOTAL .................................................... $ 190,601,038
--------------
--------------
</TABLE>
F-15
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1996
----------------------------
WEIGHTED
AVERAGE
RATE AMOUNT
<S> <C> <C>
September 30:
1997 ..................................................... 5.42% $ 128,478,000
1998 ..................................................... 5.58 52,742,906
1999 ..................................................... 5.02 23,000,000
2000 ..................................................... -- --
2001 ..................................................... 4.99 23,000,000
--------------
TOTAL ..................................................... $ 227,220,906
--------------
--------------
</TABLE>
Interest expense on FHLB advances was $11,732,367, $13,128,761, and
$6,827,660 for the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995,
respectively.
10. SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase ("Reverse Repurchase
Agreements") are as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
<S> <C> <C>
Balance outstanding at September 30........................................... $ 20,685,000 $ 10,100,000
Average balance during the year............................................... 17,684,231 2,940,167
Average interest rate during the year......................................... 5.81% 5.59%
Maximum month-end balance during the year..................................... 21,060,000 10,525,000
Investment securities underlying the
agreements at September 30:
Carrying value............................................................... 21,155,072 10,414,998
Estimated market value....................................................... 21,304,348 10,305,887
</TABLE>
Interest expense on Reverse Repurchase Agreements was $1,027,337,
$119,504, and $4,824,226 for the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996,
and 1995, respectively.
11. DEFERRED COMPENSATION
The Association has funded and unfunded deferred compensation agreements
with an executive and non-officer members of the Board of Directors. The
plans limit the ability of the executive to compete with the Association
and require that the directors continue to serve for a specified period
of time. The amount of expense related to such plans for the years ended
September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995, was approximately $190,000, $355,000
and $218,000, respectively.
F-16
<PAGE>
12. RETIREMENT PLAN AND EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN
The Association has a defined contribution retirement plan. The plan
covers all employees who have accumulated two years with 1,000 hours of
service in each year. A flat percentage rate, selected at the discretion
of the Board of Directors is applied to the base salary of each eligible
employee. The retirement plan expense for the years ended September 30,
1997, 1996, and 1995, was $125,000, $116,109, and $92,024, respectively.
The Association has an Employee Stock Ownership Plan ("ESOP"). The ESOP
has borrowed funds which are collateralized by common stock of the
Association and a guaranty of the Company. The borrowing is included on
the Association's statements of financial condition as a liability and
as a corresponding reduction of stockholders' equity. The Association's
expense related to the ESOP was $171,061, $152,397 and $104,650 for the
years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995 respectively.
The Association also has a supplemental retirement plan for two
executive officers. The plan requires that a set amount be deposited
into a trust each year until the executive officers reach 60 years of
age. The amount of expense related to such plans for the years ended
September 30, 1997 and 1996, was approximately $235,000 and $213,000,
respectively.
13. INCOME TAXES
The Association and subsidiaries file consolidated federal income tax
returns. If certain conditions are met in determining taxable income,
the Association is allowed a special bad-debt deduction based on a
percentage of its savings and loan taxable income or on specified
experience formulas. The Association used the
percentage-of-taxable-income method for the years ended September 30,
1997, 1996, and 1995.
Income tax expense for the years ended September 30 is summarized as
follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996 1995
------------ ---------- ------------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
Current................................................................... $ 930,195 $ 532,810 $ 1,216,458
Deferred.................................................................. 414,295 (146,428) (215,677)
------------ ---------- ------------
TOTAL..................................................................... $ 1,344,490 $ 386,382 $ 1,000,781
------------ ---------- ------------
------------ ---------- ------------
</TABLE>
The net deferred tax asset, which is included in other assets, consisted of
the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996
<S> <C> <C>
Deferred tax assets:
Deferred compensation................................................................... $ 383,610 $ 292,400
Special SAIF assessment................................................................. -- 318,580
Bad debt reserves....................................................................... 195,568 201,402
Deferred loan fees...................................................................... 42,495 71,351
Other................................................................................... 48,056 57,675
---------- ----------
Total deferred tax assets............................................................. 669,729 941,408
Deferred tax liabilities:
FHLB stock dividends.................................................................... (587,049) (349,127)
Other................................................................................... (16,465) (111,771)
---------- ----------
Total deferred tax liabilities........................................................ (603,514) (460,898)
Valuation allowance...................................................................... -- --
---------- ----------
Net deferred tax asset................................................................... $ 66,215 $ 480,510
---------- ----------
---------- ----------
</TABLE>
F-17
<PAGE>
The income tax provision differed from the amounts computed by applying
the federal and state income tax rates as a result of the following:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997 1996 1995
------------------------ --------------------- ------------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Expected income tax expense......................... 38.3% $ 1,424,765 38.3% $ 901,170 38.3% $ 1,127,350
Exempt income....................................... (1.5) (54,618) (6.1) (143,203) (0.4) (10,743)
Cash surrender value of life insurance.............. (2.0) (73,096)
State tax, net of federal benefit................... 1.6 60,127
Reduction in valuation allowance.................... (5.5) (129,184) (2.1) (60,527)
Change in estimate.................................. (0.3) (12,688) (10.3) (242,401) (1.9) (55,299)
------- ----------- ----- --------- ------- -----------
TOTAL............................................... 36.1% $ 1,344,490 16.4% $ 386,382 33.9% $ 1,000,781
------- ----------- ----- --------- ------- -----------
------- ----------- ----- --------- ------- -----------
</TABLE>
The Association provides for the recognition of a deferred tax asset or
liability for the future tax consequences of differences in carrying
amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities. Specifically exempted
from this provision are bad debt reserves for tax purposes of U.S.
savings and loan associations in the Association's base year, as
defined. Base year reserves total approximately $2,979,000 at September
30, 1997. Consequently, a deferred tax liability of approximately
$1,013,000 related to such reserves is not provided for in the statement
of financial condition at September 30, 1997.
14. REGULATORY MATTERS
The Association is subject to various regulatory capital requirements
administered by the federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum
capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory--and possibly
additional discretionary--actions by regulators that, if undertaken,
could have a direct material effect on the Association's financial
statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory
framework for prompt corrective action, the Association must meet
specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the
Association's assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items
as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The Association's
capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative
judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other
factors.
Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital
adequacy require the Association to maintain minimum amounts and ratios
(set forth in the table below) of tangible and core capital (as defined
in the regulations) to adjusted total assets (as defined), and of total
capital (as defined) to risk weighted assets (as defined). Management
believes, as of September 30, 1997, that the Association meets all
capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject.
Prior to September 30, 1997, the most recent notification from the
Office of Thrift Supervision ("OTS") categorized the Association as well
capitalized under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action.
To be categorized as well capitalized the Association must maintain
minimum total, tangible, and core capital ratios as set forth in the
table below.
F-18
<PAGE>
The Association's actual capital amounts and ratios are also presented in
the table (in thousands):
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
REQUIRED
FOR CAPITAL
ACTUAL ADEQUACY
--------------- PURPOSES
ACTUAL -------------
AMOUNT RATIO AMOUNT RATIO
------- ------ ------ -----
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
As of September 30, 1997:
Tangible capital to adjusted total assets................. $24,245 6.32% $5,754 1.50%
Core capital to adjusted total assets..................... 24,245 6.32 11,509 3.00
Total capital to risk weighted assets..................... 25,913 16.22 12,781 8.00
Tier I capital to risk weighted assests................... 24,245 15.18 6,389 4.00
As of September 30, 1996:
Tangible capital to adjusted total assets................. $22,783 5.97% $5,722 1.50%
Core capital to adjusted total assets..................... 22,783 5.97 11,444 3.00
Total capital to risk weighted assets..................... 24,428 16.75 11,660 8.00
Tier I capital to risk weighted assests................... 22,783 15.63 5,830 4.00
<CAPTION>
REQUIRED TO BE
CATEGORIZED AS
WELL
CAPITALIZED
UNDER
PROMPT
CORRECTIVE
ACTION
PROVISIONS
--------------
AMOUNT RATIO
------ ------
<S> <C> <C>
As of September 30, 1997:
Tangible capital to adjusted total assets................. N/A N/A
Core capital to adjusted total assets..................... $19,181 5.00%
Total capital to risk weighted assets..................... 15,976 10.00
Tier I capital to risk weighted assests................... 9,583 6.00
As of September 30, 1996:
Tangible capital to adjusted total assets................. N/A N/A
Core capital to adjusted total assets..................... $22,888 5.00%
Total capital to risk weighted assets..................... 14,575 10.00
Tier I capital to risk weighted assests................... 8,745 6.00
</TABLE>
A reconciliation of GAAP capital by regulatory capital is presented in
the following table as of September 30, 1997.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
TANGIBLE CORE TOTAL
CAPITAL CAPITAL CAPITAL
-------- -------- -------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
GAAP capital..................... $ 24,246 $ 24,246 $24,246
Regulatory general valuation..... 1,667
-------- -------- -------
Regulatory capital............... $ 24,246 $ 24,246 $25,913
-------- -------- -------
-------- -------- -------
</TABLE>
15. DIVIDENDS
During the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995, the Association
declared dividends of $0.885, $0.77 and $0.59 per common share, respectively.
Cash dividends of $1,067,810, $583,862, and $574,713 were paid or accrued to be
paid in the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995, respectively. The
Company waived dividends of $375,188, $664,125 and $375,187 in the years ended
September 30, 1997, 1996, and 1995, respectively, (see Note 19).
16. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
In the ordinary course of business, the Association and subsidiaries have
various outstanding commitments and contingent liabilities that are not
reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. In addition,
the Association is a defendant in certain claims and legal actions arising in
the ordinary course of business. In the opinion of management, after
consultation with legal counsel, the ultimate disposition of these matters is
not expected to have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial
statements of the Association and subsidiaries.
17. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
The Association is a party to financial instruments with off-balance
sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of
its customers and to reduce its own exposure to fluctuations in interest
rates. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit,
standby letters of credit and financial guarantees, interest-rate swaps, and
futures contracts. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of
credit and interest-rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the
consolidated statements of financial condition. The contract or notional
amounts of those instruments reflect the extent of the Association's
involvement in particular classes of financial instruments.
F-19
<PAGE>
The Association's exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by
the other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit,
standby letters of credit, and financial guarantees written is represented by
the contractual notional amount of those instruments. The Association uses the
same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it
does for on-balance sheet instruments. For interest-rate swap transactions,
forward and futures contracts, the contract or notional amounts do not represent
exposure to credit loss. The Association controls the credit risk of its
interest-rate swap agreements and forward and futures contracts through credit
approvals, limits, and monitoring procedures.
Unless noted otherwise, the Association does not require collateral or other
security to support financial instruments with credit risk.
INTEREST-RATE EXCHANGE AGREEMENTS--The Association enters into interest-rate
swap transactions to manage its interest-rate exposure. Interest-rate swap
transactions generally involve the exchange of fixed-and floating-rate
interest-payment obligations without the exchange of the underlying principal
amounts. Entering into interest-rate swap agreements involves not only the risk
of dealing with counterparties and their ability to meet the terms of the
contracts but also the interest-rate risk associated with unmatched positions.
Notional principal amounts often are used to express the volume of these
transactions, but the amounts potentially subject to credit risk are much
smaller. During the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995 the
Association was a counter-party in an agreement to assume fixed-rate interest
rate interest payments in exchange for variable market-indexed interest payments
(interest-rate swaps). The notional principal amounts of the interest-rate swap
outstanding was $12,000,000 at September 30, 1996. The original term was two
years. The fixed-payment rates were 6.06% at September 30, 1996. Variable-
interest payments received are based on the three-month LIBOR. The effect of
these agreements was to lengthen short-term variable-rate liabilities into
longer-term fixed-rate liabilities. The net cost of this agreement was $51,900
$56,611 and $711 for the years ended September 30, 1997, 1996 and 1995,
respectively.
INTEREST-RATE CAPS--The Association purchases interest rate caps in order
manage its interest rate risk exposure. As of September 30, 1997, the
Association was party to the following interest rate cap positions.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
NOTIONAL AMOUNT EXPIRATION DATE CAP RATE INDEX RATE
- ---------------- ---------------------- ------------- ----------------------
<S> <C> <C> <C>
$ 10,000,000 December 20, 1998 6.0% Three-month Libor
$ 10,000,000 June 20, 1999 6.0% Three-month Libor
$ 10,000,000 June 30, 1999 6.0% Three-month Libor
$ 10,000,000 December 31, 1999 6.0% Three-month Libor
</TABLE>
Commitments to Extend Credit and Financial Guarantees--Commitments to
extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no
violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally
have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require
payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire
without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily
represent future cash requirements. The Association evaluates each customer's
creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained,
if it is deemed necessary by the Association upon extension of credit, is
based on management's credit evaluation of the counterparty.
Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the
Association to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. The
credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially
F-20
<PAGE>
the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The
Association holds marketable securities as collateral supporting these
commitments for which collateral is deemed necessary.
At September 30, 1997, the Association had the following outstanding
commitments to extend credit:
<TABLE>
<S> <C>
Undisbursed loans in process................................................... $2,814,983
Unfunded lines of credit....................................................... 1,933,675
Outstanding loan commitments................................................... 6,514,061
-----------
Total outstanding commitments............................................ $11,262,719
-----------
-----------
</TABLE>
The Association has not incurred any losses on its commitments in any of the
three years in the period ended September 30, 1997.
At September 30, 1997, commitments to fund fixed rate loans totaled $2.9
million with interest rates ranging from 5.95% to 10.0%
18. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
In the normal course of business, the Association has made loans to its
directors, officers, and their related business interests. In the opinion of
management, related party loans are made on substantially the same terms,
including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for
comparable transactions with unrelated persons and do not involve more than the
normal risk of collectibility. The aggregate dollar amount of loans outstanding
to directors, officers and their related business interests total approximately
$857,176 and $798,679 at September 30, 1997 and 1996, respectively.
19. CUMULATIVE WAIVED DIVIDENDS TO MAJORITY STOCKHOLDER
The Company filed notices with the OTS requesting approval to waive its
right to receive cash dividends declared by the Association for each declared
dividend beginning in the quarter ended June 30, 1994. The OTS did not object to
the dividend waiver request subject to the following conditions: (1) for as long
as the Association is controlled by the Company, the amount of dividends waived
by the Company must be considered as a restriction on retained earnings of the
Association; (2) the amount of the dividend waived by the Company shall be
available for declaration as a dividend solely to the Company; (3) the amount of
the dividend waived by the Company must be considered as having been paid by the
Association in evaluating any proposed dividend. In addition, the OTS may
rescind its non-objection to the waiver of dividends if, based on subsequent
developments, the proposed waivers are determined to be detrimental to the safe
and sound operation of the Association.
If management determines that it is probable that the waived dividends will
be paid, it will be necessary to record a liability in accordance with Statement
of Financial Accounting Standards No. 5. In management's opinion it is not
probable that the waived dividends will be paid, therefore, a liability has not
been recorded in the financial statements of the Association. The cumulative
unpaid dividends are classified as restricted retained earnings.
20. STOCK OPTION PLANS
The Association has two stock option plans. The plans granted options prior
to October 1, 1995 for 70,476 shares at the fair value of the stock at the date
of grant, which was $10 per share. At October 1, 1995, 70,476 shares remained
unexercised. During the years ended September 30, 1997 and 1996, 7,830 and
14,594 options were exercised, respectively. At September 30, 1997, 48,052
remain unexercised of which, 33,102 were exercisable. The remaining options vest
ratably until April 1999, at which time they become 100% vested. Options
available for grant under the plans total 4,274 shares at September 30,
F-21
<PAGE>
1997. Such options are reserved for future board members and vest ratably at
20% each year beginning with the year of grant.
21. SPECIAL SAIF ASSESSMENT
The Deposit Insurance Funds Act of 1996 required a special one-time
assessment on Savings Association Insurance Fund ("SAIF") assessable deposits of
65.7 basis points (.657%) to capitalize the SAIF. The special assessment was
based on deposits as of March 31, 1995, as reported on the Association's Thrift
Financial Report. The assessment was charged to operations and recorded as a
liability as of September 30, 1996.
22. RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
In October 1995, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK-BASED
COMPENSATION ("SFAS 123"). SFAS 123 establishes financial accounting and
reporting standards for stock-based compensation plans. Those plans include all
arrangements by which employees receive shares of stock or other equity
instruments of the employer. SFAS No. 123 defines a fair value based method of
accounting for an employee stock option or similar equity instrument. Under the
fair value based method, compensation cost is measured at the grant date based
on the value of the award and is recognized over the service period, which is
usually the vesting period. Accounting Principles Board ("APB") Opinion 25,
requires compensation cost for stock-based employee compensation plans to be
recognized based on the difference, if any, between the quoted market price of
the stock and the amount an employee must pay to acquire the stock. SFAS No. 123
permits an entity in determining its net income to continue to apply the
accounting provisions of APB Opinion 25 to its stock-based employee compensation
arrangements. An entity that continues to apply APB Opinion 25 must comply with
the disclosure requirements of SFAS 123. SFAS 123 is effective for fiscal years
beginning after December 15, 1995. The Association adopted SFAS 123 and it did
not have a material effect on the Association's consolidated financial
statements.
The FASB has issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 125,
ACCOUNTING FOR TRANSFERS AND SERVICING OF FINANCIAL ASSETS AND EXTINGUISHMENTS
OF LIABILITIES, ("SFAS 125"), as amended by SFAS No. 127. This statement
provides accounting and reporting standards for transfers and servicing of
financial assets and extinguishments of liabilities. The statement is effective
for transfers and servicing of financial assets and extinguishments of
liabilities occurring after December 31, 1996. SFAS 127 delayed the effective
date of certain provisions of SFAS 125 until December 31, 1997. The adoption of
SFAS 125, as amended by SFAS 127, is not expected to have a material effect on
the Assoication's consolidated financial statements.
In February 1997, the FASB issued Statement No. 128, "Earnings Per Share"
("SFAS 128"). SFAS 128 establishes standards for computing and presenting
earnings per share ("EPS"), simplifying the standards previously found in APB
Opinion No. 15, "Earnings Per Share." The current presentation of primary EPS
is replaced with a presentation of basic EPS. Dual presentation of basic and
diluted EPS will be required on the face of the income statement as well as a
reconciliation of the numerator and denominator of the basic EPS computation to
the numerator and denominator of the diluted EPS computation. Basic EPS excludes
dilution and is computed by dividing income available to common stockholders by
the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted
EPS is computed similarly to fully diluted EPS pursuant to APB Opinion No. 15.
Also in February 1997, the FASB issued Statement No. 129, "Disclosure of
Information about Capital Structure", establishing standards for disclosing
information abut an entity's capital structure. SFAS 129 calls for summary form
information regarding rights and privileges of various securities outstanding
and other capital instrument information. SFAS 128 and 129
F-22
<PAGE>
are effective for financial statements issued for periods ending after
December 15, 1997, including interim periods. The adoption of SFAS 128 and
129 is not expected to have a material effect on the Association's
consolidated financial statements.
In June 1997, the FASB issued Statement No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive
Income" ("SFAS 130"). SFAS 130 establishes standards to reporting and display of
comprehensive income and its components. SFAS 130 requires that all items that
are required to be recognized under accounting standards as components of
comprehensive income be reported in a financial statement that is displayed with
the same prominence as other financial statements. The Association will be
required to classify items of other comprehensive income by their nature in a
financial statement and display the accumulated balance of other comprehensive
income separately from retained earnings and additional paid-in capital in the
equity section of the statement of financial condition. Also in June 1997, the
FASB issued Statement No. 131, "Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and
Related Information", establishing standards for the way public enterprises
report information about operating segments in interim financial reports issued
to shareholders. It also establishes standards for related disclosures about
products and services, geographic areas, and major customers. SFAS 130 and 131
are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 1997, with
reclassification of earlier periods. The adoption of SFAS 130 and 131 is not
expected to have a material effect on the Association's consolidated financial
statements.
23. EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS
The Association has entered into employment agreements with three
executive officers. If an officer is dismissed without cause or in the event
of change in control the Association may be obligated to continue the
officers' salary for a period of up to three years.
24. BRANCH ACQUISITION
On August 21, 1997 the Association entered into an agreement with
NationsBank, N.A., a national banking association, ("NationsBank") whereby the
Association agreed to purchase the fixed assets and assume the deposits of the
NationsBank branches located in Hardy, Lake City, and Walnut Ridge, Arkansas.
The transaction is pending regulatory approval. The Association agreed to pay a
premium of 5.87% of the deposit liabilities located at the Hardy and Walnut
Ridge branches and 7.51% of the deposit liabilities at Lake City.
The dollar amount of deposit liabilities purchased will be determined on the
date of closing.
25. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
On October 14, 1997, the Board of Directors of the Company adopted a plan
of conversion (the "Plan") of Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company into
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc., a capital stock corporation organized under
Delaware law (the "Holding Company"). The purpose of the conversion is to
convert the Mutual Holding Company to the capital stock form of organization,
which is intended to provide the Holding Company and the Association with
greater flexibility and capital resources to respond to changing regulatory
and market conditions and to effect corporate transactions, including mergers
and acquisitions.
The plan was adopted by the Board of Directors of the Company, and must also
be approved by (i) a majority of the total number of votes entitled to be cast
by Voting Members of the Company at a Special Meeting of Members to be called
for that purpose, and (ii) at least two-thirds of the outstanding common stock
of the Association at the Special Meeting of Stockholders, including at least a
majority of the votes
F-23
<PAGE>
cast, in person or by proxy, of the Minority Stockholders. Prior to the
submission of the Plan to the Voting Members and stockholders of the
Association for consideration, the Plan must be approved by the OTS.
The plan of conversion provides for the establishment, upon the
completion of the conversion, of a special liquidation account for the
benefit of eligible account holders and the supplemental eligible account
holders in an amount equal the net worth of the Association as of the date of
its latest statement of financial condition contained in the final offering
circular used in connection with the conversion. The liquidation account will
be maintained for the benefit of eligible account holders and supplemental
eligible account holders who continue to maintain their accounts in the
Association after conversion. In the event of a complete liquidation (and
only in such event), each eligible and supplemental eligible account holder
will be entitled to receive a liquidation distribution from the liquidation
account in an amount proportionate to the current adjusted qualifying
balances for accounts then held.
The Association may not declare or pay cash dividends on its shares of
common stock if the effect thereof would cause the Association's
stockholders' equity to be reduced below applicable regulatory capital
maintenance requirements for insured institutions or below the special
liquidation account referred to above.
Conversion costs will be deferred and deducted from the proceeds of the
shares sold in the conversion. If the conversion is not completed, all costs
will be charged to expense. Conversion costs incurred through September 30,
1997 were immaterial.
26. QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)
The following tables represent summarized data for each of the four quarters
in the years ended September 30, 1997 and 1996:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1997
----
FOURTH THIRD SECOND FIRST
QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Interest income.......................................... $ 6,663,462 $ 6,592,792 $ 6,360,775 $ 6,476,148
Interest expense......................................... 4,830,954 4,711,491 4,540,067 4,616,290
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Net interest income...................................... 1,832,508 1,881,301 1,820,708 1,859,858
Provision for loan losses................................ -- -- 30,000 30,000
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Net interest income after provision for loan losses...... 1,832,508 1,881,301 1,790,708 1,829,858
Non-interest income...................................... 391,666 291,452 315,158 352,906
Non-interest expense..................................... 1,387,640 1,178,784 1,115,768 1,283,358
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Income before income taxes............................... 836,534 993,969 990,098 899,406
Income tax expense....................................... 309,713 371,480 347,903 315,394
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Net income............................................... $ 526,821 $ 622,489 $ 642,195 $ 584,012
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Earnings per common share................................ $ 0.33 $ 0.38 $ 0.39 $ 0.36
Cash dividends declared per common share................. $ 0.225 $ 0.225 $ 0.225 $ 0.21
Average common shares and common stock equivalents
outstanding............................................ 1,632,424 1,629,686 1,628,367 1,625,561
</TABLE>
F-24
<PAGE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
1996
----
FOURTH THIRD SECOND FIRST
QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
<S> <C> <C> <C> <C>
Interest income.......................................... $ 6,517,861 $ 6,457,416 $ 6,196,528 $ 6,245,224
Interest expense......................................... 4,602,865 4,696,358 4,671,957 4,657,162
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Net interest income...................................... 1,914,996 1,761,057 1,524,571 1,588,062
Provision for loan losses................................ 220,000 105,000 30,000 56,200
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Net interest income after provision for loan losses...... 1,694,996 1,656,057 1,494,571 1,531,862
Non-interest income...................................... 704,065 336,067 117,549 368,523
Non-interest expense..................................... 2,131,049 1,310,668 1,062,783 1,046,268
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Income before income taxes............................... 268,011 681,457 549,338 854,117
Income tax (benefit) expense............................. (154,773) 153,565 39,634 347,956
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Net income............................................... $ 442,784 $
527,892 $ 509,704 $ 506,161
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
Earnings per common share................................ $ 0.27 $ 0.33 $ 0.32 $ 0.31
Cash dividends declared per common share................. $ 0.21 $ 0.20 $ 0.19 $ 0.17
Average common shares and common stock equivalents
outstanding............................................ 1,624,541 1,617,996 1,617,400 1,610,000
* * * * * *
</TABLE>
F-25
<PAGE>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NO DEALER, SALESMAN OR ANY OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATION OTHER THAN AS CONTAINED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFERING MADE HEREBY, AND, IF GIVEN OR
MADE, SUCH OTHER INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATION MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS
HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY POCAHONTAS BANCORP, INC., THE BANK OR FBR. THIS
PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER
TO BUY ANY OF THE SECURITIES OFFERED HEREBY TO ANY PERSON IN ANY JURISDICTION
IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED OR IN WHICH THE PERSON
MAKING SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO, OR TO ANY PERSON
WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IN SUCH JURISDICTION.
NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE HEREUNDER SHALL UNDER
ANY CIRCUMSTANCES CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE
AFFAIRS OF POCAHONTAS BANCORP, INC. OR THE BANK SINCE ANY OF THE DATES AS OF
WHICH INFORMATION IS FURNISHED HEREIN OR SINCE THE DATE HEREOF.
------------------------
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
---------
Summary.........................................................
Selected Consolidated Financial and Other Data of the Bank and
Subsidiary....................................................
Risk Factors....................................................
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.........................................
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association.................
Historical Pro Forma Capital Compliance.........................
Use of Proceeds.................................................
Dividend Policy.................................................
Market for the Common Stock.....................................
Capitalization..................................................
Pro Forma Data..................................................
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations.....................................
Business of the Bank............................................
Regulation and Supervision......................................
Federal and State Taxation......................................
Management of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc...........................
Management of the Bank..........................................
Beneficial Ownership of the Bank's Common Stock and Expected
Beneficial Ownership of the Company's Common Stock............
The Conversion..................................................
Restrictions on the Acquisition of the Company and the Bank.....
Description of Capital Stock of the Company.....................
Description of Capital Stock of the Bank........................
Transfer Agent and Registrar....................................
Experts.........................................................
Legal Opinions..................................................
Additional Information..........................................
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements...................... F-1
------------------------
UNTIL MARCH , 1998 OR 25 DAYS AFTER COMMENCEMENT OF THE SYNDICATED
COMMUNITY OFFERING, IF ANY, WHICHEVER IS LATER, ALL DEALERS EFFECTING
TRANSACTIONS IN THE REGISTERED SECURITIES, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN
THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS
UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OF SUBSCRIPTIONS.
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
UP TO 2,875,000 SHARES
(ANTICIPATED MAXIMUM)
POCAHONTAS
BANCORP, INC.
(PROPOSED HOLDING COMPANY FOR
POCAHONTAS FEDERAL SAVINGS
AND LOAN ASSOCIATION
COMMON STOCK
PAR VALUE $.01 PER SHARE
---------------------
PROSPECTUS
---------------------
FRIEDMAN, BILLINGS,
RAMSEY & CO., INC.
February , 1998
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>
PART II: INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 16. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules:
The exhibits and financial statement schedules filed as part of this
registration statement are as follows:
(a) List of Exhibits
1.1 Engagement Letter between Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
and Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc.**
1.2 Form of Agency Agreement among Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc., Pocahontas
Federal Savings and Loan Association, and Friedman, Billings, Ramsey &
Co., Inc.**
2 Plan of Conversion and Reorganization**
3.1 Certificate of Incorporation of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (Incorporated
herein by reference to Exhibit D of the Plan of Conversion and
Reorganization)
3.2 Bylaws of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (Incorporated herein by reference to
Exhibit E of the Plan of Conversion and Reorganization)
4 Form of Common Stock Certificate of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.**
5 Opinion of Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, P.C. regarding legality
of securities being registered**
8.1 Federal Tax Opinion of Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, P.C.
8.2 State Tax Opinion of Deloitte & Touche, LLP**
8.3 Letter from RP Financial, LC with respect to Subscription Rights**
10.1 Employment Agreement for Skip Martin**
10.2 Employment Agreement for James A. Edington**
10.3 Employment Agreement for Dwayne Powell**
10.4 Restated Supplemental Retirement Income Agreement for Skip Martin**
10.5 Restated Supplemental Retirement Income Agreement for
James A. Edington**
10.6 Supplemental Retirement Income Agreement for Dwayne Powell**
10.7 1994 Incentive Stock Option Plan**
10.8 1994 Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors**
10.9 1994 Recognition and Retention Plan for Employees**
10.10 1994 Recognition and Retention Plan for Outside Directors**
10.11 401(K) Savings and Employee Stock Ownership Plan**
21 Subsidiaries of the Registrant**
23.1 Consent of Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, P.C. (contained in
opinion filed as Exhibit 5)
23.2 Consent of Deloitte & Touche, LLP
<PAGE>
23.3 Consent of RP Financial, LC**
23.4* Consent of Deloitte & Touche, LLP (contained in opinion filed as Exhibit
8.2)
24 Power of Attorney (set forth on Signature Page)
27 EDGAR Financial Data Schedule**
99.1 Appraisal Agreement between Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan
Association and RP Financial, LC**
99.2 Appraisal Report of RP Financial, LC**
99.3 Proxy Statement**
99.4 Marketing Materials**
99.5 Order and Acknowledgment Form**
- ----------
* To be filed supplementally or by amendment.
** Previously filed.
(b) Financial Statement Schedules
No financial statement schedules are filed because the required
information is not applicable or is included in the consolidated financial
statements or related notes.
Item 17. Undertakings
The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes:
(1) To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being
made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement:
(i) To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the
Securities Act of 1933;
(ii) To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising after
the effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent
post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the
aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set
forth in the registration statement;
(iii) To include any material information with respect to the plan
of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration
statement or any material change to such information in the
registration statement.
(2) That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the
Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be
a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the
offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona
fide offering thereof.
(3) To remove from registration by means of post-effective amendment
any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of
the offering.
(4) To provide to the underwriter at the closing specified in the
underwriting agreements, certificates in such denominations and registered in
such names as required by the underwriter to permit prompt delivery to each
purchaser.
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the
Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling
persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise,
the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and
Exchange Commission such indemnification is
<PAGE>
against public policy as expressed in the Act, and is, therefore, unenforceable.
In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other
than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director,
officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any
action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling
person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will,
unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling
precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the questions whether
such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and
will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
<PAGE>
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the registrant
has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in Pocahontas, Arkansas on February 2,
1997.
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
By: /s/ Skip Martin
---------------------------------------
Skip Martin
President and Chief Executive Officer
(Duly Authorized Representative)
POWER OF ATTORNEY
We, the undersigned directors and officers of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
(the "Company") hereby severally constitute and appoint Skip Martin as our true
and lawful attorney and agent, to do any and all things in our names in the
capacities indicated below which said Skip Martin may deem necessary or
advisable to enable the Company to comply with the Securities Act of 1933, and
any rules, regulations and requirements of the Securities and Exchange
Commission, in connection with the registration statement on Form S-1 relating
to the offering of the Company's Common Stock, including specifically, but not
limited to, power and authority to sign for us in our names in the capacities
indicated below the registration statement and any and all amendments (including
post-effective amendments) thereto; and we hereby approve, ratify and confirm
all that said Skip Martin shall do or cause to be done by virtue thereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
registration statement has been signed below by the following persons in the
capacities and as of the dates indicated.
Signatures Title Date
- ---------- ----- ----
/s/ Skip Martin President, Chief Executive February 2, 1998
- ------------------------ Officer and Director (Principal
Skip Martin Executive Officer)
/s/ James A. Edington Executive Vice President and February 2, 1998
- ------------------------ Director
James A. Edington
/s/ Dwayne Powell Senior Vice President and February 2, 1998
- ------------------------ Chief Financial Officer (Principal
Dwayne Powell Financial and Accounting Officer)
/s/ Ralph P. Baltz Chairman February 2, 1998
- ------------------------
Ralph P. Baltz
/s/ N. Ray Campbell Director February 2, 1998
- ------------------------
N. Ray Campbell
/s/ Charles R. Ervin Director February 2, 1998
- ------------------------
Charles R. Ervin
<PAGE>
/s/ Robert Rainwater Director February 2, 1998
- ------------------------
Robert Rainwater
/s/ Marcus Van Camp Director February 2, 1998
- ------------------------
Marcus Van Camp
<PAGE>
As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 6, 1998
Registration No. 333-43143
================================================================================
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
-----------------------------
EXHIBITS
TO
PRE-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT NO. 3 TO
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
ON
FORM S-1
-----------------------------
POCAHONTAS BANCORP, INC.
================================================================================
<PAGE>
EXHIBIT INDEX
1.1 Engagement Letter between Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
and Friedman, Billings, Ramsey & Co., Inc.**
1.2 Form of Agency Agreement among Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc., Pocahontas
Federal Savings and Loan Association, and Friedman, Billings, Ramsey &
Co., Inc.**
2 Plan of Conversion and Reorganization**
3.1 Certificate of Incorporation of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (Incorporated
herein by reference to Exhibit D of the Plan of Conversion and
Reorganization)
3.2 Bylaws of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (Incorporated herein by reference to
Exhibit E of the Plan of Conversion and Reorganization)
4 Form of Common Stock Certificate of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.**
5 Opinion of Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, P.C. regarding legality
of securities being registered**
8.1 Federal Tax Opinion of Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, P.C.
8.2 State Tax Opinion of Deloitte & Touche, LLP**
8.3 Letter from RP Financial, LC with respect to Subscription Rights**
10.1 Employment Agreement for Skip Martin**
10.2 Employment Agreement for James A. Edington**
10.3 Employment Agreement for Dwayne Powell**
10.4 Restated Supplemental Retirement Income Agreement for Skip Martin**
10.5 Restated Supplemental Retirement Income Agreement for
James A. Edington**
10.6 Supplemental Retirement Income Agreement for Dwayne Powell**
10.7 1994 Incentive Stock Option Plan**
10.8 1994 Stock Option Plan for Outside Directors**
10.9 1994 Recognition and Retention Plan for Employees**
10.10 1994 Recognition and Retention Plan for Outside Directors**
10.11 401(K) Savings and Employee Stock Ownership Plan**
21 Subsidiaries of the Registrant**
23.1 Consent of Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick, P.C. (contained in
opinion filed as Exhibit 5)
<PAGE>
23.2 Consent of Deloitte & Touche, LLP
23.3 Consent of RP Financial, LC**
23.4* Consent of Deloitte & Touche, LLP (contained in opinion filed as Exhibit
8.2)
24 Power of Attorney (set forth on Signature Page)
27 EDGAR Financial Data Schedule**
99.1 Appraisal Agreement between Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan
Association and RP Financial, LC**
99.2 Appraisal Report of RP Financial, LC**
99.3 Proxy Statement**
99.4 Marketing Materials**
99.5 Order and Acknowledgment Form**
- ----------
* To be filed supplementally or by amendment.
** Previously filed.
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Exhibit 8.1
February 3, 1998
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
203 West Broadway
Pocahontas, Arkansas 72455-3420
Ladies and Gentlemen:
You have requested this firm's opinion regarding certain federal income
tax consequences which will result from the conversion of Pocahontas Federal
Mutual Holding Company (the "Mutual Holding Company"), to the stock holding
company form, as effectuated pursuant to the two integrated transactions
described below. This Opinion Letter is governed by, and should be
interpreted in accordance with, the Legal Opinion Accord (the "Accord") of
the American Bar Association Section of Business Law (1991). As a
consequence, it is subject to a number of qualifications, exceptions,
definitions, limitations on coverage and other limitations, all as more
particularly described in the Accord. Our opinion is based upon the existing
provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code) and
regulations thereunder, both final and proposed (the "Treasury Regulations"),
and upon current Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") published rulings and
existing court decisions, any of which could be changed at any time. Any
such changes may be retroactive and could significantly modify the statements
and opinions expressed herein. Similarly, any change in the facts and
assumptions stated below, upon which this opinion is based, could modify the
conclusions. This opinion is as of the date hereof, and we disclaim any
obligation to advise you of any change in any matter considered herein after
the date hereof.
We, of course, opine only as to the matters we expressly set forth, and
no opinions should be inferred as to any other matters or as to the tax
treatment of the transactions that we do not specifically address. We
express no opinion as to other federal laws and regulations, or as to laws
and regulations of other jurisdictions, or as to factual or legal matters
other than as set forth herein.
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 2
We have made such other investigations as we have deemed relevant or
necessary for the purpose of this opinion. In our examination, we have
assumed the authenticity of original documents, the accuracy of copies and
the genuineness of signatures. We have further assumed the absence of
adverse facts not apparent from the face of the instruments and documents we
examined and have relied upon the accuracy of the factual matters set forth
in the Plan of Conversion and Reorganization (the "Plan") and the
Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed by Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. (the
"Company") with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Application for Conversion on
Form AC filed with the Office of Thrift Supervision (the "OTS").
In issuing our opinions, we have assumed that the Plan has been duly and
validly authorized and has been approved and adopted by the board of
directors of the Mutual Holding Company and the Bank at a meeting duly called
and held; that the Bank will comply with the terms and conditions of the
Plan, and that the various representations and warranties which are provided
to us are accurate, complete, true and correct. Accordingly, we express no
opinion concerning the effect, if any, of variations from the foregoing.
We specifically express no opinion concerning tax matters relating to
the Plan under state and local tax laws and under Federal income tax laws
except on the basis of the documents and assumptions described above. We
note that in December 1994, the IRS published Revenue Procedure 94-76 which
states that the IRS will not issue private letter rulings with respect to the
downstream merger of a corporation into a less than "80 percent distributee",
i.e, a corporation in which the merging corporation possesses less than 80
percent of the total voting power and less than 80 percent of the total value
of such corporation's stock. The IRS has assumed this "no-rule" position to
study whether such downstream mergers circumvent the purpose behind the
repeal of General Utilities & Operating Co. v. Helvering, 296 U.S. 200
(1935). If the IRS were to conclude that such mergers circumvent the repeal
of General Utilities, the IRS could issue regulations which could have the
effect of taxing to the merging corporation, as of the effective time of the
merger, the fair market value of the assets of such corporation over its
basis in such assets. Accordingly, the issuance of such regulations could
significantly modify the opinions expressed herein.
For purposes of this opinion, we are relying on the representations
provided to us by the Mutual Holding Company and Pocahontas Federal Savings
and Loan Association (the "Bank" or "Pocahontas Federal") as described in the
Affidavits of the President of the Mutual Holding Company and the Bank,
incorporated herein by reference.
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 3
The Proposed Transactions
Based solely upon our review of the documents described above, and in
reliance upon such documents, we understand that the relevant facts are as
follows. In December 1991, Pocahontas Federal, a Federally-chartered mutual
savings bank, reorganized into the mutual holding company form of
organization.
In April, 1994, the Bank sold 747,500 shares of common stock ("Bank
Common Stock") at $10.00 per share to the public (the "Minority
Stockholders"). After the conclusion of the sale to Minority Stockholders,
the Mutual Holding Company held 53.6% of the Bank's Common Stock outstanding.
The shares of Bank Common Stock that were sold to the Minority Stockholders
constituted approximately 46.4% of the issued and outstanding shares of Bank
Common Stock.
At the present time, two transactions referred to as the "MHC Merger"
and the "Bank Merger" are being undertaken. The MHC Merger and the Bank
Merger are being accomplished pursuant to a Plan of Conversion and
Reorganization (hereafter referred to as the "Plan"). Pursuant to the Plan,
the conversion ("Conversion") will be effected in the following steps, each
of which will be completed contemporaneously.
(i) The Bank will organize the Company (which will become the stock
holding company of the Bank) as a first tier wholly-owned
subsidiary of the Bank;
(ii) The Company will organize an interim savings bank ("Interim") as a
wholly-owned stock savings bank subsidiary of the Company;
(iii) Mutual Holding Company will exchange its charter for a federal
stock savings association charter and will simultaneously merge in
a statutory merger with and into the Bank (the "MHC Merger") with
the Bank as the resulting entity, pursuant to the Agreement of
Merger between Mutual Holding Company and the Bank, whereby each
member of the Mutual Holding Company who is an Eligible Account
Holder or Supplemental Eligible Account Holder will receive an
interest in a liquidation account established in the Bank pursuant
to regulations of the Commissioner (the "Liquidation Account") in
exchange for such member's ownership interest in the Mutual Holding
Company. In conjunction with the MHC Merger, the Bank's stock held
by the Mutual Holding Company will be canceled.
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 4
(iv) Interim will merge in a statutory merger with and into the Bank
with the Bank as the resulting institution (the "Bank Merger")
pursuant to the Agreement of Merger between the Bank, the Company
and Interim, whereby each Minority Stockholder will receive common
stock of the Company ("Company Common Stock") in exchange for
minority Shares, based on an exchange ratio (the "Exchange Ratio"),
with cash paid in lieu of fractional shares.
(v) As a result of the Bank Merger, the Company will own all of the
common stock of the Bank, and the Company will offer for sale
Company Common Stock in an offering (the "Offering") that will
occur contemporaneously with the Conversion (discussed below).
The Plan complies with the provisions of Subpart A of 12 C.F.R. Part
563b, which sets forth the OTS regulations for conversions of mutual
institutions to stock form. The Plan also complies with the provisions of 12
C.F.R. Section 575.12(a), which is the OTS regulation governing the
conversion of mutual holding companies to stock form.
In the MHC Merger, a liquidation account is being established by the
Bank for the benefit of Eligible Account Holders and Supplemental Account
Holders. Pursuant to Section 20 of the Plan, the initial balance of the
liquidation account will be equal to the sum of (i) approximately 52.1% (the
Mutual Holding Company stock ownership interest in the Bank) of the Bank's
total stockholders' equity as reflected in its latest statement of financial
condition contained in the final Prospectus utilized in the Conversion, or
(ii) the retained earnings of the Bank at the time the Bank underwent its
initial mutual holding company reorganization.
Upon the date of consummation of the Bank Merger ("the Effective Date"),
Interim will be merged with and into the Bank and Interim will cease to exist
as a legal entity. All of the then outstanding shares of Bank Common Stock
will be converted into and become shares of Company Common Stock pursuant to
the Exchange Ratio that ensures that after the Conversion and before giving
effect to Minority Stockholders' purchases in the Offering and receipt of
cash in lieu of fractional shares, Minority Stockholders will own the same
aggregate percentage of the Company's Common Stock as they currently own of
the Bank Common Stock. The common stock of Interim owned by the Company
prior to the Bank Merger will be converted into and become shares of common
stock of the Bank on the Effective Date. The Company Common Stock held by
the Bank immediately prior to the Effective Date will be canceled on the
Effective Date. Immediately following the Bank Merger, additional shares of
the Company Common Stock will be sold to depositors and former shareholders
of the Bank and to members of the public in the Offering.
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 5
As a result of the MHC Merger and the Bank Merger, the Company will be a
publicly held corporation, will register the Company Common Stock under
Section 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the
"Exchange Act"), and will become subject to the rules and regulations
thereunder and file periodic reports and proxy statements with the SEC. The
Bank will become a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company and will continue
to carry on its business and activities as conducted immediately prior to the
Conversion.
The stockholders of the Company will be the former Minority Stockholders
of the Bank immediately prior to the Bank Merger (i.e., all stockholders of
the Bank, excluding the Mutual Holding Company), plus those persons who
purchase shares of Company Common Stock in the Offering. Nontransferable
rights to subscribe for the Company Common Stock have been granted, in order
of priority, to depositors of the Bank who have account balances of $50.00 or
more as of the close of business on September 30, 1996 ("Eligible Account
Holders"), the Bank's tax-qualified employee plans ("Employee Plans"),
depositors of the Bank who have account balances of $50.00 or more as of the
close of business on December 31, 1997 ("Supplemental Eligible Account
Holders"), other members of the Bank (other than Eligible Account Holders and
Supplemental Eligible Account Holders) ("Other Members"), and owners of
shares of Bank Common Stock other than the Mutual Holding Company ("Minority
Stockholders"). Subscription rights are nontransferable. The Company will
also offer shares of Company Common Stock not subscribed for in the
Subscription Offering, if any, for sale in a community offering to certain
members of the general public (the "Community Offering").
Opinions
Based on the foregoing description of the MHC Merger and the Bank
Merger, and subject to the qualifications and limitations set forth in this
letter, we are of the opinion that, if the MHC Merger were to be consummated
as described above as of the date hereof, then:
1. The conversion of the Mutual Holding Company from a Federally
chartered mutual holding company to a Federally chartered interim stock
savings association will constitute a mere change in identity, form or place
of organization within the meaning of Section 368(a)(1)(F) of the Code.
2. The MHC Merger qualifies as a tax-free reorganization within the
meaning of Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the Code. (Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the
Code.)
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 6
3. The Mutual Holding Company will not recognize any gain or loss on
the transfer of its assets to the Bank in exchange for an interest in a
liquidation account established in the Bank. (Section 361 of the Code.)
4. The exchange of the members' equity interests in the Mutual Holding
Company for interests in a liquidation account established at the Bank in the
MHC Merger will satisfy the continuity of interest requirement of Section
1.368-1(b) of the Income Tax Regulations (cf. Rev. Rul. 69-3, 1969-1 C.B.
103, and Rev. Rul. 69-646, 1969-2 C.B. 54).
5. No gain or loss will be recognized by the Bank upon the receipt of
the assets of the Mutual Holding Company in exchange for the transfer to the
members of the Mutual Holding Company of an interest in the liquidation
account in the Bank. (Section 1032(a) of the Code.)
6. The basis of the assets of Mutual Holding Company to be received by
Bank will be the same as the basis of such assets in the hands of the Mutual
Holding Company immediately prior to the transfer. (Section 362(b) of the
Code.)
7. The holding period of the assets of the Mutual Holding Company to
be received by Bank will include the holding period of those assets in the
hands of the Mutual Holding Company immediately prior to the transfer.
(Section 1223(2) of the Code.)
8. Mutual Holding Company members will recognize no gain or loss upon
the receipt of an interest in the liquidation account in Bank in exchange for
their membership interest in Mutual Holding Company. (Section 354(a) of the
Code.)
In addition, we are of the opinion that, if the Bank Merger was to be
consummated as described above as of the date hereof, then:
9. The Bank Merger qualifies as a reorganization within the meaning of
Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the Code, pursuant to Section 368(a)(2)(E) of the
Code. The Bank Merger is not disqualified as a tax-free reorganization by
reason of the fact that because Company Common Stock will be conveyed to the
Bank's stockholders in exchange for their Bank Common Stock. (Section
368(a)(2)(E) of the Code.) The Bank, the Company and Interim will each be a
party to the reorganization within the meaning of Section 368(b).
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 7
10. Interim will not recognize any gain or loss on the transfer of its
assets to Bank in exchange for Bank Common Stock and the assumption by Bank
of the liabilities, if any, of Interim. (Section 361(a) and 357(a) of the
Code.)
11. Bank will not recognize any gain or loss on the receipt of the
assets of Interim in exchange for Bank Common Stock. (Section 1032(a) of the
Code.)
12. Bank's basis in the assets received from Interim in the proposed
transaction will, in each case, be the same as the basis of such assets in
the hands of Interim immediately prior to the transaction. (Section 362(b)
of the Code.)
13. Bank's holding period for the assets received from Interim in the
proposed transaction will, in each instance, include the period during which
such assets were held by Interim. (Section 1223(2) of the Code.)
14. The Company will not recognize any gain or loss upon its receipt of
Bank Common Stock in exchange for Interim stock. (Section 354(a) of the
Code.)
15. Bank shareholders will not recognize any gain or loss upon their
exchange of Bank Common Stock solely for shares of Company Common Stock
(including fractional shares which the Bank shareholders otherwise would be
entitled to receive). (Section 354(a) of the Code.)
16. Cash received in the Bank Merger by a Bank stockholder in lieu of a
fractional share interest of Company Common Stock will be treated as having
been received as a distribution in full payment in exchange for the
fractional share interest of Bank Common Stock which such stockholder would
otherwise be entitled to receive, and will qualify as capital gain or loss
(assuming the Bank Common Stock surrendered in exchange therefor was held as
a capital asset by such stockholder).
17. Each Bank shareholder's basis in his or her Company Common Stock
received in the exchange (including fractional shares which the Bank
shareholders otherwise would be entitled to receive) will be the same as the
basis of the Bank Common Stock surrendered in exchange therefor. (Section
358(a) of the Code.)
18. Each Bank shareholder's holding period in his or her Company Common
Stock received in the exchange will include the period during which the Bank
stock surrendered was
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 8
held, provided that the Bank Common Stock surrendered is a capital asset in
the hands of the Bank shareholder on the date of the exchange. (Section
1223(1) of the Code.)
19. No gain or loss will be recognized by the Company on the receipt of
money in exchange for Company Common Stock in the Offering. (Section 1032(a)
of the Code.)
Analysis
Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the Code defines the term "reorganization" to
include a "statutory merger or consolidation" of corporations such as the MHC
Merger and the Bank Merger. Section 368(a)(2)(E) of the Code provides that a
transaction otherwise qualifying as a merger under Section 368(a)(1)(A), such
as the Bank Merger, shall not be disqualified by reason of the fact that
common stock of a corporation (referred to in the Code as the "controlling
corporation") (i.e., the Company) which before the merger was in control of
the merged corporation is used in the transaction if:
(i) after the transaction, the corporation surviving the merger (the
Bank) holds substantially all of its properties and the properties
of the merged corporation (Interim) (other than common stock of the
controlling corporation (the Company) distributed in the
transaction); and
(ii) in the transaction, former stockholders of the surviving
corporation (the Bank stockholders) exchanged, for an amount of
voting common stock of the controlling corporation, an amount of
common stock in the surviving corporation which constitutes control
of such corporation.
Section 1.368-2(b)(1) of the Treasury Regulations provides that, in
order to qualify as a reorganization under Section 368(a)(1)(A), a
transaction must be a merger or consolidation effected pursuant to the
corporation laws of the United States or a state. The Plan provides that the
MHC Merger and the Bank Merger will be accomplished in accordance with
applicable state and federal law.
Treasury Regulations and case law require that, in addition to the
existence of statutory authority for a merger, certain other conditions must
be satisfied in order to qualify a proposed transaction as a reorganization
within the meaning of Section 368(a)(1)(A) of the Code. The "business
purpose test," which requires a proposed merger to have a bona fide business
purpose, must be satisfied. See 26 C.F.R. Section 1.368-1(c). We believe
that the MHC Merger and Bank
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 9
Merger satisfy the business purpose test for the reasons set forth in the
Prospectus under the caption "The Conversion--Reasons for the Conversion."
The "continuity of business enterprise test" requires an acquiring
corporation either to continue an acquired corporation's historic business or
use a significant portion of its historic assets in a business. See 26
C.F.R. Section 1.368-1(d). We believe that the business conducted by the
Bank prior to the MHC Merger and the Bank Merger will be unaffected by the
transactions.
The "continuity of interest doctrine" requires that the continuing
common stock interest of the former owners of an acquired corporation,
considered in the aggregate, represent a "substantial part" of the value of
their former interest, and provide them with a "definite and substantial
interest" in the affairs of the acquiring corporation or a corporation in
control of the acquiring corporation. Paulsen v. Comm'r., 469 U.S. 131
(1985); Helvering v. Minnesota Tea Co., 296 U.S. 378 (1935); John A. Nelson
Co. v. Helvering, 296 U.S. 374 (1935); Southwest Natural Gas Co. v. Comm'r.,
189 F.2d 332 (5th Cir. 1951), cert. denied, 342 U.S. 860 (1951). We believe
that the MHC Merger satisfies the continuity of interest doctrine based on
the information set forth in the Company's Registration Statement and based
on Revenue Rulings 69-646, 1969-2 C.B. 54 and 69-3, 1965-1 C.B. 103. We
believe that the Bank Merger satisfies the continuity of interest doctrine
based on representations received from the Bank in connection with the
preparation of this opinion to the effect that, to the best knowledge of the
management of the Bank, former shareholders of the Bank owning 50% or more of
all of the outstanding stock of the Bank immediately prior to the Conversion,
disregarding shares held by the Mutual Holding Company that were canceled in
the MHC Merger, would continue to own shares of the Company immediately after
the Bank Merger. In addition, we believe other applicable requirements of
the Treasury Regulations and case law which are preconditions to
qualification of the MHC Merger and the Bank Merger as a reorganization,
within the meaning of Sections 368(a)(1)(A) and 368(a)(2)(E) of the Code, are
satisfied on the basis of the information contained in the Plan and the
Prospectus.
Section 354 of the Code provides that no gain or loss shall be
recognized by stockholders who exchange common stock in a corporation, such
as the Bank, which is a party to a reorganization, solely for common stock in
another corporation which is a party to the reorganization, such as the
Company. Section 356 of the Code provides that stockholders shall recognize
gain to the extent they receive money as part of a reorganization, such as
cash received in lieu of fractional shares. Section 358 of the Code provides
that, with certain adjustments for money received in a reorganization, such
as cash received in lieu of fractional shares, a stockholder's basis in the
common stock he or she receives in a reorganization shall equal the basis of
the common stock which he or she surrendered in the transaction. Section
1223(1) states that,
<PAGE>
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK & SCHICK
A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
Boards of Directors
Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc.
Pocahontas Federal Savings and Loan Association
Pocahontas Federal Mutual Holding Company
February 3, 1998
Page 10
where a stockholder receives property in an exchange which has the same basis
as the property surrendered, he or she shall be deemed to have held the
property received for the same period as the property exchanged, provided
that the property exchanged had been held as a capital asset.
Section 361 of the Code provides that no gain or loss shall be
recognized to a corporation such as the Interim which is a party to a
reorganization on any transfer of property pursuant to a plan of
reorganization such as the Plan of Conversion. Section 362 of the Code
provides that if property is acquired by a corporation such as the Bank in
connection with a reorganization, then the basis of such property shall be
the same as it would be in the hands of the transferor immediately prior to
the transfer. Section 1223(2) of the Code states that where a corporation
such as the Savings Bank will have a carryover basis in property received
from another corporation which is a party to a reorganization, the holding
period of such assets in the hands of the acquiring corporation shall include
the period for which such assets were held by the transferor, provided that
the property transferred had been held as a capital asset. Section 1032 of
the Code states that no gain or loss shall be recognizes to a corporation,
such as the Company, on the receipt of property in exchange for common stock.
We hereby consent to the filing of the opinion as an exhibit to the
MHC's Application for Conversion on Form AC as filed with the OTS and to the
Company's Registration Statement on Form S-1 as filed with the SEC. We also
consent to the references to our firm in the Prospectus contained in the
Forms AC and S-1 under the captions "The Conversion--Tax Aspects" and "Legal
Opinions."
Very truly yours,
\s\ Luse Lehman Gorman Pomerenk & Schick
LUSE LEHMAN GORMAN POMERENK
& SCHICK, A PROFESSIONAL CORPORATION
<PAGE>
Exhibit 23.2
INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' CONSENT
We consent to the use in this Amendment No. 3 to Registration Statement No.
333-43143 of Pocahontas Bancorp, Inc. on Form S-1 of our report dated October
30, 1997, appearing in the Prospectus, which is part of this Registration
Statement.
We also consent to the reference to us under the heading "Experts" in such
Prospectus.
DELOITTE & TOUCHE, LLP
Little Rock, Arkansas
February 4, 1998.